BREF Especialidades Quimicas Inorganicas
BREF Especialidades Quimicas Inorganicas
Integrated Pollution Prevention and Control Reference Document on Best Available Techniques for the Production of
This document is one of a series of foreseen documents as below (at the time of writing, not all documents have been drafted):
Reference Document on Best Available Techniques. . . Large Combustion Plants Mineral Oil and Gas Refineries Production of Iron and Steel Ferrous Metals Processing Industry Non Ferrous Metals Industries Smitheries and Foundries Industry Surface Treatment of Metals and Plastics Cement and Lime Manufacturing Industries Glass Manufacturing Industry Ceramic Manufacturing Industry Large Volume Organic Chemical Industry Manufacture of Organic Fine Chemicals Production of Polymers Chlor Alkali Manufacturing Industry Large Volume Inorganic Chemicals - Ammonia, Acids and Fertilisers Industries Large Volume Inorganic Chemicals - Solid and Others industry Production of Speciality Inorganic Chemicals Common Waste Water and Waste Gas Treatment/Management Systems in the Chemical Sector Waste Treatments Industries Waste Incineration Management of Tailings and Waste-Rock in Mining Activities Pulp and Paper Industry Textiles Industry Tanning of Hides and Skins Slaughterhouses and Animals By-products Industries Food, Drink and Milk Industries Intensive Rearing of Poultry and Pigs Surface Treatment Using Organic Solvents Industrial Cooling Systems Emissions from Storage Reference Document . . . General Principles of Monitoring Economics and Cross-Media Effects Energy Efficiency Techniques MON ECM ENE Code LCP REF I&S FMP NFM SF STM CL GLS CER LVOC OFC POL CAK LVIC-AAF LVIC-S SIC CWW WT WI MTWR PP TXT TAN SA FDM ILF STS CV ESB
Electronic versions of draft and finalised documents are publically available and can be downloaded from http://eippcb.jrc.es.
Executive Summary
EXECUTIVE SUMMARY
The BAT (Best Available Techniques) Reference Document (BREF) entitled Best Available Techniques for the Production of Speciality Inorganic Chemicals presents the result of the work carried out by a group of European experts in a Technical Working Group (TWG) to determine the Best Available Techniques for the production of these chemicals. This document reflects an information exchange carried out under Article 16(2) of Council Directive 96/61/EC (IPPC Directive). This executive summary describes the main findings, a summary of the principal BAT conclusions and the associated consumption and emission levels. It should be read in conjunction with the preface, which explains the objectives of the document; how it is intended to be used and legal terms. This executive summary can be read and understood as a standalone document but, as a summary, it does not present all the complexities of this full document. It is therefore not intended as a substitute for this full document as a tool in BAT decision making. Scope of this document This document, together with other BREFs in the series, is intended to cover the activities described in Section 4 of the IPPC Directive, namely the Chemical industry. Within the chemical industry, this document focuses on the Speciality Inorganic Chemicals (SIC) sector. Because the IPPC Directive does not define the term SIC and since there is no common understanding of this term in industry, this document proposes criteria to differentiate between SIC and Large Volume Inorganic Chemicals (LVIC). In addition, the following working definition of SIC has been used for the purpose of this document: Speciality Inorganic Chemical (SIC) is taken to mean an inorganic substance manufactured industrially by chemical processing, generally in relatively small quantities, according to specifications (i.e. purity) tailored to meet the particular requirements of a user or industry sector (e.g. pharmaceutical). Given the huge variety of SIC, associated raw materials and production processes, this document focuses on a limited number of (illustrative) families of SIC and concludes on BAT for each of these specific families. From the illustrative families and the specific associated BAT conclusions, this document infers generic (or common) BAT conclusions that are considered applicable to the production of a wider range of SIC. The illustrative families developed in this document are speciality inorganic pigments, phosphorus compounds, silicones, inorganic explosives and cyanides. The exchange of information on soluble inorganic salts of nickel could not be carried out to such an extent that BAT conclusions could be drawn, and it was consequently decided to remove the section on inorganic salts of nickel from this document. The SIC sector Precise figures cannot be given for SIC industry sales because there is no common definition of SIC. It is thought however that, in Europe, the SIC sector represents between 10 and 20 % of the total chemical industry sales, and that sales are increasing slightly. The SIC sector is characterised by its diversity and by its fragmentation. Thousands of SIC products are manufactured all over Europe using an immense range of raw materials and production processes. SIC installations are generally small to medium size installations using continuous or batch modes of operation. Some SIC installations produce only one type of SIC
Speciality Inorganic Chemicals i
Executive Summary
while others are multipurpose plants capable of producing many different SIC. Companies of all sizes (from very large to very small) produce SIC at standalone installations or at installations that are part of a larger industrial complex. Production in Europe is generally highly automated and computer-controlled although there are exceptions which include explosives and pigments production. The SIC sector is highly competitive and confidential in nature as companies tend to develop niche markets and focus on their competitive advantage. Competition is generally based on quality as opposed to price. Key environmental issues Any substances might conceivably be a potential release to any medium because of the huge number of chemicals produced. In spite of this, the common environmental issues in the SIC sector as a whole include emissions of particulates to air (mainly dust and heavy metals); waste waters with high COD, heavy metals and/or salt loads; the consumption of energy and of water. The enormous variety of possibly produced and handled (also emitted) substances at SIC installations can also include highly harmful compounds having toxic or carcinogenic properties (e.g. cyanides, cadmium, lead, chromium (VI), arsenic). In addition, there are explosives among SIC substances. Health and safety can therefore be a crucial issue in the production of SIC substances. However, only some of these issues are relevant to individual SIC installations as shown by the illustrative families addressed in this document. The quality of end-products and the purity of raw materials are important factors influencing the environmental impact of the SIC sector. Common applied techniques, consumption and emission levels Although processes for the production of SIC are extremely diverse and sometimes very complex (e.g. silicones), they are typically composed of a combination of simpler activities (or process steps) and equipment. These activities include dissolution of raw materials, mixing, synthesis/reaction or calcination, washing, drying, milling/grinding (wet or dry), sieving, condensation, distillation, evaporation, filtration, hydrolysis, extraction, compaction, granulation and briquetting. These process steps can be grouped under five general process stages which form the core activities in a SIC production process: raw and auxiliary materials supply, handling and preparation; synthesis/reaction/calcinations; product separation and purification; product storage and handling; and emissions abatement. This document briefly describes these activities and general process stages and highlights the associated environmental issues. This document also briefly describes the process equipment and infrastructure commonly used in the SIC sector, as well as the characteristics of its energy supply and management system. Generic consumption and emission levels reflecting the whole SIC sector are difficult to provide because consumption and emission levels are specific to each SIC production process and only a few illustrative SIC processes have been examined in this document. This document therefore presents instead a checklist of possible emission sources and components against which assessments of any SIC production process can be made. Common techniques to consider in the determination of BAT The generic techniques that have been considered in the determination of BAT for the whole SIC sector are generally presented in line with the generic approach in order to understand a SIC production process. Each technique is presented following the same outline to facilitate its evaluation and, when it is possible, to enable comparisons to be made between techniques. Most of the common techniques are used in other chemical industry sectors and are described, generally in more detail, in other BREF documents (especially in the CWW BREF).
ii Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Executive Summary
Generic Best Available Techniques (BAT) This document presents Best Available Techniques (BAT) at two levels: generic BAT valid for the whole SIC sector, and specific BAT valid for the illustrative families of SIC selected. BAT for the production of a speciality inorganic chemical pertaining to one of the illustrative SIC families is therefore the combination of the generic BAT elements and the specific BAT elements that can be found in this document. For the production of a SIC that does not pertain to one of these illustrative SIC families, only the generic elements apply. In addition to the BAT referenced in this document, BAT for a SIC installation may also contain elements from other IPPC documents such as the BREFs on Emissions from Storage (ESB), Common Waste Water and Waste Gas Treatment/Management Systems in the Chemical Sector (CWW BREF). With regard to the CWW BREF, it is worth noting the following points: the SIC BREF takes a more in-depth look into the application of some of the techniques identified in the CWW BREF for the production of speciality inorganic chemicals in order to reduce the need for the reader of this document to consult the CWW BREF, techniques used both in the SIC sector and in other chemical industry sectors are briefly described in this document. For more detailed information, the reader should refer to the CWW BREF.
The main conclusions reached for the generic BAT are summarised below. Raw and auxiliary materials supply, storage, handling and preparation BAT is to reduce the amount of packaging materials disposed of by, e.g. recycling hard and soft used packaging materials, unless safety or hazard considerations prevent it. Synthesis/reaction/calcination BAT is to reduce emissions and the amount of residues generated by implementing one or a combination of the following measures: using high purity feedstock; improving reactor efficiencies; improving catalyst systems. For discontinuous processes, BAT is to optimise yields, lower emissions and reduce waste by sequencing the addition of reactants and reagents. BAT for discontinuous processes is also to minimise cleaning operations by optimising the sequences for addition of raw and auxiliary materials. Product handling and storage BAT is to reduce the amount of residues generated, for example by using returnable product transportation containers/drums. Waste gas emissions abatement This document presents BAT conclusions and associated emission levels for the abatement of HCN, NH3, HCl and Particulate Matters (PM). As an example, for PM BAT is to minimise emissions of total dust in off-gases and achieve emission levels in the range of 1 10 mg/Nm3 by using techniques described in this document. The lower end of the range may be achieved by using fabric filters in combination with other abatement techniques. However, the range may be higher, depending on the carrier gas and particulate characteristics. Using fabric filters is not always possible, e.g. when pollutants other than dust have to be abated or when the off-gases present humid conditions. The PM recovered/removed are recycled back into production when this is feasible. The scrubbing medium is recycled when this is feasible.
iii
Executive Summary
Waste water management and water emissions abatement Waste water treatment in the SIC sector follows at least three different strategies: pretreatment within the premises of the SIC installation and final treatment(s) in a central WWTP within the premises of a larger site where the SIC installation is located pretreatment and/or final treatment(s) in a WWTP within the premises of the SIC installation pretreatment within the premises of the SIC installation and final treatment(s) in a municipal WWTP.
All three strategies are BAT when properly applied to the actual waste water situation. No generic BAT conclusions on the abatement of heavy metals in waste water were derived. However, BAT conclusions on heavy metals abatement from waste water specific to three of the five illustrative families of SIC addressed in this document have been drawn, namely for speciality inorganic pigments, silicones and inorganic explosives. For information on heavy metals abatement in waste water in the production of substances not covered in the illustrative families sections of this document, it is recommended to refer to the CWW BREF. As a general measure, BAT is to allocate contaminated waste water streams according to their pollutant load. Inorganic waste water without relevant organic components is segregated from organic waste water and ducted to special treatment facilities. This document also presents BAT conclusions for the collection and treatment of rainwater. Infrastructure BAT is to minimise diffuse dust emissions in particular from the storage and handling of materials/products by applying one or more of the following techniques: storing materials in closed systems, using covered areas protected from rain and wind, having production equipment totally or partially enclosed, having equipment designed with hooding and ducting to capture diffuse dust emissions and abating them, carrying out housekeeping regularly. BAT is to reduce fugitive gaseous and liquid emissions by applying one or more of the following measures: having periodic leak detection and repair programmes, operating equipment at slightly below atmospheric pressure, replacing flanges by welded connections, using seal-less pumps and bellow valves, using high performance sealing systems, carrying out housekeeping regularly. For new installations, BAT is to use a computerised control system to operate the plant. However, this does not apply where safety issues do not permit automatic operations (e.g. in the production of SIC explosives). For installations where solid hazardous compounds can build up in pipelines, machines and vessels, BAT is to have in place a closed cleaning and rinsing system. Energy BAT is to reduce the consumption of energy by optimising plant design, construction and operation, for example by using pinch methodology, unless safety issues prevent it. Cross-boundary techniques Where substances which represent a potential risk of contamination of ground and groundwater are handled, BAT is to minimise soil and groundwater pollution by designing, building, operating and maintaining facilities, in such a way that material escapes are minimised. This document provides the specific list of techniques that are considered BAT. BAT is to have a high level of education and continuous training of personnel. This includes having personnel with sound basic education in chemical engineering and operations, continuously training plant personnel on the job, regularly evaluating and recording the performance of personnel, and regularly training personnel on how to respond to emergency situations, health and safety at work, and on product and transportation safety regulations.
iv Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Executive Summary
BAT is to apply the principles of an Industry Code if available. This includes the following: applying very high standards for safety, environmental and quality aspects in the production of the SIC; carrying out activities such as auditing, certification, training of plant personnel. BAT is to carry out a structured safety assessment for normal operation and to take into account effects due to deviations of the chemical process and deviations in the operation of the plant. In order to ensure that a process can be controlled adequately, BAT is to apply one or more of the following techniques: organisational measures, control engineering techniques, reaction stoppers, emergency cooling, pressure resistant construction, pressure relief systems. A number of environmental management techniques are determined as BAT. The scope and nature of the Environmental Management System (EMS) will generally be related to the nature, scale and complexity of the installation, and the range of environmental impacts it may have. BAT is to implement and adhere to an EMS that incorporates, as appropriate to individual circumstances, features that include the definition of an environmental policy, planning, establishing and implementing procedures, checking performance and taking corrective action, having the management system and audit procedure examined and validated by an accredited certification body or an external EMS verifier. Illustrative families of Speciality Inorganic Chemicals Speciality inorganic pigments General information and applied processes and techniques The information contained in this document focuses on speciality inorganic pigments produced industrially by chemical processes (such as iron oxide pigments, complex inorganic coloured pigments, zinc sulphide, barium sulphate and lithopone pigments). Other (non-speciality) inorganic pigments, in particular titanium dioxide and carbon black pigments, are in the scope of the Large Volume Inorganic Chemicals Solid and Others (LVIC-S) BREF. In Europe, speciality inorganic pigments are produced in small to large installations using a continuous or a batch mode of operation. Production is mainly located in Germany, Italy and Spain. Pigments production is considered a mature industrial sector where little new development is foreseen. Although many production processes have been developed to manufacture the very large variety of inorganic pigments, production may be broken down in two main processes: pigment synthesis followed by pigment processing. The synthesis of pigments is carried out using a wet precipitation process or a dry calcination process each having a different environmental impact. The wet chemical process requires a large amount of water and generates a large amount of waste water, whereas the dry calcination process requires less water but more energy and gives rise to more off-gas emissions. Pigment processing includes washing, drying, calcination, mixing/milling, filtration/screening, and drying operations. Pigment processing gives rise to emissions to air and water. Of particular concern is the emission of particulates containing heavy metals to air. Consumption/emissions levels and techniques to consider in the determination of BAT This document provides consumption and emission levels from a sample of plants producing pigments in Europe. Techniques to consider in the determination of BAT include the use of non-carcinogenic raw materials, fluoride abatement by lime washing, the use of distilled water coming from the evaporation/concentration system for washing pigments, the removal of chromium from waste water, the recycling of precipitation sludge back into production, the biological treatment of waste water loaded with nitrates, the pretreatment and final treatment of waste water loaded with heavy metals.
Executive Summary
Best Available Techniques In some instances, the diversity of the production processes and raw materials used led to BAT conclusions which are only applicable to certain pigments and/or when certain processes are carried out. Examples of BAT that have a wider applicability are presented below (i.e. concerning PM, acid gases and waste water). BAT is to capture dust in the work areas and duct it to abatement. The abated dust is then recycled back into production. BAT is also to carry out regular housekeeping of the work areas. BAT is to minimise the emission of acid gases and fluorides by using sorbent injection techniques for example. BAT is to minimise the emission of total dust from the activities carried out at the installation and achieve emission levels of 1 10 mg/Nm3 by using techniques such as cyclone, fabric filter, wet scrubber, ESP. The lower end of the range may be achieved by using fabric filters in combination with other abatement techniques. Using fabric filters is not always possible, for example when other pollutants have to be abated or when the offgases present humid conditions. For waste water, BAT is to (pre)treat waste water contaminated with Cr(VI) and achieve a Cr(VI) concentration of <0.1 mg/l by flow buffering and reducing Cr(VI) to Cr(III), for example using sulphite or iron (II) sulphate. BAT is also to pretreat the waste water loaded with heavy metals before discharging to the receiving water by a combination of techniques indicated in this document. The filtration residues recovered from the waste water treatment may be recycled back into production. Phosphorus compounds General information and applied processes and techniques The phosphorus compounds addressed in this document are phosphorus trichloride (PCl3), phosphoryl chloride (POCl3) and phosphorus pentachloride (PCl5). All three substances are very toxic. They are produced in Europe by six companies at seven sites. The main markets for phosphorus compounds are in agriculture and in the production of flame-retardants. Production is carried out at multipurpose plants using a continuous mode of operation. Production of PCl3, POCl3 and PCl5 are closely related as PCl3 is the starting material for the production of the other two compounds. PCl3 is manufactured in Europe either using the gas-liquid or the gas phase reaction process. Elemental phosphorus and chlorine are the raw materials used to produce PCl3. Consumption/emission levels and techniques to consider in the determination of BAT The main environmental issues of concern in the production of phosphorus compounds are HCl and phosphorus oxide emissions to air, as well as chlorides and phosphorous emissions to water. Techniques to consider in the determination of BAT include the use of hot condensate water to melt elemental phosphorus and to keep it in liquid form, the use of different systems to blanket elemental phosphorus, the use of elemental phosphorus with low organic and inorganic impurities, the use of scrubbing systems to abate phosphorus compounds in the waste gases, and storage measures. Best Available Techniques BAT for phosphorus compounds relate mainly to the minimisation of waste, energy savings, the prevention of accidents, the production yield as well as the minimisation of chloride, and phosphorus emissions to the environment. Examples of these are presented below.
vi
Executive Summary
BAT is to reduce the consumption of energy required to melt the solid white/yellow elemental phosphorus raw material by using hot condensate water coming from other parts of the process. BAT is to minimise the risk of fire by blanketing the elemental phosphorus raw material with an inert medium up to the reaction step. BAT is to reduce HCl emissions to air from the production of phosphorus compounds and achieve emission levels of 3 15 mg/Nm3 by alkaline scrubbing. To minimise emissions in all production conditions, flowrates through the scrubber system and alkali concentration in the scrubbing medium have to be sufficiently high. BAT is to minimise emissions of phosphorus and chlorine to the receiving water by treating water effluents in a WWTP equipped with biological treatment and achieve emission levels of phosphorus to the receiving water of 0.5 2 kg/t of raw elemental phosphorus and emission levels of chlorine to the receiving water of 5 10 kg/t of raw elemental phosphorus. Regarding waste, BAT is to achieve emission levels of waste distillation residues from PCl3 production of 4 8 kg/t of raw elemental phosphorus and to incinerate distillation residues. Silicones General information and applied processes and techniques Silicones are a special variety of polymers. They differ from polymers as the backbone of their structure does not contain carbon, but is a chain of alternating silicon and oxygen atoms. Several thousands of different silicone products are on the market and a production site often manufactures over a thousand different silicone products. This document addresses the most important ones, namely polydimethylsiloxane (PDMS). Applications of silicones include electric isolators, lubricants, elastomers, coatings, additives in lacquers, paintings and cosmetic products. Four companies produce silicones in Europe, all using a continuous mode of operation. PDMS is produced through the following process steps: methyl chloride synthesis, grinding of elemental silicon, direct synthesis (Mller-Rochow synthesis), distillation, and hydrolysis/condensation. The main raw materials are elemental silicon, HCl and methanol. Consumption/emission levels and techniques to consider in the determination of BAT The main environmental issues are dust, chlorides and NOX emissions to the air, as well as emission of copper and zinc to the receiving water. Techniques to consider in the determination of BAT include measures for the storage of elemental silicon, pinch methodology to optimise energy consumption, a dry dedusting system for the storage, handling and grinding of elemental silicon, different ways of recovering methyl chloride, thermal treatment of off-gases containing light hydrocarbons and chlorinated compounds, treatment of waste water, re-use/recovery of water and HCl, prevention of accidents. Best Available Techniques BAT for the production of silicones mainly relate to the maximisation of the efficiency of the chemical reaction, the minimisation of materials used, the prevention of accidents, the minimisation of waste, the efficient use of energy, the reduction of emissions to air and water. Some examples are presented below. BAT is to minimise diffuse dust emissions from the storage and handling of elemental silicon by applying measures indicated in this document. BAT is to reduce channelled dust emissions from elemental silicon grinding, storage and handling, and achieve emission levels of 5 20 mg/Nm3 (yearly average) by using fabric filters, for example, and recycling the separated dust back into production.
Speciality Inorganic Chemicals vii
Executive Summary
To achieve maximum efficiency of the chemical reaction in the direct synthesis, BAT is to use elemental silicon raw materials with a particle size of <1 mm. Regarding the prevention of accidents, BAT is to minimise the sources of ignition energy from elemental silicon grinding and to minimise the sources of explosions from grinding and conveying elemental silicon by maintaining the oxygen and/or elemental silicon dust content in the equipment atmosphere at a safe level below the LEL. BAT is to reduce the consumption of energy by recycling the energy produced in the direct synthesis. For waste water treatment, BAT is to minimise emissions of copper and zinc to water by pretreating the water effluents from PDMS production by precipitation/flocculation under alkaline conditions followed by sedimentation and filtration. BAT is also to reduce the BOD/COD content of the water effluent coming out of the pretreatment by applying a biological treatment step. SIC explosives General information and applied processes and techniques The inorganic explosives covered in this document are lead azide, lead trinitroresorcinate and lead picrate which are of industrial and economic importance in Europe. These substances are classified as primary explosives whose main function is to initiate a secondary explosive (e.g. in dynamites). Other uses include applications in air-bag inflators and seat-belt pretensioners. Inorganic explosives are produced batch wise. The raw materials used are lead nitrate and sodium azide in the production of lead azide, lead nitrate and trinitroresorcine in the production of lead trinitroresorcinate and lead nitrate and sodium picrate in the production of lead picrate. SIC explosives are produced by a precipitation reaction. The resulting product is then purified and dried. Consumption/emission levels and techniques to consider in the determination of BAT The main environmental issues associated with inorganic explosives production are emissions to water of lead, nitrates, sulphates, COD and suspended solids. Techniques to consider in the determination of BAT include the removal of lead from waste waters by precipitation with sulphuric acid or sodium carbonate, the removal of traces of explosive materials containing lead from waste waters using a neutralisation station, and ground protection measures. Best Available Techniques This document presents BAT in areas that include accident prevention, waste minimisation and reduction of lead emissions to water. Some examples of BAT are presented below. In order to avoid the domino effect in the case of an explosion, BAT is to separate production and storage buildings on the production site. BAT is also to reduce the risk of explosions of electric origin by storing SIC explosives in buildings equipped with electrical protection and safety systems. BAT for waste water includes the collection and treatment of used process waters, the removal of traces of explosive impurities in the waste water, the reduction of organic impurities in the waste water by using activated carbon. BAT is also to recycle waste water back into the production process where the production scale and/or the ratio between energy-cost/water-cost justifies this. Finally, BAT is to send the waste water to a central WWTP for treatment. If the central WWTP does not have denitrification treatment (and nitrification if necessary), BAT is to subsequently treat the waste water in a biological WWTP (on-site or off-site, e.g. municipal WWTP) with denitrification (and nitrification if necessary).
viii Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Executive Summary
Cyanides General information and applied processes and techniques This document focuses on water soluble sodium cyanide (NaCN) and potassium cyanide (KCN). The other inorganic cyanide salts are not addressed due to their low production volume. Cyanides are mainly used in Europe in the chemical synthesis industry as well as in electroplating and metal hardening. NaCN and KCN are produced at less than a dozen sites in Europe in medium sized facilities using a continuous mode of operation. This document addresses the production of NaCN and KCN by the water solution process which includes two main steps for the production of a solution of cyanides (i.e. neutralisation followed by filtration) and subsequent steps for the production of cyanides in solid forms (i.e. drying, compaction, granulation, separation from fine dust, sieving or briquetting). The raw materials are HCN and NaOH or KOH. Consumption/emission levels and techniques to consider in the determination of BAT Emissions from the production of cyanides mainly consists of HCN and NH3 to the air and of cyanides to the receiving waters. Techniques to consider in the determination of BAT include the destruction of cyanides from waste gases and waste waters using hydrogen peroxide, the thermal treatment of off-gases containing VOCs, the cleaning-inplace system for equipment contaminated with cyanide, the use of returnable packaging for the transport of solid cyanides, the use of a computerised control system to operate the plant, the application of the International Cyanide Management Code, storage measures for cyanides, the use of raw materials with low contents of heavy metals, the high level of education and continuous training of personnel. Best Available Techniques This document presents BAT on waste reduction, minimisation of raw materials as well as on the abatement of NOX, HCN, NH3 and VOCs. This document also presents BAT associated emission levels for these pollutants. Regarding emissions of cyanides to water, this document concludes that BAT is to minimise these emissions by using techniques that oxidise cyanides. Using hypochlorite is also considered BAT when the cyanide-effluent stream is free of organic material and when no free hypochlorite is left in the effluent after the oxidation reaction. The associated BAT emission levels are also indicated in this document. Several BAT for the prevention of soil pollution are also presented. Other BAT conclusions relate to water and energy consumption, product storage and packaging, plant operation and training of personnel. Emerging techniques Some emerging techniques have been identified in the course of the work. These are: the decontamination of exhaust gases and waste water by chemically modified inorganic ion exchangers and active carbon, the utilisation of industrial waste as fuel, air filtration for the abatement of volatile chromium compounds, the development and application of advanced ceramic electrodes for the electrochemical elimination of cyanides in waste water.
ix
Executive Summary
Concluding remarks The information exchange on BAT for the production of SIC was conducted in a period of about two years, from October 2003 to November 2005. The exchange of information was challenging because confidentiality concerns hampered the collection of actual consumption and emission data from individual SIC installations. However, this did not prevent the drawing of generic BAT conclusions valid for the whole SIC sector as well as BAT conclusions for the specific families of SIC addressed in this document. Consensus has been achieved on BAT and no split views were recorded. The EC is launching and supporting, through its RTD programmes, a series of projects dealing with clean technologies, emerging effluent treatment and recycling technologies and management strategies. Potentially these projects could provide a useful contribution to future BREF reviews. Readers are therefore invited to inform the European IPPC Bureau of any research results which are relevant to the scope of this document (see also the preface of this document).
Preface
PREFACE
1. Status of this document
Unless otherwise stated, references to the Directive in this document means the Council Directive 96/61/EC on integrated pollution prevention and control. As the Directive applies without prejudice to Community provisions on health and safety at the workplace, so does this document. This document forms part of a series presenting the results of an exchange of information between EU Member States and industries concerned on best available technique (BAT), associated monitoring, and developments in them. It is published by the European Commission pursuant to Article 16(2) of the Directive, and must therefore be taken into account in accordance with Annex IV of the Directive when determining best available techniques. 2. Relevant legal obligations of the IPPC Directive and the definition of BAT
In order to help the reader understand the legal context in which this document has been drafted, some of the most relevant provisions of the IPPC Directive, including the definition of the term best available techniques, are described in this preface. This description is inevitably incomplete and is given for information only. It has no legal value and does not in any way alter or prejudice the actual provisions of the Directive. The purpose of the Directive is to achieve integrated prevention and control of pollution arising from the activities listed in its Annex I, leading to a high level of protection of the environment as a whole. The legal basis of the Directive relates to environmental protection. Its implementation should also take account of other Community objectives such as the competitiveness of the Communitys industry thereby contributing to sustainable development. More specifically, it provides for a permitting system for certain categories of industrial installations requiring both operators and regulators to take an integrated, overall look at the polluting and consuming potential of the installation. The overall aim of such an integrated approach must be to improve the management and control of industrial processes so as to ensure a high level of protection for the environment as a whole. Central to this approach is the general principle given in Article 3 that operators should take all appropriate preventative measures against pollution, in particular through the application of Best Available Techniques enabling them to improve their environmental performance. The term best available techniques is defined in Article 2(11) of the Directive as the most effective and advanced stage in the development of activities and their methods of operation which indicate the practical suitability of particular techniques for providing in principle the basis for emission limit values designed to prevent and, where that is not practicable, generally to reduce emissions and the impact on the environment as a whole. Article 2(11) goes on to clarify further this definition as follows: techniques includes both the technology used and the way in which the installation is designed, built, maintained, operated and decommissioned; available techniques are those developed on a scale which allows implementation in the relevant industrial sector, under economically and technically viable conditions, taking into consideration the costs and advantages, whether or not the techniques are used or produced inside the Member State in question, as long as they are reasonably accessible to the operator; best means most effective in achieving a high general level of protection of the environment as a whole.
xi
Preface
Furthermore, Annex IV of the Directive contains a list of considerations to be taken into account generally or in specific cases when determining best available techniques ... bearing in mind the likely costs and benefits of a measure and the principles of precaution and prevention. These considerations include the information published by the Commission pursuant to Article 16(2). Competent authorities responsible for issuing permits are required to take account of the general principles set out in Article 3 when determining the conditions of the permit. These conditions must include emission limit values, supplemented or replaced where appropriate by equivalent parameters or technical measures. According to Article 9(4) of the Directive, these emission limit values, equivalent parameters and technical measures must, without prejudice to compliance with environmental quality standards, be based on the best available techniques, without prescribing the use of any technique or specific technology, but taking into account the technical characteristics of the installation concerned, its geographical location and the local environmental conditions. In all circumstances, the conditions of the permit must include provisions on the minimisation of long-distance or transboundary pollution and must ensure a high level of protection for the environment as a whole. Member States have the obligation, according to Article 11 of the Directive, to ensure that competent authorities follow or are informed of developments in Best Available Techniques. 3. Objective of this Document
Article 16(2) of the Directive requires the Commission to organise an exchange of information between Member States and the industries concerned on best available techniques, associated monitoring and developments in them, and to publish the results of the exchange. The purpose of the information exchange is given in recital 25 of the Directive, which states that the development and exchange of information at Community level about best available techniques will help to redress the technological imbalances in the Community, will promote the worldwide dissemination of limit values and techniques used in the Community and will help the Member States in the efficient implementation of this Directive. The Commission (Environment DG) established an information exchange forum (IEF) to assist the work under Article 16(2) and a number of technical working groups have been established under the umbrella of the IEF. Both IEF and the technical working groups include representation from Member States and industry as required in Article 16(2). The aim of this series of documents is to reflect accurately the exchange of information which has taken place as required by Article 16(2) and to provide reference information for the permitting authority to take into account when determining permit conditions. By providing relevant information concerning best available techniques, these documents should act as valuable tools to drive environmental performance. 4. Information Sources
This document represents a summary of information collected from a number of sources, including in particular the expertise of the groups established to assist the Commission in its work, and verified by the Commission services. All contributions are gratefully acknowledged. 5. How to understand and use this document
The information provided in this document is intended to be used as an input to the determination of BAT in specific cases. When determining BAT and setting BAT-based permit conditions, account should always be taken of the overall goal to achieve a high level of protection for the environment as a whole. The rest of this section describes the type of information that is provided in each section of the document.
xii Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Preface
Chapter 1 provides general information on the Speciality Inorganic Chemicals (SIC) industrial sector. Chapter 2 describes the processes and techniques commonly used within the sector. Chapter 3 provides information concerning common current consumption and emission levels reflecting the situation in existing SIC installations at the time of writing. Chapter 4 describes, in a generic manner, the common emission reduction and other common techniques that are considered to be most relevant for determining BAT and BAT-based permit conditions. For each technique, this information includes the consumption and emission levels considered achievable by using the technique, some idea of the costs and the cross-media issues associated with the technique, and the extent to which the technique is applicable to the range of installations requiring IPPC permits, for example new, existing, large or small installations. Techniques that are generally seen as obsolete are not included. Chapter 5 presents the techniques and, when possible, associated consumption and emission levels that are considered to be generic BAT for the SIC sector as a whole. Chapter 6 considers, in detail, illustrative SIC families that have been chosen to elucidate the application of BAT in the SIC sector. Chapter 5 and the BAT sections of Chapter 6 present the techniques and the consumption and emission levels that are considered to be compatible with BAT in a general sense. The purpose is thus to provide general indications regarding the consumption and emission levels that can be considered as an appropriate reference point to assist in the determination of BAT-based permit conditions or for the establishment of general binding rules under Article 9(8). It should be stressed, however, that this document does not propose emission limit values. The determination of appropriate permit conditions will involve taking account of local, site-specific factors such as the technical characteristics of the installation concerned, its geographical location and the local environmental conditions. In the case of existing installations, the economic and technical viability of upgrading them also needs to be taken into account. Even the single objective of ensuring a high level of protection for the environment as a whole will often involve making trade-off judgements between different types of environmental impact, and these judgements will often be influenced by local considerations. Although an attempt is made to address some of these issues, it is not possible for them to be considered fully in this document. The techniques and levels presented in Chapter 5 and in the BAT sections of Chapter 6 will, therefore, not necessarily be appropriate for all installations. On the other hand, the obligation to ensure a high level of environmental protection including the minimisation of long-distance or transboundary pollution implies that permit conditions cannot be set on the basis of purely local considerations. It is, therefore, of the utmost importance that the information contained in this document is fully taken into account by permitting authorities. Since the Best Available Techniques change over time, this document will be reviewed and updated as appropriate. All comments and suggestions should be made to the European IPPC Bureau at the Institute for Prospective Technological Studies at the following address: Edificio Expo, c/Inca Garcilaso, s/n, E-41092 Sevilla, Spain Telephone: +34 95 4488 284 Fax: +34 95 4488 426 e-mail: [email protected] Internet: http://eippcb.jrc.es
xiii
Best Available Techniques Reference Document for the Production of Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
EXECUTIVE SUMMARY.........................................................................................................................I PREFACE.................................................................................................................................................XI SCOPE ................................................................................................................................................. XXV 1 GENERAL INFORMATION ........................................................................................................... 1 1.1 The chemical industry in Europe ............................................................................................... 1 1.2 The SIC sector in Europe ........................................................................................................... 1 1.2.1 Production and market features........................................................................................ 2 1.2.2 Companies profiles ......................................................................................................... 2 1.2.3 Sectors outlook ............................................................................................................... 3 1.2.4 Competition...................................................................................................................... 3 1.3 Key environmental issues in the SIC sector ............................................................................... 4 COMMON APPLIED PROCESSES AND TECHNIQUES .......................................................... 5 2.1 General features of a SIC production process ............................................................................ 5 2.2 Common process steps ............................................................................................................... 6 2.2.1 Dissolution of raw materials ............................................................................................ 7 2.2.2 Mixing.............................................................................................................................. 8 2.2.3 Synthesis/reaction ............................................................................................................ 9 2.2.4 Calcination ....................................................................................................................... 9 2.2.5 Washing ......................................................................................................................... 10 2.2.6 Drying ............................................................................................................................ 10 2.2.7 Size reduction and separation operations ....................................................................... 11 2.2.7.1 Dry milling/grinding .............................................................................................. 11 2.2.7.2 Wet milling ............................................................................................................ 12 2.2.7.3 Sieving ................................................................................................................... 12 2.2.8 Condensation.................................................................................................................. 13 2.2.9 Distillation...................................................................................................................... 13 2.2.10 Evaporation .................................................................................................................... 15 2.2.11 Solid-liquid and solid-gas separations............................................................................ 16 2.2.12 Hydrolysis ...................................................................................................................... 17 2.2.13 Extraction....................................................................................................................... 17 2.3 Raw and auxiliary materials and finished products storage and handling................................ 18 2.4 Process-integrated measures for emissions prevention and reduction...................................... 18 2.5 Emissions abatement systems .................................................................................................. 19 2.5.1 General overview ........................................................................................................... 19 2.5.2 Waste gas treatment techniques ..................................................................................... 20 2.5.3 Waste water treatment techniques.................................................................................. 22 2.6 Process equipment and infrastructure....................................................................................... 23 2.6.1 Reactors ......................................................................................................................... 23 2.6.2 Pumps, compressors and fans ........................................................................................ 25 2.6.3 Pipes............................................................................................................................... 25 2.6.4 Valves ............................................................................................................................ 26 2.6.5 Utility fluids ................................................................................................................... 26 2.6.6 Cooling and refrigeration systems ................................................................................. 27 2.6.7 Cleaning systems ........................................................................................................... 28 2.6.8 Vacuum systems ............................................................................................................ 29 2.6.9 Storage systems.............................................................................................................. 29 2.6.10 Transfer and handling systems....................................................................................... 30 2.6.11 Monitoring practices ...................................................................................................... 30 2.7 Energy supply .......................................................................................................................... 31 2.8 Management systems ............................................................................................................... 31 COMMON CONSUMPTION AND EMISSION LEVELS ......................................................... 33 3.1 Air emissions............................................................................................................................ 33 3.1.1 Diffuse emissions to air.................................................................................................. 36 3.1.2 Point source emissions to air.......................................................................................... 36 3.2 Water emissions ....................................................................................................................... 36 3.3 Wastes ...................................................................................................................................... 38 xv
Odour and noise emissions .......................................................................................................41 Energy consumption .................................................................................................................41 Water consumption...................................................................................................................41 Factors influencing consumption and emission levels..............................................................41 Installation boundary definition and degree of integration.............................................41 Determination of consumption and emission levels .......................................................42 Definition of waste .........................................................................................................42
COMMON TECHNIQUES TO CONSIDER IN THE DETERMINATION OF BAT..............43 4.1 Structure of this chapter............................................................................................................44 4.2 Raw and auxiliary materials and finished products supply, storage, handling and preparation44 4.2.1 Recycling or re-use of used containers/drums ................................................................44 4.2.2 Recycling of used soft packaging materials.................................................................45 4.2.3 Storage of liquid and liquefied gas .................................................................................46 4.2.4 Transfer and handling of liquid and liquefied gas ..........................................................46 4.2.5 Storage of solids .............................................................................................................46 4.2.6 Handling of solids...........................................................................................................46 4.3 Synthesis/reaction/calcination ..................................................................................................47 4.3.1 Substitution of raw materials ..........................................................................................47 4.3.2 Improving reactor efficiencies........................................................................................48 4.3.3 Improving catalyst systems ............................................................................................49 4.3.4 Optimising processes......................................................................................................50 4.4 Emissions abatement ................................................................................................................51 4.4.1 Waste water treatment techniques ..................................................................................51 4.4.1.1 Separation or clarification techniques.....................................................................53 4.4.1.1.1 Sedimentation (including coagulation/flocculation) of solids.........................53 4.4.1.1.2 Air flotation ....................................................................................................55 4.4.1.1.3 Filtration .........................................................................................................56 4.4.1.1.4 Membrane filtration (microfiltration or ultrafiltration) ...................................57 4.4.1.2 Physical and/or chemical techniques ......................................................................58 4.4.1.2.1 Precipitation....................................................................................................58 4.4.1.2.2 Crystallisation .................................................................................................60 4.4.1.2.3 Chemical oxidation .........................................................................................61 4.4.1.2.4 Chemical reduction .........................................................................................62 4.4.1.2.5 Nanofiltration (NF)/Reverse Osmosis (RO) ...................................................63 4.4.1.2.6 Adsorption ......................................................................................................64 4.4.1.2.7 Ion exchange ...................................................................................................66 4.4.1.2.8 Evaporation.....................................................................................................67 4.4.1.2.9 Stripping .........................................................................................................68 4.4.1.2.10 Incineration .....................................................................................................69 4.4.2 Waste gas treatment techniques......................................................................................70 4.4.2.1 Waste gas treatment techniques to abate particulate matter....................................70 4.4.2.1.1 Separators .......................................................................................................70 4.4.2.1.2 Cyclones .........................................................................................................72 4.4.2.1.3 Wet dust scrubber ...........................................................................................73 4.4.2.1.4 Electrostatic precipitator (ESP).......................................................................75 4.4.2.1.5 Fabric and ceramic filters................................................................................76 4.4.2.1.6 Two-stage dust filter .......................................................................................78 4.4.2.1.7 Absolute High Efficiency Particule Arrestation (HEPA) filter.......................79 4.4.2.1.8 High Efficiency Air Filter (HEAF).................................................................81 4.4.2.1.9 Mist filter ........................................................................................................82 4.4.2.2 Waste gas treatment techniques to abate VOCs and inorganic compounds............84 4.4.2.2.1 Membrane separation......................................................................................84 4.4.2.2.2 Condensation and cryogenic condensation .....................................................86 4.4.2.2.3 Adsorption ......................................................................................................87 4.4.2.2.4 Wet gas scrubber.............................................................................................89 4.4.2.2.5 Removal of HCN and NH3 from waste gases .................................................91 4.4.2.2.6 Twin-bed oxidiser systems .............................................................................93 4.4.2.2.7 Incineration of exhaust gases containing Volatile Organic Compounds (VOCs)............................................................................................................94 4.4.2.2.8 Catalytic oxidation ..........................................................................................96 4.4.2.3 Waste gas treatment techniques to abate gaseous pollutants in combustion exhaust gases .......................................................................................................................97 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
xvi
4.4.2.3.1 Sorbent injection for abating acid gases and fluorides ................................... 97 4.4.2.3.2 Selective reduction of NOX (SNCR and SCR) ............................................... 99 4.4.2.3.3 Wet SO2 abatement techniques .................................................................... 100 4.4.3 Combined waste water and waste gas treatment techniques ........................................ 101 4.4.3.1 Scrubbing and recycling of cyanides from waste gases and waste waters using hydrogen peroxide (H2O2) as the oxidising agent ................................................ 101 4.4.4 Treatment techniques of liquid (non-aqueous) and solid residues ............................... 103 4.4.4.1 Thickening and dewatering .................................................................................. 103 4.4.4.2 Stabilisation and conditioning .............................................................................. 105 4.4.4.3 Thermal sludge reduction..................................................................................... 106 4.5 Infrastructure .......................................................................................................................... 106 4.5.1 Cleaning-In-Place (CIP) systems of equipment contaminated with solid hazardous compounds ................................................................................................................... 106 4.5.2 Use of a computerised control system to operate the plant .......................................... 108 4.6 Energy .................................................................................................................................... 109 4.6.1 Pinch methodology ...................................................................................................... 109 4.7 Cross-boundary techniques .................................................................................................... 110 4.7.1 Ground protection ........................................................................................................ 110 4.7.2 High level of education and continuous training of personnel..................................... 112 4.7.3 Application of an Industry Code (IC) .......................................................................... 113 4.7.4 Rainwater collection and treatment.............................................................................. 114 4.7.5 Safety assessment......................................................................................................... 115 4.7.5.1 Physico-chemical safety assessment of chemical reactions ................................. 115 4.7.5.2 Prevention of runaway reactions .......................................................................... 119 4.7.6 Environmental management tools................................................................................ 120 5 6 GENERIC BEST AVAILABLE TECHNIQUES ....................................................................... 129 ILLUSTRATIVE FAMILIES OF SPECIALITY INORGANIC CHEMICALS..................... 137 6.1 Speciality inorganic pigments ................................................................................................ 137 6.1.1 General information ..................................................................................................... 137 6.1.1.1 Uses...................................................................................................................... 138 6.1.1.1.1 Iron oxide pigments...................................................................................... 138 6.1.1.1.2 Complex Inorganic Coloured (CIC) pigments ............................................. 139 6.1.1.1.3 Zinc sulphide pigments and precipitated barium sulphate (blanc fixe) ........ 141 6.1.1.2 Toxicity ................................................................................................................ 141 6.1.1.3 Speciality inorganic pigments production and consumption in Europe and worldwide............................................................................................................. 142 6.1.1.4 Features of the European speciality inorganic pigments industry ........................ 143 6.1.1.5 Economics ............................................................................................................ 143 6.1.2 Applied processes and techniques................................................................................ 143 6.1.2.1 Pigment synthesis................................................................................................. 144 6.1.2.1.1 Wet chemical process................................................................................... 145 6.1.2.1.2 Dry calcination process ................................................................................ 145 6.1.2.1.3 Environmental impact of pigment synthesis ................................................ 145 6.1.2.2 Pigment processing .............................................................................................. 146 6.1.2.3 Measures for reduction of emissions.................................................................... 146 6.1.2.3.1 Principle of waste gas treatment................................................................... 146 6.1.2.3.2 Principle of waste water treatment ............................................................... 149 6.1.2.4 Iron oxide pigments.............................................................................................. 151 6.1.2.4.1 Precipitation and Penniman-Zoph processes................................................ 151 6.1.2.4.2 Laux process................................................................................................. 155 6.1.2.5 Chromium (III) oxide pigments ........................................................................... 157 6.1.2.5.1 Waste gas treatment ..................................................................................... 157 6.1.2.5.2 Waste water treatment .................................................................................. 159 6.1.2.5.3 Waste............................................................................................................ 159 6.1.2.6 Complex Inorganic Coloured (CIC) pigments ..................................................... 159 6.1.2.6.1 Waste gas treatment ..................................................................................... 159 6.1.2.6.2 Waste water treatment .................................................................................. 160 6.1.2.7 Zinc sulphide, barium sulphate and lithopone pigments ...................................... 161 6.1.2.7.1 Zinc sulphide and lithopone pigments.......................................................... 161 6.1.2.7.2 Precipitated barium sulphate pigments......................................................... 162 6.1.2.7.3 Waste water treatment .................................................................................. 164 6.1.3 Consumption and emission levels ................................................................................ 164 xvii
6.1.3.1 Raw materials, auxiliary chemicals, energy and water consumption....................164 6.1.3.1.1 Energy consumption .....................................................................................164 6.1.3.1.2 Air emissions ................................................................................................165 6.1.3.1.3 Water consumption and emission .................................................................167 6.1.3.1.4 By-products and wastes ................................................................................172 6.1.3.1.5 Noise .............................................................................................................173 6.1.3.1.6 Odour ............................................................................................................173 6.1.4 Techniques to consider in the determination of BAT ...................................................173 6.1.4.1 Use of non-carcinogenic raw materials.................................................................173 6.1.4.2 Penniman-Zoph process to manufacture yellow iron oxide pigments ..................174 6.1.4.3 Fluoride and boron abatement by lime washing ...................................................175 6.1.4.4 Use of distilled water coming from the evaporation/concentration system for washing pigments .................................................................................................176 6.1.4.5 Chromium removal from waste water ..................................................................177 6.1.4.6 Strict control of the pH value of the reaction........................................................178 6.1.4.7 Recycling of precipitation sludges back into production......................................178 6.1.4.8 Biological treatment of waste water loaded with nitrates .....................................179 6.1.4.9 Pretreatment of waste water loaded with heavy metals ........................................180 6.1.4.10 Final treatment of waste water loaded with heavy metals ....................................181 6.1.5 Best Available Techniques ...........................................................................................182 6.1.6 Emerging techniques ....................................................................................................184 6.2 Phosphorus compounds ..........................................................................................................185 6.2.1 General information......................................................................................................185 6.2.1.1 Uses ......................................................................................................................185 6.2.1.2 Toxicity.................................................................................................................186 6.2.1.3 Explosions and fire hazards ..................................................................................186 6.2.1.4 Phosphorus compounds production in Europe and worldwide.............................186 6.2.1.5 Features of the European phosphorus compounds industry..................................187 6.2.1.6 Economics ............................................................................................................187 6.2.2 Applied processes and techniques ................................................................................187 6.2.2.1 Process chemistry .................................................................................................187 6.2.2.2 Production processes ............................................................................................187 6.2.2.2.1 Production of PCl3 ........................................................................................187 6.2.2.2.2 Production of POCl3 .....................................................................................189 6.2.2.2.3 Production of PCl5 ........................................................................................190 6.2.2.3 Raw material storage and handling.......................................................................191 6.2.2.4 Finished products storage and handling................................................................191 6.2.2.5 Materials used for production equipment .............................................................192 6.2.3 Consumption and emission levels ................................................................................192 6.2.3.1 Energy consumption .............................................................................................192 6.2.3.2 Water consumption...............................................................................................192 6.2.3.3 Air emissions ........................................................................................................192 6.2.3.4 Water emissions....................................................................................................193 6.2.3.5 Wastes...................................................................................................................193 6.2.4 Techniques to consider in the determination of BAT ...................................................194 6.2.4.1 Use hot condensate water to melt elemental phosphorus and to keep it in liquid form ......................................................................................................................194 6.2.4.2 Use of an inert gas (typically N2) to blanket elemental phosphorus raw material 195 6.2.4.3 Use of water to blanket the elemental phosphorus raw material and recycling of the water for off-gas scrubbing...................................................................................195 6.2.4.4 Use of elemental phosphorus raw material containing low organic and inorganic impurities ..............................................................................................................196 6.2.4.5 Use of neutral scrubbing for abating PCl3 and phosphorus oxides in waste gases197 6.2.4.6 Use of alkaline scrubbing for abating PCl3 in waste gases ...................................197 6.2.4.7 Use of strictly enclosed systems ...........................................................................198 6.2.4.8 Incineration of the distillation residues from the PCl3 production........................198 6.2.4.9 Storage measures for phosphorus compounds ......................................................199 6.2.5 Best Available Techniques ...........................................................................................200 6.3 Silicones .................................................................................................................................201 6.3.1 General information......................................................................................................201 6.3.1.1 Uses ......................................................................................................................202 6.3.1.2 Toxicology and environmental aspects for the use of silicones............................202 6.3.1.3 Production capacity ..............................................................................................203 xviii Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
6.3.1.4 Features of the European silicone industry .......................................................... 203 6.3.1.5 Economics ............................................................................................................ 203 6.3.2 Applied processes and techniques................................................................................ 204 6.3.2.1 Auxiliary chemicals and utilities.......................................................................... 204 6.3.2.2 Raw materials and auxiliary chemicals storage and handling .............................. 205 6.3.2.3 Methyl chloride synthesis..................................................................................... 205 6.3.2.4 Grinding of silicon ............................................................................................... 206 6.3.2.5 Direct synthesis .................................................................................................... 206 6.3.2.6 Distillation............................................................................................................ 207 6.3.2.7 Hydrolysis/condensation or methanolysis............................................................ 208 6.3.2.8 Polymer synthesis................................................................................................. 209 6.3.2.8.1 Equilibrium polymerisation.......................................................................... 209 6.3.2.8.2 Polycondensation ......................................................................................... 209 6.3.3 Consumption and emission levels ................................................................................ 210 6.3.3.1 Raw materials, auxiliary chemicals, energy and water consumption ................... 210 6.3.3.1.1 Raw materials and auxiliary chemicals consumption................................... 210 6.3.3.1.2 Energy consumption..................................................................................... 210 6.3.3.1.3 Water consumption ...................................................................................... 211 6.3.3.2 Air emissions........................................................................................................ 211 6.3.3.3 Water emissions ................................................................................................... 212 6.3.3.4 By-products and solid wastes ............................................................................... 214 6.3.3.4.1 By-products .................................................................................................. 214 6.3.3.4.2 Wastes .......................................................................................................... 214 6.3.3.5 Noise .................................................................................................................... 214 6.3.4 Techniques to consider in the determination of BAT .................................................. 215 6.3.4.1 Storage of elemental silicon in silos..................................................................... 215 6.3.4.2 Optimisation of utility consumption by pinch methodology................................ 215 6.3.4.3 Dry dedusting system for elemental silicon grinding, storage and handling........ 216 6.3.4.4 Optimisation of the chemistry for the direct synthesis ......................................... 218 6.3.4.5 Recovery of methyl chloride through condensation with water heat exchangers 218 6.3.4.6 Recovery of methyl chloride through condensation using cryogenic fluids ........ 219 6.3.4.7 Condensation of methylchlorosilanes by air condensers...................................... 220 6.3.4.8 Thermal oxidation of off-gases containing light hydrocarbons and chlorinated organic compounds .............................................................................................. 221 6.3.4.9 Treatment of waste water from PDMS production .............................................. 223 6.3.4.10 Minimisation of the quantity of water used in the production process................. 224 6.3.4.11 Re-use of the water formed in the methyl chloride synthesis step into the hydrolysis step...................................................................................................... 225 6.3.4.12 HCl recovery from the hydrolysis of dimethyldichlorosilane .............................. 226 6.3.4.13 Selection of the elemental silicon particle size..................................................... 227 6.3.4.14 Use of a covered elemental silicon storage .......................................................... 228 6.3.4.15 Minimise the source of ignition energy from elemental silicon grinding............. 229 6.3.4.16 Minimise the sources of explosions from elemental silicon grinding and conveying .............................................................................................................................. 230 6.3.4.17 Cooling of the distillation columns with air ......................................................... 231 6.3.4.18 Backup power source for the waste water treatments .......................................... 231 6.3.5 Best Available Techniques........................................................................................... 232 6.4 Speciality inorganic chemical (SIC) explosives..................................................................... 235 6.4.1 General information ..................................................................................................... 236 6.4.1.1 Uses...................................................................................................................... 236 6.4.1.2 Toxicity ................................................................................................................ 236 6.4.1.3 Production capacity.............................................................................................. 237 6.4.1.4 Features of the European SIC explosive industry ................................................ 237 6.4.1.5 Economics ............................................................................................................ 238 6.4.2 Applied processes and techniques................................................................................ 238 6.4.2.1 Process chemistry................................................................................................. 238 6.4.2.2 Raw materials and auxiliary chemicals storage and handling .............................. 239 6.4.2.3 Raw material solution .......................................................................................... 239 6.4.2.4 Reaction ............................................................................................................... 239 6.4.2.5 Purification of SIC explosives.............................................................................. 240 6.4.2.6 Drying of SIC explosives ..................................................................................... 240 6.4.2.7 Handling and storage of SIC explosives .............................................................. 240 6.4.3 Consumption and emission levels ................................................................................ 240 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals xix
Raw materials and auxiliary chemicals consumption ...........................................242 Energy consumption .............................................................................................243 Water consumption...............................................................................................244 Air emissions ........................................................................................................244 Water emissions....................................................................................................244 Solid wastes ..........................................................................................................246 Odour and noise emissions ...................................................................................247 Techniques to consider in the determination of BAT ...................................................247 Removal of lead from waste waters by precipitation with sulphuric acid or sodium carbonate (pretreatment technique).......................................................................247 6.4.4.2 Removal of traces of explosive materials containing lead from waste waters using a neutralisation station.............................................................................................249 6.4.4.3 COD reduction through treatment with activated carbon .....................................251 6.4.4.4 Destruction of explosive impurities from waste water .........................................252 6.4.4.5 Ground protection.................................................................................................253 6.4.5 Best Available Techniques ...........................................................................................255 6.5 Cyanides .................................................................................................................................257 6.5.1 General information......................................................................................................257 6.5.1.1 Uses and markets ..................................................................................................258 6.5.1.2 Quality of the cyanide products/specifications .....................................................258 6.5.1.3 Toxicity.................................................................................................................259 6.5.1.4 Cyanides production in Europe and worldwide....................................................259 6.5.1.5 Features of the European cyanide industry ...........................................................260 6.5.1.6 Economics ............................................................................................................260 6.5.2 Applied processes and techniques ................................................................................261 6.5.2.1 Main types of production processes......................................................................261 6.5.2.2 Process chemistry .................................................................................................262 6.5.2.3 Raw materials and auxiliary chemicals storage and handling...............................263 6.5.2.4 Neutralisation/crystallisation ................................................................................263 6.5.2.5 Filtration ...............................................................................................................264 6.5.2.6 Drying...................................................................................................................264 6.5.2.7 Compaction...........................................................................................................264 6.5.2.8 Granulation ...........................................................................................................264 6.5.2.9 Separation from fine dust/sieving/briquetting.......................................................264 6.5.2.10 Packaging and storing of cyanides........................................................................264 6.5.2.11 Handling and storage of cyanides .........................................................................265 6.5.3 Consumption and emission levels ................................................................................266 6.5.3.1 Raw materials and auxiliary chemicals consumption ...........................................266 6.5.3.2 Energy consumption .............................................................................................267 6.5.3.3 Water consumption...............................................................................................267 6.5.3.4 Air emissions ........................................................................................................267 6.5.3.5 Water emissions....................................................................................................269 6.5.3.6 Solid wastes ..........................................................................................................270 6.5.3.7 Odour and noise emissions ...................................................................................270 6.5.3.8 Monitoring ............................................................................................................270 6.5.4 Techniques to consider in the determination of BAT ...................................................270 6.5.4.1 Destruction of cyanides from waste gases and waste waters using hydrogen peroxide (H2O2) as the oxidising agent.................................................................270 6.5.4.2 Incineration of process air containing volatile organic compounds (VOCs) ........273 6.5.4.3 Cleaning-In-Place (CIP) system for equipment contaminated with cyanides.......275 6.5.4.4 Removal of HCN and NH3 from waste gases .......................................................277 6.5.4.5 Returnable packaging for the transport of solid cyanides.....................................279 6.5.4.6 Use of a computerised control system to operate the plant...................................280 6.5.4.7 Double containment of cyanide plants..................................................................281 6.5.4.8 Application of the International Cyanide Management Code (ICMC).................282 6.5.4.9 Storage measures for solid cyanides .....................................................................283 6.5.4.10 Using NaOH and KOH with a very low content of heavy metals ........................283 6.5.4.11 High level of education and continuous training of personnel .............................285 6.5.5 Best Available Techniques ...........................................................................................286 6.5.6 Emerging techniques ....................................................................................................289 7 EMERGING TECHNIQUES........................................................................................................291
xx
Decontamination of exhaust gases and waste water by chemically modified inorganic ion exchangers and active carbons ............................................................................................... 291 Utilisation of industrial waste and especially petrochemical residues for power generation with low emissions ......................................................................................................................... 292 Air filtration for the abatement of volatile chromium compounds in the tanning industry .... 293 Development and application of advanced ceramic electrodes for the electrochemical elimination of cyanides in waste water .................................................................................. 293
CONCLUDING REMARKS ........................................................................................................ 295 8.1 Timing of the work................................................................................................................. 295 8.2 Sources of information and development of this document ................................................... 295 8.3 Degree of consensus reached ................................................................................................. 297 8.4 Recommendations for future work......................................................................................... 297 8.5 Suggested topics for future R&D projects ............................................................................. 298
REFERENCES....................................................................................................................................... 299 GLOSSARY OF TERMS AND ABBREVIATIONS .......................................................................... 301 9 ANNEXES ...................................................................................................................................... 309 9.1 Annex I. Questionnaire used to gather environmental information on SIC installations ....... 309
xxi
List of figures
Figure 2.1: Schematic representation of a SIC production process ..............................................................6 Figure 2.2: Overview of the abatement systems used at a typical SIC installation.....................................20 Figure 3.1: Factors on which the type and amount of waste in a typical SIC installation depend..............39 Figure 4.1: Waste water treatment techniques in relation to contaminants.................................................52 Figure 4.2: Main sources of dust and abatement techniques used in the SIC sector...................................70 Figure 4.3: Removal of HCN and NH3 from waste gases...........................................................................91 Figure 4.4: Incineration of process air containing Volatile Organic Compounds (VOCs) .........................94 Figure 4.5: Scrubbing and recycling of cyanides from waste gases and waste waters .............................101 Figure 4.6: A Cleaning-In-Place-system (CIP) of equipment contaminated with solid hazardous compounds .........................................................................................................................106 Figure 4.7: Safety assessment procedure ..................................................................................................116 Figure 4.8: Iterative assessment strategy for normal operations...............................................................116 Figure 6.1: Pigment synthesis and processing ..........................................................................................144 Figure 6.2: Off-gas treatment for reducing total dust from the exhaust gas of a dryer and a miller/grinder ............................................................................................................................................148 Figure 6.3: Flow diagram of water effluents treatment.............................................................................150 Figure 6.4: Wet processes for the production of iron oxide pigments and measures for the reduction of emissions ............................................................................................................................152 Figure 6.5: Process steps of aqueous oxidation processes in the production of iron oxide pigments .......154 Figure 6.6: Production of iron oxide pigments by the Laux process ........................................................156 Figure 6.7: Production of chromium (III) oxide pigments........................................................................158 Figure 6.8: Production of Complex Inorganic Coloured (CIC) pigments.................................................160 Figure 6.9: Flow diagram for the production of lithopone pigments ........................................................161 Figure 6.10: Production of phosphorus trichloride by the gas-liquid reaction process.............................188 Figure 6.11: Production of phosphorus trichloride by gas phase reaction ................................................189 Figure 6.12: Production of phosphoryl chloride .......................................................................................190 Figure 6.13: Production of phosphorus pentachloride ..............................................................................191 Figure 6.14: Process steps for the production of silicones........................................................................205 Figure 6.15: Methyl chloride synthesis.....................................................................................................206 Figure 6.16: Example of the hydrolysis of dimethyldichlorosilane to oligosiloxane................................208 Figure 6.17: Consumption of raw materials, auxiliary materials, energy and water for the production of silicones..............................................................................................................................210 Figure 6.18: Emissions to air from the production of silicones ................................................................211 Figure 6.19: Emissions to water from the production of PDMS...............................................................213 Figure 6.20: Example of a fabric filter system used in the production of silicones ..................................216 Figure 6.21: Chemical structure of some primary explosives...................................................................235 Figure 6.22: Consumption of raw materials, auxiliary chemicals, energy and water for the production of SIC explosives....................................................................................................................241 Figure 6.23: Emissions to water from the production of SIC explosives .................................................241 Figure 6.24: Basic behaviour of a cyanide solution..................................................................................257 Figure 6.25: Main steps for the production of sodium or potassium cyanide using a water solution process ............................................................................................................................................262 Figure 6.26: Emissions to air from the production of cyanides ................................................................268 Figure 6.27: Emissions to water from the production of cyanides............................................................269 Figure 6.28: Destruction of cyanides from waste gases and waste waters................................................271 Figure 6.29: Incineration of process air containing volatile organic compounds (VOCs)........................273 Figure 6.30: Cleaning-In-Place-system (CIP) for equipment contaminated with cyanides ......................275 Figure 6.31: Removal of HCN and NH3 from waste gases.......................................................................277
xxii
List of tables
Table 2.1: Likely environmental impact of the common process steps used in the production of SIC substances .............................................................................................................................. 7 Table 2.2: Selection of techniques for waste gas emission reduction in relation to the pollutant to be removed ............................................................................................................................... 21 Table 2.3: Major waste water contaminants and their respective treatment techniques............................. 22 Table 3.1: Main pollutants that could be emitted to the air during the production of some SIC substances ............................................................................................................................................. 34 Table 3.2: Pollutants that could be carried by the waste water discharged to the receiving waters in the production of some SIC substances ..................................................................................... 36 Table 4.1: Information breakdown for each technique described in Chapter 4.......................................... 43 Table 4.2: Operational data associated with the use of precipitation techniques ....................................... 59 Table 4.3: Operational data associated with the use of the adsorption technique ...................................... 64 Table 4.4: Operational data associated with the use of the separator technique......................................... 71 Table 4.5: Operational data associated with the use of wet dust scrubbers................................................ 73 Table 4.6: Operational data associated with the use of ESP....................................................................... 75 Table 4.7: Operational data associated with the use of fabric and ceramic filters...................................... 76 Table 4.8: Operational data associated with the use of two-stage dust filters ............................................ 78 Table 4.9: Operational data associated with the use of HEPA filters......................................................... 79 Table 4.10: Operational data associated with the use of HEAF filters....................................................... 81 Table 4.11: Operational data associated with the use of mist filters .......................................................... 82 Table 4.12: Operational data associated with the use of membrane separation ......................................... 85 Table 4.13: Operational data associated with the use of condensation ...................................................... 86 Table 4.14: Operational data associated with the use of adsorption........................................................... 88 Table 4.15: Operational data associated with the use of wet gas scrubbers ............................................... 90 Table 4.16: Achieved emission levels for the removal of HCN and NH3 from waste gases...................... 91 Table 4.17: Operational data for the removal of HCN and NH3 from waste gases .................................... 92 Table 4.18: Achieved emission levels after incineration of VOCs ............................................................ 95 Table 4.19: Operational data for the incineration of VOCs........................................................................ 95 Table 4.20: Operational data associated with the use of catalytic oxidation .............................................. 96 Table 4.21: Achieved emission levels after SO2 abatement ..................................................................... 100 Table 4.22: Achieved emission levels after scrubbing and recycling of cyanides ................................... 102 Table 4.23: Operational data for the scrubbing and recycling of cyanides .............................................. 102 Table 4.24: Achieved emission levels associated with the CIP of equipment contaminated with cyanides ........................................................................................................................................... 107 Table 4.25: Operational data for the cleaning of equipment contaminated with cyanides ....................... 107 Table 4.26: Examples from SIC plants for retention volumes ................................................................. 110 Table 4.27: Template to analyse the effects due to deviations of chemical processes or to the operation of the plant ............................................................................................................................. 117 Table 6.1: Main application fields for some inorganic pigments in Western Europe .............................. 138 Table 6.2: Examples of existing Complex Inorganic Coloured (CIC) pigments...................................... 140 Table 6.3: Estimated worldwide production of inorganic pigments in 1995............................................ 142 Table 6.4: Off-gas treatments for the production of inorganic pigments ................................................. 147 Table 6.5: Main water effluent streams for the production of chromium(III) oxide pigments................. 159 Table 6.6: Sources of waste water from the production of zinc sulphide, lithopone and barium sulphate pigments ............................................................................................................................ 164 Table 6.7: Consumption of energy at several plants producing SIC pigments in Europe ........................ 165 Table 6.8: Concentration levels of pollutants measured in the off-gas after treatment at several plants producing pigments in Europe........................................................................................... 166 Table 6.9: Techniques used to treat waste water at several plants producing pigments in Europe .......... 169 Table 6.10: Concentration levels of pollutants measured in the waste water after treatment at several plants producing pigments in Europe ................................................................................ 170 Table 6.11: Pollutants loads and concentrations for the production of iron oxide pigments.................... 171 Table 6.12: Average amount of waste water treated in the production of zinc sulphide, barium sulphate and lithopone pigments...................................................................................................... 172 Table 6.13: Pollutants contained in the waste water from the production of zinc sulphide, barium sulphate and lithopone pigments...................................................................................................... 172 Table 6.14: Emission levels achieved after pretreatment and final treatment of waste water loaded with heavy metals ...................................................................................................................... 181 Table 6.15: Emission levels associated with BAT 6.1.12 ........................................................................ 183 Table 6.16: Production capacity of raw siloxanes (i.e. PDMS) in Europe ............................................... 203 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals xxiii
Table 6.17: Metal concentrations after sedimentation ..............................................................................213 Table 6.18: Possible use of by-products from the production of silicones ...............................................214 Table 6.19: Main applications of SIC explosives .....................................................................................236 Table 6.20: Production capacity of lead azide, lead trinitroresorcinate and lead picrate in Europe .........237 Table 6.21: Raw and auxiliary materials used in the production of lead azide (LA)................................242 Table 6.22: Raw and auxiliary materials used in the production of lead trinitroresorcinate (LTNR).......243 Table 6.23: Raw and auxiliary materials used in the production of lead picrate (LP) ..............................243 Table 6.24: Efficiency of the lead removal pretreatment in the production of lead azide and lead trinitroresorcinate at a Spanish installation ........................................................................245 Table 6.25: Typical concentration of pollutants in waste waters at the output of the central WWTP ......245 Table 6.26: Annual water emission levels in the production of SIC explosives.......................................246 Table 6.27: Concentration values of pollutants in water emissions in the production of SIC explosives.246 Table 6.28: Typical quantity of solid wastes generated at a Spanish installation .....................................246 Table 6.29: Efficiency of the lead removal pretreatment system at a Spanish installation.......................248 Table 6.30: Technical specifications of the evaporator ............................................................................250 Table 6.31: Example of a daily mass balance ...........................................................................................250 Table 6.32: Typical liquid cyanide product specifications .......................................................................259 Table 6.33: Sites where sodium cyanide and potassium cyanide are produced in Europe .......................260 Table 6.34: Quantity of raw materials needed to produce one tonne of NaCN and one tonne of KCN respectively ........................................................................................................................266 Table 6.35: Emissions to air from a well operated cyanide production plant ...........................................267 Table 6.36: Discharge levels to a WWTP from a typical cyanide production plant .................................269 Table 6.37: Achieved emission levels after oxidative destruction of cyanides.........................................271 Table 6.38: Operational data for the destruction of cyanides ...................................................................272 Table 6.39: Achieved emission levels after incineration of VOCs ...........................................................273 Table 6.40: Operational data for the incineration of VOCs ......................................................................274 Table 6.41: Achieved emission levels associated with the cleaning of equipment contaminated with cyanides..............................................................................................................................275 Table 6.42: Operational data for the cleaning of equipment contaminated with cyanides .......................276 Table 6.43: Achieved emission levels for the removal of HCN and NH3 from waste gases ....................277 Table 6.44: Operational data for the removal of HCN and NH3 from waste gases ..................................278 Table 6.45: Emission levels to air associated with BAT for the production of cyanides..........................286 Table 6.46: Discharge levels to water at the inlet of the WWTP associated with BAT for the production of cyanides..............................................................................................................................287 Table 8.1: Milestones for the work on the Speciality Inorganic Chemicals BREF ..................................295
xxiv
Scope
SCOPE
The chemical industry is generally recognised to be a complex industrial sector with an extremely large number and diversity of manufactured products. Some 70000 chemical compounds are manufactured worldwide, each having a distinct chemical nature, production route(s) and end-use [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. For the exercise of the chemical BREFs under the IPPC Directive, the chemical industry was divided into organics and inorganics, and these were then divided into sectors. The four BREF documents covering the production of inorganic chemicals are listed below and Speciality Inorganic Chemicals (SIC) is one of these: Chloralkali (CAK) Large Volume Inorganic Chemicals Ammonia, Acids and Fertilisers (LVIC-AAF) Large Volume Inorganic Chemicals Solid and Others (LVIC-S) Speciality Inorganic Chemicals (SIC).
Together with the other three BREFs, this document is intended to cover the following principal activities that are described in Annex I of the IPPC Directive: Production within the meaning of the categories of activities contained in this section means the production on an industrial scale by chemical processing of substances or groups of substances listed in Sections 4.2. Chemical installations for the production of basic inorganic chemicals, such as: (a) gases, such as ammonia, chlorine or hydrogen chloride, fluorine or hydrogen fluoride, carbon oxides, sulphur compounds, nitrogen oxides, hydrogen, sulphur dioxide, carbonyl chloride (b) acids, such as chromic acid, hydrofluoric acid, phosphoric acid, nitric acid, hydrochloric acid, sulphuric acid, oleum, sulphurous acids (c) bases, such as ammonium hydroxide, potassium hydroxide, sodium hydroxide (d) salts, such as ammonium chloride, potassium chlorate, potassium carbonate, sodium carbonate, perborate, silver nitrate (e) non-metals, metal oxides or other inorganic compounds such as calcium carbide, silicon, silicon carbide 4.3. Chemical installations for the production of phosphorous-, nitrogen- or potassium-based fertilisers (simple or compound fertilisers) 4.4. Chemical installations for the production of basic plant health products and of biocides 4.5. Installations using a chemical or biological process for the production of basic pharmaceutical products 4.6. Chemical installations for the production of explosives Working definition of Speciality Inorganic Chemicals (SIC) The term Speciality Inorganic Chemicals does not appear in the IPPC Directive, and the Directive does not include any definition of what speciality means. Furthermore, the term speciality is widely used in the chemical industry but to cover very different realities; there is no commonly accepted definition of this term, and almost every chemical producer has its own.
xxv
Scope
Despite this, the term speciality is generally understood and used in the chemical industry as opposed to commodity or large volume. With the view of defining the scope of the SIC BREF and in order to avoid the duplication of information with the LVIC-S BREF (the BREF with the highest probability of overlaps), the following criteria were considered to differentiate SIC substances from LVIC substances (and these were proposed by the European Chemical Industry Council Cefic):
Criteria Volume of production* Size of investment to build a production plant Product description Product differentiation from competition Applications Driver for selling to customers Raw material used R&D objective Integration of production Who makes the buying decision? LVIC Usually high Very high Formula No Often a large number of applications or very high volume applications Price Often a mineral To improve the economics of the process Vertical, often produced at the source of the mineral raw material The customers purchasing department Usually low Medium Formula + effect, purity, formulation Yes often the speciality product is sold on performance Often only a few applications or highly specialised Quality/price Often a chemical to be reprocessed and refined To create new tailored applications Often produced on an LVIC site as a complementary production The customers technical/production staff SIC
Each individual speciality inorganic chemical addressed in this document meets several of the above criteria, but not necessarily all of them. For the purpose of this document, the following definition of SIC is used: For the purpose of the SIC BREF, Speciality Inorganic Chemical (SIC) is taken to mean an inorganic substance manufactured industrially, by chemical processing, generally in relatively small quantities, according to specifications (i.e. purity) tailored to meet the particular requirements of a user or industry sector (e.g. pharmaceutical). Generally, the SIC sector is considered to have the following features: companies of all sizes manufacture SIC substances SIC substances are produced in medium and small sized facilities SIC substances are produced in standalone installations or in installations that are part of a larger industrial (typically chemical) complex a SIC facility can be dedicated to the production of a single SIC product or several SIC substances continuous as well as batch operations are used for the production of SIC substances confidentiality is an issue for companies producing SIC substances the production of SIC substances often requires the purification of products and advanced developments to cope with customers new requirements.
xxvi
Scope
Bearing in mind the number and huge variety of SIC substances, associated raw materials and production processes, it was considered that a good approach was to focus, as a starting point, on a limited number of families or groups of SIC substances, and to develop BAT conclusions for each of these families. From this, generic or common BAT conclusions that could apply to the production of a wider range of SIC substances not specifically covered by the selected families of SIC substances have been concluded. The following criteria were adopted in order to select the families of substances that are discussed in this document: the family is of industrial importance (relatively large production volume and/or relatively large number of manufacturing facilities) the manufacturing processes for the family have environmental issues where an information exchange will be particularly valuable information will be readily available on the manufacturing processes so that the SIC BREF work could be completed within a reasonable timeframe.
The following six families were selected using the above-mentioned criteria: speciality inorganic pigments silicones phosphorus compounds (PCl3, POCl3, PCl5) inorganic explosives cyanides (NaCN, KCN) soluble inorganic salts of nickel (NiSO4, NiCl2, NiCO3, Ni(NO3)2).
Document structure As the scope of SIC is so large, this document contains a mixture of generic/common information and specific/illustrative information that is presented in two parts:
Generic/common part General information on the SIC sector. Common process steps, abatement systems, energy supply, process equipment and infrastructure that are generally valid for all SIC production processes or common to many SIC production processes. Conclusions on generic BAT are drawn. Specific/illustrative part Specific information on a small number of selected illustrative SIC families to demonstrate the application of BAT in the SIC sector. These illustrative families have been chosen according to the criteria indicated above. Specific BAT conclusions are drawn for each family. The illustrative SIC families are: speciality inorganic pigments phosphorus compounds silicones inorganic explosives cyanides. The exchange of information on soluble inorganic salts of nickel could not lead to drawing BAT conclusions specific to this family. For this reason, there is no specific section in this document covering soluble inorganic salts of nickel. Chapter 1 Chapter 2 Chapter 3 Chapter 4 Chapter 5
Part A
Chapter 6
Part B
Section 6.1 Section 6.2 Section 6.3 Section 6.4 Section 6.5
xxvii
Scope
Noting the introduction of BAT given in Chapter 5, BAT for the production of a speciality inorganic chemical pertaining to one of the illustrative SIC families described in this document is the combination of the generic elements presented in Chapter 5 and the specific elements that can be found in the relevant Section 6.X.5 (i.e. Section 6.1.5 for speciality inorganic pigments, Section 6.2.5 for phosphorus compounds, Section 6.3.5 for silicones, Section 6.4.5 for inorganic explosives and Section 6.5.5 for cyanides). Concerning the production of a SIC substance that does not pertain to one of the illustrative SIC families addressed in this document, only the generic elements presented in Chapter 5 are relevant to define BAT. Users of this document should find that moving from Part A to Part B of this document provides an increasing level of detail and a trend from qualitative to quantitative information. A detailed description of BAT, and associated consumption/emission levels, is only presented for those families described in Part B, although Part A (in Chapter 5) gives generic/common BAT for the SIC sector, and, as far as possible, consumption and emission levels associated with BAT. When considering permit conditions for a plant producing chemicals pertaining to one of the illustrative families, Part B provides specific information on production techniques, consumption and emission levels, process-integrated and end-of-pipe techniques, and BAT. When permitting any other SIC processes, then the information in Part A provides a toolkit that can be used to formulate permit conditions. Interface with other BREFs There are other BREFs in the planned series that may need to be read in conjunction with this document in order to determine BAT for SIC processes. The relevant BREFs include horizontal BREFs (that cover issues common to several industrial sectors or subsectors e.g. Emissions from Storage) and vertical BREFs (that cover a particular industrial sector e.g. Large Combustion Plants). At the time of writing, there are BREFs on the following topics that may be pertinent to the SIC sector: Common Waste Water and Waste Gas Treatment/Management Systems in the Chemical Sector [8, European IPPC Bureau, 2003] Emissions from Storage [31, European IPPC Bureau, 2000] Industrial Cooling Systems [36, European IPPC Bureau, 2003] Monitoring of Emissions [37, European IPPC Bureau, 2003] Economics and Cross-Media Effects [32, European IPPC Bureau, 2004] Large Combustion Plants [34, European IPPC Bureau, 2004] Waste Incineration [35, European IPPC Bureau, 2004] Waste Treatments [29, Cefic, 2004].
This document aims to minimise any overlaps with the relevant horizontal BREFs, but may cover horizontal topics in a greater level of detail. Horizontal BREFs are cited in this document for the sake of completeness/understanding and to alert readers to the existence of complementary information.
xxviii
Chapter 1
The Speciality Inorganic Chemicals (SIC) sector, as defined for the purpose of this document (see Scope section above), would essentially be part of the larger speciality and fine chemicals sector (it may also cross into the pharmaceuticals sector) which represented around 29 % of the total chemical industry sales in Europe in 2002 [29, Cefic, 2004]. It is thought that, in Europe, the SIC sector represents between 10 and 20 % of the total chemical industry sales, and that sales are increasing slightly.
Chapter 1
Chapter 1
1.2.4 Competition
The Speciality Inorganic Chemicals sector is highly competitive and confidential in nature as companies tend to develop niche markets and focus on their competitive advantages. Until recently, Asias strength was as a low cost producer of bulk chemicals. However, companies in Asia (especially China and India) have become much more efficient at making complex speciality products in the last few years. Furthermore, companies in Asia are growing at a much higher rate than companies in Europe. Competition in the SIC sector is generally based on quality as opposed to price (although this is not the case in the inorganic pigments industry), so there is less sensitivity to changes in appreciation of currencies (e.g. EUR/USD) and export sales are generally not considerably affected by such changes. Although labour costs are an important factor for the SIC sector, assets and proximity to customers may be more important. If this is the case, European companies may not be at a disadvantage compared to their Asian competitors.
Chapter 1
Generally, only some of these issues are relevant to individual SIC installations. The enormous variety of possibly produced and handled (also emitted) substances at SIC installations can also include highly harmful compounds having toxic or carcinogenic properties (e.g. cyanides, cadmium, lead, chromium (VI), arsenic). In addition, there are explosives among SIC substances (see Section 6.4). Health and safety can therefore be a crucial issue in the production of SIC substances.
Chapter 2
2 COMMON APPLIED PROCESSES AND TECHNIQUES 2.1 General features of a SIC production process
Although processes for the production of SIC are extremely diverse and sometimes very complex (e.g. silicones), they are typically composed of a combination of simpler activities (or process steps) and equipment. The common activities and equipment are combined and modified to create the chemical process for production of the desired speciality product. Some of the common activities have already been recognised through the preparation of horizontal BREFs (e.g. for cooling systems, bulk storage, waste water and waste gas treatment/management systems). The core activity of a chemical production process is the conversion of raw materials into the desired product(s) using the necessary chemical reactions and physical changes. This typically involves the five general stages described below and shown schematically in Figure 2.1. raw and auxiliary materials supply, storage, handling and preparation1: the supply, storage and handling of the raw and auxiliary materials, their preparation (e.g. weighing, mixing) and their charging into the vessel(s) where the chemical reaction(s) will occur (e.g. reactor, kiln) synthesis/reaction/calcination: the core of every process where raw materials are transformed into a crude product by means of a chemical reaction, often with the aid of a catalyst product separation and purification: the product obtained from the reaction is separated (sometimes in several steps) from other reaction components (e.g. unreacted raw materials, by-products, catalysts) and purified (sometimes in several steps) to the required specification product storage and handling: the storage, packaging and export of the finished products emissions abatement: the collection, re-use, treatment and disposal of unwanted gases, liquids and solids containing those pollutants that have not been addressed by process-integrated measures.
It is important to highlight that in the SIC sector, the quality and purity of raw materials are key factors influencing the environmental impact of the substances produced. It can be noted that there are sometimes opportunities to re-use/recycle into the SIC production process (or in other processes within the industrial site where the SIC installation is located) residues generated particularly in the synthesis/reaction/calcination and the emissions abatement steps. This is exemplified in the family of SIC substances addressed in Chapter 6 of this document (see also Figure 3.1). The five general stages above are complemented by: a comprehensive infrastructure that interconnects the process steps (e.g. cooling systems, vacuum systems, safety systems and facilities) an energy system that produces steam or electrical energy for use in the process, and cooling facilities (where needed) a management system that ensures the control of the process under all scenarios (e.g. normal operation, emergencies). This can be viewed as the software to make all the hardware work.
Chapter 2
As this document does not provide a comprehensive description of all SIC processes, it is important to understand the generic principles of process steps, site infrastructure, energy, and management systems. These fundamental elements should enable a basic understanding of any SIC production process, its potential environmental impact, and suitable techniques in particular for preventing and controlling emissions. The following sections in this chapter therefore describe, in a generic manner, the main features of these fundamentals as applied to the production of SIC. More detailed descriptions of chemical processes and equipment can be found in a standard textbook such as the Ullmanns Encyclopedia of Industrial Chemistry [1, Ullmann, 2001].
Infrastructure Energy
1
Raw materials supply, storage handling and preparation
Management systems
Figure 2.1: Schematic representation of a SIC production process
Chapter 2 Example of SIC substances produced Common process step Likely environmental impact Consumptions Phosphorus compounds Nickel salts Explosives Pigments Cyanides Silicones Energy Water Emissions Waste X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X 7 Water
Dissolution of raw materials Mixing Synthesis/reaction Calcination Washing Drying Dry milling/grinding Wet milling Sieving Condensation Distillation Evaporation Filtration Hydrolysis Extraction Compaction Granulation Briquetting
X X X X X X X X X X X
X X X X X X X X
X X X X X X X X X X X X
X X X
X X
X X X X X X X X X X
X X X X
Table 2.1: Likely environmental impact of the common process steps used in the production of SIC substances
Air X X X X
Chapter 2
Environmental issues Energy: energy may be used in the form of heat or kinetic energy in the dissolution operation. Water: in the production of SIC, the main environmental issue associated with the dissolution of raw materials is the consumption of fresh water. Waste water can sometimes be used as a substitute for the use of fresh water. Waste: waste may be generated in the dissolution of raw materials.
2.2.2 Mixing
Description [1, Ullmann, 2001] Mixing operations can be classified according to the aggregate state of the predominant component (i.e. gaseous, liquid, paste, solid/granular). For liquids, mixing is usually referred to as stirring and for pastes, mixing is usually referred to as kneading. Coarse mixing in mixers for solids is accomplished by the continuous movement of material in the process volume. It must be possible for adjacent particles to change places. Depending on the flowability of the powders being mixed, this can be achieved through a variety of mechanisms and in a variety of geometries. The large number of mixers on the market can be classified under several headings: tumblers screw mixers paddle mixers pneumatic mixers silo mixers high speed mixers.
Mixing of solid components is an important process step in the production of SIC pigments. Environmental issues Air: the mixing of solid fine materials (powder) can generate dust that can be emitted to air. Mixing equipment can be totally or partially enclosed or dust capture systems can be installed on top of mixing equipment in order to minimise diffuse emissions. The ducted dust can be led to an abatement system (e.g. bag filter) to minimise emissions to air. Energy: energy is used in the mixing operations to power equipment (e.g. motors). Noise: mixing involves the use of mechanical equipment which produces noise.
Chapter 2
2.2.3 Synthesis/reaction
Description Synthesis, or reaction, is the core of the production process, as this is where raw materials are transformed into a crude product by means of a chemical reaction (e.g. precipitation), often with the aid of a catalyst in order to increase the production efficiency. The reaction takes place in a reactor (see Section 2.6.1 for the description of a reactor and the associated environmental issues). A synthesis/reaction or a calcination process step is always needed for the production of a SIC substance. Environmental issues Air: emissions to air may arise from the synthesis/reaction operations. VOC or dust emissions can be produced. Water: waste waters may arise from the synthesis/reaction operations. Energy: the reaction can necessitate the use of energy to heat or cool the reactor. Resource: often a catalyst is needed to foster the reaction and reach higher production efficiencies. Wastes: synthesis/reaction can generate residues (e.g. catalysts residues, non-reacted products). Safety: safety may be an issue to consider in synthesis/reaction, especially when the operation involves the use of hazardous compounds. Specific measures may be necessary to meet the requirements of the Seveso II Directive (Directive 96/82/EC) in particular.
2.2.4 Calcination
Description Calcination is an endothermic process that requires heat to decompose chemical compounds. A calcination process step is used in the production of some speciality inorganic pigments (see Section 6.1.2.1.2). Combustion processes involve exothermic oxidation or burning of the feed material. Roasting processes use elevated temperatures and controlled furnace atmospheres to effect the desired chemical reactions in the furnace charge; roasting reactions may be either endothermic or exothermic. Although many furnace technologies exist, current industrial practice favours the rotary kiln and the fluidised-bed reactor for these applications. A rotary kiln is an inclined, rotating cylindrical reactor through which a charge moves continuously. In a fluidised-bed reactor used for calcination purposes, an initially stationary bed of solid particles is brought to a fluidised state by an upward stream of gas as soon as the volume flowrate of the fluid exceeds a certain limiting value. Environmental issues Air: in the calcination process, some products of decomposition can be emitted to the air, e.g. CO2, SOX, NOX, VOCs, particulates (dust). Dust is emitted from the calcination of pigments and needs to be abated. During the calcination of lithopone pigments, sulphur dioxide is liberated and needs to be abated. Energy: calcination requires the consumption of energy.
Speciality Inorganic Chemicals 9
Chapter 2
2.2.5 Washing
Description Washing is often used for eliminating soluble by-products (e.g. salts), e.g. from the production of SIC pigments (see Section 6.1.2.2), and is usually subsequent to the synthesis/reaction or calcination step. In the production of SIC substances, washing is usually performed with water (occasionally, organic solvents may be added to minimise organic impurities, as in the case of the production of SIC explosives see Section 6.4.2.5) Environmental issues Water: the amount of water used is an issue. The waste waters are usually heavily loaded with by-products (e.g. salts).
2.2.6 Drying
Description [1, Ullmann, 2001] Drying denotes the separation of volatile liquids from solid materials by vaporising the liquid and removing the vapour. The liquid that is to be removed in the production of SIC is usually water, but it could also be a solvent such as alcohol or acetone, or a mixture of such solvents. The vaporisation of liquids requires the supply of heat. The product that is to be dried is denoted as the moist solid (e.g. moist cyanide crystals), or simply as the solid. The substance that carries the necessary heat is called the drying agent. This substance could be air, an inert gas, or superheated steam. Heat could also be supplied by radiation, by hot surfaces, or by microwaves. The myriad of dryer types is a consequence of the different behaviour that the solid exhibits during drying, the particular product needs, and many economic considerations. The main types of dryers used in the SIC sector are: spray dryers fluidised-bed dryers rotary dryers static tray dryers (room dryers). Because safety issues do not permit the use of spray, fluidised-bed, or rotary dryers in the production of SIC explosives, static tray dryers are used (see Section 6.4.2.6).
Because drying may cause particles to be lumped together, a subsequent milling operation may be required to obtain the required fine particle size (e.g. in the production of speciality inorganic pigments or in the production of soluble inorganic salts of nickel). Drying is very much used in the production of SIC substances (e.g. speciality inorganic pigments, SIC explosives, cyanides, soluble inorganic salts of nickel). Environmental issues Air: drying processes are potential sources of dust and VOC emissions. Energy: the heat supply implies the consumption of energy (electricity or steam). Water: drying may generate waste water.
10 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Chapter 2
Sections 2.2.7.1, 2.2.7.2, 2.2.7.3 present the main size reduction operations used in the production of SIC substances and their associated environmental impact. 2.2.7.1 Dry milling/grinding Description Dry milling/grinding is the process of reducing materials to fine powder or to small particles in a suitable mill without the presence of a liquid, either by rods, balls, or pebbles, or autogenously, by the material itself. Dry milling/grinding is used if the subsequent process is a dry process or if the substance is intolerant to water or other liquids. With respect to workers safety, attention must be paid to the risk of explosions (dust explosion). Dry milling/grinding is used for example in the production of speciality inorganic pigments (see Section 6.1.2 and Figure 2.1). Environmental issues Air: dry milling/grinding processes are potential sources of dust emissions. Dust (in particular dust containing heavy metals) is emitted for example in the production of SIC pigments and need to be abated (see Figure 6.2). Energy: consumption of electricity to power the motors. Noise: dry milling/grinding involves the use of mechanical equipment which produces noise. Safety: dry milling/grinding may involve risks of explosion (dust explosion, see Section 6.3.4.16).
11
Chapter 2
2.2.7.2 Wet milling Description [1, Ullmann, 2001] Wet milling/grinding is defined as the comminution (reducing to fine powder or to small particles of materials) of solids suspended in a fluid. The principal reasons for using this technique are: the feed is already in the form of a suspension the product is desired as a suspension the feed material has to be finely ground and has a tendency to agglomerate the material is toxic.
Wet milling/grinding combines the actual comminution of the solid particles with the breaking up of agglomerates and the dispersion of the individual particles. In some machines, comminution is the primary objective, whereas in others deagglomeration is the primary function. Comminution devices, with the exception of crushers, impact mills, and jet mills are used for wet grinding. They operate primarily with low to moderate viscosity suspensions. However, roller and high compression roller mills can only be employed at moisture levels of 20 % or less; although some roller mills are made for wet milling. The Szego mill, the roller frame, the agitated ball mill, perl mills, and the disk mill have been especially designed for wet milling. Wet milling is used, for example, in the production of speciality inorganic pigments (see Section 6.1.2 and Figure 2.1). Environmental issues Energy: energy is used in the wet milling operations to power equipment (e.g. motors). Water: the fluid used in wet milling is usually water. Waste water originates from wet milling operations. Noise: wet milling involves the use of mechanical equipment which produces noise. 2.2.7.3 Sieving Description This operation involves passing the particle materials through openings of a particular standard size in a screen in order to make them smaller. Different types of sieving operations exist: gravity sieving mechanical sieving vacuum sieving air classifying.
Sieving is used, for example, in the production of cyanides (see Section 6.5.2.9). Environmental issues Air: sieving processes are potential sources of dust emissions. Energy: energy is used in the sieving operations to power equipment (e.g. motors).
12 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Chapter 2
2.2.8 Condensation
Description Components from gaseous mixtures can be separated into liquids (or solids) by fractional condensation. Either the residual gas or the condensate may be the desired product. The temperature, the partial pressure of the condensing substances and their vapour pressure are linked. The recovery of 100 % of the condensing substances is not possible, whatever the temperature, when inerts are present with the condensing substances. Condensation may be used to separate products from waste water or waste gas streams and this often enables valuable feedstock or solvent to be returned to the production process. Condensation of volatile species is also used to minimise the emission of air pollutants, but this may require the use of cryogenic condensation to achieve the desired lower emissions. Condensation processes are used, for example, in the production of silicones (see Section 6.3.2.6) and phosphorus compounds (see Section 6.2.2.2, Figure 6.10 and Figure 6.11). Environmental issues Air: residual components that are not condensed can be emitted to the air. Water: if the residual gas is the product, condensation will generate waste water. Cooling water may be used. Energy: considerable amounts of energy may be required in the condensation operations. Wastes: residual condensate can be a waste.
2.2.9 Distillation
Description Distillation is the most important industrial method of separating liquids through differences in their boiling points. Distillation involves the partial evaporation of a liquid phase followed by condensation of the vapour. This separates the starting mixture (the feed) into two fractions with different compositions; namely a condensed vapour (the condensate or distillate) that is enriched in the more volatile components and a remaining liquid phase (the distilland) that is depleted of volatiles. Distillation can be divided into sub-categories according to: operating mode (continuous or batch) operating pressure (vacuum, atmospheric or pressurised) number of distillation stages (single or multistage) introduction of inert gases use of additional compounds to aid separation (azeotropic and extractive distillation).
Only a limited number of separation problems may be solved by simple distillation and it is unsuitable for feeds containing components with similar boiling temperatures. Multistage distillation is used, for example, in the production of silicones (see Section 6.3.2.6).
13
Chapter 2
A higher efficiency can be achieved by increasing the contact surface area of the liquid and vapour phases. Rectification columns provide intensive mass transfer by the repeated countercurrent contacting of the vapour and liquid streams in multiple stages. Rectification columns are of the plate or packed design, and may involve more than 100 distillation steps. The internal structure provides a large mass transfer contact surface which is constantly regenerated. The mass transfer contact area is maximised by ensuring that the column packing is completely wet. Heat is required at the bottom of a distillation column for evaporating the feed and condensation energy is needed at the top of the column. The condensation energy is often transferred into cooling water or air, and this may provide an opportunity for energy recovery. Environmental issues Distillation columns may contribute to emissions in three ways: by allowing impurities to remain in the product through polymer formation in the still due to an excessive temperature by inadequate condensing.
Air: off-gases from distillation may contain volatile material in the form of vapour or entrained droplets/mist, although this can be reduced by the use of additional condensing areas. Non-condensable substances (e.g. oxygen, nitrogen, carbon dioxide, low boiling organics) are not usually cooled to their condensation temperature and will exit the condenser. Emission points from distillation are typically: the condenser, accumulator, hot wells, steam jet ejectors, vacuum pumps and pressure relief valves. The total volume of gases emitted from a distillation operation depends upon: air leaks into the column (increases with reduced pressure and increased size); volume of inert carrier gas; gases dissolved in the feed; efficiency/operation of the condenser or other recovery equipment; and physical properties of the organic constituents. Water: depending on the boiling point of the components, effluents may result from aqueous bottom residues or from the top after condensation. Discharges depend on the efficiency of the distillation process and of additional steps for phase separation (preferably fractionated-condensation of the top effluent and stripping of the bottom residues). Wastes: highly concentrated still bottoms are often incinerated if recovery is not possible. Energy: both the heat supply needed to evaporate the liquid phase, and the cold supply to condensate the vapour in the top of the column, imply the consumption of energy which may be very high. When batch distillation is used, the total energy supply could be minimised through optimal selection of reflux-time policies in industrial practice.
14
Chapter 2
2.2.10 Evaporation
Description [1, Ullmann, 2001] Solutions consisting of a solvent and a dissolved solid substance may undergo simple thermal separation by vaporising the solvent, thus concentrating the residual solid. This is a result of the small vapour pressure of most solid components. This method plays an important part in the recovery of many common materials, for example salts (e.g. inorganic salts of nickel) and the like. Evaporation may also serve the purpose of separation and recovery of the pure solvent. It is also possible to use evaporation to concentrate emulsions and suspensions. Usually, the term vaporisation is used when the predominant purpose is recovering the solvent and the term evaporation when the task is separating the solid or increasing its concentration. In designing evaporation plants, particularly in the choice and design of the equipment, a series of points needs careful consideration: chiefly among these, is the operational behaviour of the materials being processed, for example, any tendency towards forming deposits and fouling the heating surfaces, or the residence time of thermally unstable products. Because of their low thermal efficiency, simple single-stage evaporators are seldom used. Their application is limited to systems of small capacity or those in which the product requires short solution residence times due to temperature sensitivity. Multistage evaporation (or cascade evaporation) is an effective means for reducing steam consumption. A number of evaporator stages are connected together in such a manner that the solvent vapours generated in one stage serve as the heating medium for a succeeding stage. Also, only the vapours generated in the last stage must be condensed by a cooling medium, thus reducing cooling water usage. Vapour recompression evaporation is a heat pumping technique. A portion, or the total flow of solvent vapour leaving the evaporator vapour separation chamber, is compressed to a higher pressure and condensed in the steam chest of the same evaporator. In many cases, this processing scheme achieves specific heating steam efficiencies that can only be attained by multistage evaporator systems having as many as three to five stages. Environmental issues Air: evaporation is a potential source of air emissions. Water: the evaporation operations can generate waste waters if vapours are condensed. Energy: energy consumption may be very high in the evaporation operations.
15
Chapter 2
The main solid-liquid separation techniques are: centrifuging filtration sedimentation and clarification drying (see Section 2.2.6).
The choice of technique depends on: the characteristics of the particles and the carrier stream process factors such as temperature and pressure the volume of the carrier stream and the concentration of particles in it to be treated which stream is product and which is waste operational factors such as floor space and headroom economic factors (investment and operational costs).
Environmental issues Air: in case the end-product is not the gas, emissions into the air are released when using the above-mentioned techniques (e.g. fabric filters, ESP) for solid-gas separation. Wastes: it is often possible to re-use solids that are collected by separating devices, although often for lower grade applications.
16
Chapter 2
2.2.12 Hydrolysis
[1, Ullmann, 2001] Description Hydrolysis of compounds usually results in the introduction of a hydroxyl function and is most commonly associated with the elimination of a leaving group X: RX + H2O X ROH + HX In water, the reaction is catalysed mainly by H+ and OH ions. Hydrolysis is a process step used, for example, in the production of silicones (see Section 6.3.2.7). Environmental issues Air: hydrolysis may generate off-gases (e.g. in the production of silicones, see Section 6.3.3.2). Water: waste waters can be generated in the hydrolysis operations (e.g. in the production of silicones, see Section 6.3.3.3). Hydrolysis consumes water.
2.2.13 Extraction
Description Extraction is the most important liquid-liquid separation process used in industrial chemistry. It is used mainly where other separation methods or direct distillation are ineffective or too expensive. Its typical uses include: separation of components with similar boiling points separation of high boilers from aqueous solutions separation of mixtures with high boiling points separation of temperature sensitive compounds separation of azeotropic mixtures (e.g. extraction of acetic acid from aqueous media) separation of pollutants for the minimisation of waste water streams.
In order to extract the desired substance(s) from the solution, an extraction solvent that is immiscible in the solution is added. During the contact called extraction between the feed stream and the solvent, the targeted substance(s) undergo transfer from the initial solution to the solvent. Generally, the desired substance is then separated from the solvent by distillation and the solvent is recycled. Sometimes, the selective action of the solvent is used in combination with distillation (extractive distillation or azeotropic distillation). Various types of mixer-settlers, centrifugal extractors and columns are used as extraction apparatus. Extraction is used, for example, in the production of inorganic salts of nickel. Environmental issues Water: the extracting agent (raffinate) is generally recycled and only a small amount of liquid waste is generated. If water is used as the solvent, it can then be biologically treated once any highly concentrated waste components have been separated. Other extracting agents may require incineration.
Speciality Inorganic Chemicals 17
Chapter 2
2.3 Raw and auxiliary materials and finished products storage and handling
Emissions may arise from the storage of raw and auxiliary materials, finished products and wastes during routine operations, unplanned events or during accidents. The substances used in the production process may be stored as gases, liquids or solids and the storage may take various forms, for example small bags, sacks, drums, Intermediate Bulk Containers (IBC) or tanks. Solids may even be stored in bulk in storage areas where measures are taken in order to prevent diffuse dust emissions (e.g. in the production of silicones), the concretion of hygroscopic materials (e.g. iron sulphate, aluminium sulphate, chloride salts, cyanides) or to avoid unexpected chemical reactions due to exceeding the critical mass of a substance (e.g. ammonium nitrate, iron (II) oxide, activated carbon). Emissions may also occur while materials are being conveyed to and from storage vessels. As part of the production process equipment, storage is subject to risks of over-pressurisation, leakage and equipment failure. HAZard and OPerability studies (HAZOP) are carried out on storage and handling facilities to provide a structured assessment of failure events and their mitigation. Risk analyses using the HAZOP methodology are extensively used in the production of SIC explosives. The detailed design of storage depends on the nature of the substance, the quantity stored and the proximity of environmental receptors. Large, integrated chemical production sites may involve lower risks of spillage because they obviate the need for the loading of transfer vessels (rail or road tankers, or boats), and their transportation and unloading at a destination. However, these sites often necessitate chemicals being pumped through long pipe networks and this introduces risks of failure on remote pipe-runs. With regard to storage, many of the techniques for preventing emissions are used in common ways across industry and in particular the SIC sector. Rather than being described repeatedly in many different BREFs, they are mostly covered in two BREFs; the horizontal BREF on Emissions from Storage [8, European IPPC Bureau, 2003] and the horizontal BREF on Waste Water and Waste Gas Treatment/Management Systems in the Chemical Sector [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003], both of which should be read in conjunction with this document.
18
Chapter 2
Proper process-integrated environmental protection uses all possible physical, chemical, biological and engineering techniques for the prevention, reduction and recycling of residues. Examples are: new synthesis pathways use of purer or even different raw materials and process agents use of purer or different fuels optimisation of process steps improved plant technology, process control and reaction sequences technical adaptations to the process improved use of catalysts and/or solvents recycling of auxiliaries (e.g. washing/rinsing water, inert gases, solvents, catalysts) recycling of residues immediately during the process use of residues as the raw material for other productions (product integration within and/or outside the installation) use of residues for energy generation.
Obviously, the development of completely new pathways for syntheses in existing SIC plants will mostly for economic reasons remain an exception, and will be restricted to products of high economic value. In practice, production-integrated environmental protection will progress continuously as the sum of many individual and maybe small improvements over time.
Waste gas treatment normally takes place directly at source. Only rarely can waste gas streams with different characteristics be treated simultaneously in one central treatment unit. One main reason is that treatment units are normally specifically designed for a particular waste gas composition. Another important reason is that special attention must be paid to the release of toxic and hazardous components and their impact on the surroundings as well as on the safety of the plant. In the SIC sector, given the toxicity and/or hazardous characteristics of many substances (e.g. cyanides, phosphorus compounds), safety is often a crucial issue. Figure 2.2 provides an overview of the abatement systems at a typical SIC installation site and the usual pathways for waste, waste gas and waste water streams.
Speciality Inorganic Chemicals 19
Chapter 2
Waste gas emission Typical site boundaries for the production of SIC
Separation ?
Waste water pretreatment Waste water treatment of total effluent Waste water emission or further treatment in a WWTP
Purification
Waste
Product
Figure 2.2: Overview of the abatement systems used at a typical SIC installation
Abatement systems which are usually located on the premises of the SIC installation and occasionally dedicated to particular processes are: waste gas treatments waste water pretreatments.
Abatement systems which are usually located on the premises of the SIC installation but are not dedicated to particular processes, but occasionally located off-site are: waste water treatment plants, occasionally municipal waste water treatment plants or plants operated by a municipality.
Those which are usually located off-site, but occasionally on the premises of the SIC installation are: waste incineration plants.
20
Chapter 2
Odour Organic gaseous or volatile components Inorganic gaseous or volatile components Organic particulates Inorganic particulates Wet matter Dry matter Technique Separator (pre) Cyclone (pre) Wet dust scrubber (FT) Electrostatic precipitator (FT) Fabric filter (incl. ceramic filter) (FT) Two-stage dust filter (pol) Absolute (HEPA) filter (pol) HEAF (pol) Mist filter (pre, pol) Condenser (pre) Cryocondensation (pre, FT) Wet gas scrubber (water) (FT) Wet gas scrubber (alkaline) (FT) Wet gas scrubber (alkalineoxidation) (FT) Wet gas scrubber (acidic) (FT) Thermal oxidation (FT) Catalytic oxidation (FT) Flaring* (FT) X X X X X X X Dust treatment X X X X X X X X X X X X X Gas treatment X X X X X X X (X) (X) (X) X X X X X X
(X)
(X)
(X) X X X X X X X
X X X X
Combustion gas treatment Dry alkali injection (FT) Semi-dry alkali injection (FT) Wet lime injection (FT) SNCR (FT) SCR (FT) X: primary application (X): secondary application (pre): mainly as pretreatment facility (FT): treatment technique used as final treatment technique (pol): mainly as polishing technique after standard technique * Flaring may only be used in emergency situations
X X X X X
(X)
Table 2.2: Selection of techniques for waste gas emission reduction in relation to the pollutant to be removed
It should be noted that the following techniques identified in the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003] have not been reported to be used in the SIC sector in the course of the elaboration of this document (the reason is that they mainly target organic pollutants in the waste gas): catalytic filtration membrane separation adsorption biofiltration bioscrubbing biotrickling.
21
Chapter 2
X X X (X) d (X) e (X) f X X g X X (X) X Biological treatment techniques X X (X) h (X) h (X) h
X: primary application (X): secondary application 1 Including coagulation/flocculation * Precipitation and sedimentation techniques are often used in combination (see Section 4.4.1) a Only solid b Undissolved organic content c Finely dispersed and low concentration d Ionic organic species e Non-volatile organic content f Volatile organic content g Special incinerator equipment required h Only biodegradable parts j Undissolved heavy metal compounds l In combination with sulphate precipitated as sulphides
Table 2.3: Major waste water contaminants and their respective treatment techniques
22
Chapter 2
It should be noted that the following techniques identified in the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003] have not been reported to be used in the SIC sector in the course of the elaboration of this document (the reason is that they mainly target organic pollutants of the waste water which are not generally pollutants of concern in the production of SIC): oil-water separation wet air oxidation Super Critical Water Oxidation (SCWO) chemical hydrolysis extraction distillation/rectification.
2.6.1 Reactors
Reactors are usually the core operation of a process because they are used for converting the raw materials into crude products. There is a wide range of reactor types, and designs may be very specific to a process, but reactors can be broadly classified according to: mode of operation (continuous or batch): SIC processes use continuous modes of operation (e.g. phosphorus compounds, silicones) as well as batch operations (e.g. inorganic explosives) reaction phase: production of SIC substances may be carried out in reactors as heterogeneously catalysed reactions where gaseous reagents make contact with a solid catalyst to form gaseous products. This has the advantage of avoiding a mixture of product with catalyst or solvent, but has the disadvantages that feed is often applied at high dilution and low conversions are achieved. Gas-liquid reactions are also important, and may be undertaken in a variety of reactors such as continuously stirred tanks, plug flows or bubble column reactors reactor geometry: the flow pattern and manner of contacting the phases. Some typical reactor configurations are: fixed bed tubular fixed bed multi-tubes fluidised-bed.
23
Chapter 2
Reactors are required to withstand a range of corrosive conditions, temperature and pressure and are thus usually made in the SIC sector of steel, glass-lined carbon steel, or coated (e.g. resins, enamel, PTFE) material. The actual design takes into account the following factors: chemistry (the reaction kinetics determine the residence time to achieve the necessary degree of conversion of raw materials into the desired product) mass transfer (the diffusion rate of reacting species) heat transfer (the removal or addition of reaction heat) health and safety of the workers and protection of the environment (the prevention of releases by reaction control).
Other characteristics of reactors are: pressure vessel with jacket, with half-coils outside or inside sized from a few litres (e.g. for inorganic explosives) to 60 m3 equipped with one or more stirrers (impellers) jackets are often fitted around the vessel to provide heat transfer wall baffles are installed inside to prevent the gross rotation (swirl) of the contents with the stirrer.
Under normal operating conditions there are five major sources of waste production in reactors: a primary reaction between feedstocks (raw materials) a secondary reaction subsequent to the primary reaction impurities contained in the raw materials (e.g. benzene in HCN raw material for the production of cyanides) catalyst degradation or loss during cleaning of the reactor the inability to recycle unreacted feedstock back into the reactor.
Effluents seldom originate directly from reactors and, in most cases, the main pollution load results from product separation and purification. Atmospheric emissions to the air from reactors may originate from: direct reactor process vents from liquid phase reactors vents from recovery devices serving streams on liquid phase reactors (enables the recovery of raw materials, products and by-products) process vents from gas phase reactors (after either the primary or secondary product recovery device) exhaust gases from combustion devices applied to any of the above streams fugitive losses from agitator seals, circulating pump seals, safety valves, flanges, valve stem packing, etc.
Reactors are served by inlets (to allow the addition of chemical reagents and inert reaction atmospheres) and outlets (for the removal of products, wastes and emergency venting). There will also be access points for measuring reaction conditions, for maintenance activities and for an agitator to provide full mixing of the reagents. These connections represent potential points of loss and hence the number of these should be minimised. It is also usual for reactors to be served by some form of internal or external heat exchanger to provide for temperature control by either heating and/or cooling. In order to dampen temperature fluctuations and minimise energy losses, a reactor may be insulated.
24
Chapter 2
The emptying and cleaning of reactors are potential sources of losses, and these can be minimised by: reducing internal obstructions installing the drain at the lowest point designing inlets that slope back into the reactor.
This is complemented by operational practices such as keeping the system warm to assist draining, the use of steam cleaning and the planning of production campaigns (when used) to minimise product changes.
The shaft sealing system usually has a gas bleed and this may require abatement.
2.6.3 Pipes
Conduits for the transfer of gases, liquids and solids are an integral part of all production processes. Pipe design is dependent on such factors as operating pressure, temperature and corrosivity of substances, so it is very specific to each installation. Well designed pipes rarely suffer from catastrophic failure and most losses are associated with pipe connections. Pipe connections either have the purpose of joining pipes (i.e. two pieces of straight pipe, changing pipe direction, changing pipe diameter, joining two streams) or linking ancillary process equipment (e.g. pumps, compressors, tanks, valves). These connections may be made by a variety of methods such as flanges, welding, threads. Special considerations are introduced where the pipes are lined. There is a general intention to minimise the length of pipe runs and to minimise the number of connections. Inspection and maintenance regimes are important for minimising fugitive emissions from pipes, especially where pipes are installed in infrequently visited parts of an installation.
25
Chapter 2
2.6.4 Valves
Valves are widely used in installations for controlling or preventing the flow of gases and liquids. The choice and design of valves is very specific to the application. Valve internal parts are usually actuated externally and this necessitates an operating stem. The loss of process fluid from valves is usually prevented by the use of a packed gland seal, in a similar manner to pumps, but under the influence of heat, pressure, vibration and corrosion, the packing can lose its integrity and allow leaks. These losses can be reduced by the use of bellows or diaphragms to isolate valve actuation from the process fluids. However, bellow valves are significantly more expensive than gate valves and their size may pose piping layout problems. Likewise, the use of diaphragm valves may be restricted by the pressures, temperatures and corrosive environments typically encountered in SIC installations. The use of packed valves incorporating live loading spring assemblies mounted on the gland bolts compensates normal packing relaxation or the effects of thermal cycling and vibration. Valve live loading offers considerable improvements in long term sealability on rising stem gate valves, globe valves and regulating control valves. In the US, valve live loading is deemed as MACT (Maximum Achievable Control Technology), equivalent to a bellow valve. On frequently operated rising stem valves (most problematic), live loading offers a considerable improvement in long term emissions performance (<500 ppm for 3 to 5 years) [30, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Valves that fail to perform as designed can have severe environmental implications either for fugitive emissions or catastrophic failure. The risk of mechanical failure can be minimised by an appropriate regime of inspection and maintenance. However, valve failure is more frequently due to incorrect operation and this underlines the need for effective operating procedures.
Chapter 2
In general, evaporative cooling towers for water are designed to ensure that condensed plumes do not reach ground level as this can cause nuisance (loss of light, reduced visibility, icy roads) and contamination (with biocides or micro-organisms). Cooling circuits are also monitored for process fluid contamination using an appropriate indicator parameter (e.g. conductivity) and temperature alarms are fitted to warn of overheating. Cooling can be carried out directly or indirectly. Direct cooling is carried out by injecting water, usually to cool down vapour phases. Indirect cooling is provided by heat exchangers (condensers), where the cooling medium (e.g. water, brines) is pumped in a separate circle. Refrigeration is provided where processes require temperatures below those that can be obtained with cooling water usually by a central site facility. Chlorofluorocarbons (CFCs) or intermediate substances such as hydrochlorofluorocarbons (HCFCs) are not generally used in new refrigeration systems because of their detrimental effect on the ozone layer. The source of cooling is distributed around a site using either chilled water (for temperatures down to about 10 C) or salt brines (down to -30 C). Measures are taken to minimise the loss of refrigerants from pumps, pipe joints, etc. Local detection systems such as Leak Detection And Repair (LDAR) systems may be used for detecting fugitive losses.
27
Chapter 2
The environmental aspects of cooling systems vary with the applied cooling configuration, but the focus is predominantly on increasing the overall energy efficiency and reducing emissions to the aquatic environment. The consumption and emission levels are very site-specific and, where it is possible to quantify them, they show large variations. In the philosophy of an integrated BAT approach, cross-media effects must be taken into account in the assessment of each environmental aspect and the associated reduction measures [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
The choice of the cleaning media depends on the equipment to be cleaned and the substances that need to be removed by the cleaning operation. The cleaning process is finished with water to rinse the equipment and the waste water is treated. The cleaning process can be carried out in different ways: with hoses: cleaning is carried out with pressurised water from a hose to reduce water consumption, and the waste waters are carried towards a WWTP. If solvents are used instead of water, they are collected and recovered where possible Cleaning-In-Place (CIP) systems: CIP systems have been developed to limit emissions, improve efficiency of the cleaning process and for the health and safety of the workers. Cleaning-In-Place systems allow equipment to be cleaned directly inside with water scatterers under pressure and allow washing liquids to be recovered. CIP systems also enable the operator to carry out the cleaning process without the need to take equipment apart or for workers to enter the vessels, which limits workers exposure to potentially harmful substances (see Section 6.5.4.3 and Section 4.5.1).
28
Chapter 2
The ingress of air through seals is a major factor in the efficiency of vacuum systems. Air ingress can be reduced by careful design, correct equipment choice and frequent maintenance. Instrumentation may be used to detect excessive flows.
The following systems are used at SIC installations to store solids: heaps (outdoors or in buildings) sacks and bulk bags silos and bunkers packaging for dangerous solids (e.g. packaging made of primary and secondary receptacles).
Emissions to the environment could occur from the operation of storage systems, whether from normal operating conditions (including transferring substances in and out of storage and cleaning) or from incidents and accidents.
29
Chapter 2
Such emissions can be: emissions to air emissions (discharges) to water (direct/indirect) noise emissions waste emissions.
Further information on the storage systems mentioned in this section and the possible emissions associated with their operation can be found in the ESB BREF [8, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
The following systems are used at SIC installations to transfer and handle solids: dump trucks (e.g. in the production of silicones, see Section 6.3.2.2) suction air conveyors pressure air conveyors bucket elevators (e.g. in the production of silicones, see Section 6.3.2.2).
Further information on the transfer and handling systems mentioned in this section and the possible emissions associated with their operation can be found in the ESB BREF [8, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
30
Chapter 2
31
Chapter 3
In addition, as for any chemical installation, emissions from a given SIC installation vary over time depending on the operating scenario: routine operation non-routine operation (e.g. start up, shut down, maintenance, incident) emergencies (e.g. fires, explosions, accidents) decommissioning.
All this makes it difficult to provide generic consumption and emission levels applicable to the whole SIC sector. However, it is apparent from the information contained in Chapter 6 that SIC installations generally resort to end-of-pipe treatments (e.g. fabric filters, srcubbers) for emission abatement, in particular when hazardous substances are involved. It is considered that the emission levels achieved with the abatement systems used in the SIC sector are generally in line with the emission levels indicated in the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. As SIC processes utilise many common process steps and equipment (see Chapter 2), it is possible to consider (in a generic manner) where emissions may arise (i.e. emission sources) and what type of pollutant those emissions might contain. The following lists of emission sources are neither exhaustive, nor will all mentioned emission sources be present in every SIC process, but the following sections provide a checklist of possible emission sources and components against which assessments on any SIC production process can be made.
33
Chapter 3
Organic compounds SIC substances produced Metal compounds Fluorides P oxides
X X X
X X X
a
X X X X X
X X
VOCs
HCN
Dust
NOx
CO2
NH3
HCl
SO2
X X X X X
Only direct emissions from normal operating conditions are indicated. Some of the pollutants are not systematically present for the given family of SIC substances. a In the production of nickel dinitrate only
Table 3.1: Main pollutants that could be emitted to the air during the production of some SIC substances
Synthesis/reaction/calcination
Possible sources of emissions Discrete vents serving reaction equipment (e.g. purges, inert vents from condensers, let-down vessels, process scrubbers) Vents associated with catalyst preparation and catalyst regeneration Vents on premixing vessels (e.g. dust, heavy metals) Relief devices to maintain safe operation (e.g. pressure relief valves, bursting discs) Possible pollutants emitted
34
Chapter 3
Product handling and storage Detailed information on sources of emissions may be found in the ESB BREF [8, European IPPC Bureau, 2003], but in general terms emissions may arise from:
Possible sources of emissions Possible pollutants emitted Loading/unloading of containers and vessels (tankers for road, rail and ship) Blanketing of storage tanks VOCs Losses from conveyors Particulates VOCs Evaporative losses from spills
Emissions abatement
Possible sources of emissions Waste gas combustion units (e.g. thermal postcombustion units, incinerators) Stripping of waste water (with air or steam) Drains, balancing tanks from waste water collection systems Storage and treatment of solid wastes Possible pollutants emitted Secondary pollutants that did not exist in the original waste stream (e.g. dioxins, particulates), as well as combustion gases Transfer of dissolved organics into the gaseous phase VOCs Particulates
Infrastructure
Possible sources of emissions Possible pollutants emitted Fugitive losses from equipment (e.g. compressors, pumps, valves) Cooling water contaminated with process streams (e.g. from equipment leakage) passing through cooling towers Workspace ventilation is primarily a health and safety issue. Although the pollutant VOCs concentrations are very low in ventilation air, there may be significant mass releases to the air because of the high air volumes involved Analysers and sampling ports Equipment evacuation and cleaning in preparation VOCs for access (e.g. maintenance)
Energy
Possible sources of emissions Combustion units for generating steam, heat and electricity (e.g. process heaters, furnaces) Possible pollutants emitted Usual combustion gases (e.g. COX, NOX, SO2, particulates) and other pollutants (e.g. acid gases, dioxins) if wastes are combusted
Management systems Inadequacies of management systems or failure of operators to adhere to procedures may be the source of process upsets or incidents with possible subsequent air emissions.
35
Chapter 3
3.1.1
Many SIC processes involve the handling of solid materials and diffuse releases of dust and small particulates from joints in conveyors systems, from stockpiles (e.g. elemental silicon dust in the production of silicones), from packaging, etc. are significant issues for many installations. In other processes, where gases or liquids with moderately high vapour pressures are handled, there is always the potential for releases of acid gases, ammonia, VOCs or volatile inorganic compounds from flanges, pumps, agitators and valves with seals, storage tanks, tanker connections, sample points, etc. These fugitive releases can occur through relaxation or progressive wear and tear of sealing materials, through poor operation, maintenance or design, or through failure of equipment. Apart from releases of material through accidental mal-operation or equipment failure, fugitive losses from individual pieces of equipment are often small but on a large-scale installation the aggregated effect can be very significant.
NaCl X X
X X X X X X X X X
Only direct emissions from normal operating conditions are indicated. Some of the pollutants are not systematically present for the given family of SIC substances (e.g. aniline is not present in the manufacturing of CIC pigments).
Table 3.2: Pollutants that could be carried by the waste water discharged to the receiving waters in the production of some SIC substances
36
NH4 X
CN
Sb V Zn Cl
Pb
Chapter 3
The sources of water emissions may include (depending in particular on the process, raw and auxiliary materials, and operating conditions used): Raw and auxiliary materials supply, storage, handling and preparation
Possible sources of emissions Storage tank overflows Mixing vessels (e.g. overflows, wash-down) Spills during loading/unloading Leakage from tanks and pipe systems Possible pollutants emitted HNO3, H2SO4 Pb(NO3)2 HNO3, H2SO4, Pb(NO3)2 HNO3, H2SO4, Pb(NO3)2
Synthesis/reaction/calcination
Possible sources of emissions When water is added as a reactant solvent or carrier Where reaction water is formed in the process (e.g. from a condensation reaction) When water is present in the raw material Process purges and bleeds (especially of mother liquors) Quenching of organic vapour streams Possible pollutants emitted Pb, NO3-, COD
NaCl
Product handling and storage Detailed information on sources of emissions may be found in the ESB BREF [8, European IPPC Bureau, 2003], but in general terms emissions may arise from:
Possible sources of emissions Storage tank overflows Spills during loading/unloading Leakage from tanks and pipe systems Spillage from drums and IBCs Possible pollutants emitted
Emissions abatement
Possible sources of emissions Effluents may utilise neutralising agents (acid or alkali) Air abatement systems (e.g. spent scrubber liquor) Dewatering of sludges Water bleed from seals, drums and knock-out drums Possible pollutants emitted NO3-, NO2-, Pb2+
37
Chapter 3
Infrastructure
Possible sources of emissions Cleaning operations (washing of vessels, pipes and other equipment to facilitate access, e.g. for maintenance purposes) Fire-fighting water Rainwater run-off from floors Diffuse sources (e.g. leaks, spills from process equipment) Oil from mechanical equipment (compressors, etc.) Contamination of condensate from steam ejectors used to create vacuum Water gland seals on vacuum pumps Vapour condensates in pipe runs General site effluents from offices, canteens, laboratories and workshops Water curtains for containment of hydrocarbons and/or absorption of acid gases Possible pollutants emitted VOC (COD), Pb2+, NO3-
BOD5
Energy
Possible sources of emissions Hydrocarbon contamination of water cooling systems (e.g. from equipment leakage) Bleed on the boiler feed-water (containing corrosion inhibitors, biocides and scale) Bleed on the water demineralisation plant Cooling system blowdown Steam condensate contaminated with raw material, product, or waste (e.g. from equipment leakage)
Management systems Water emissions may occur from process upsets or incidents that are attributable to the inadequacies of management systems or the failure of operators to adhere to procedures. Many SIC installations have small and easily treatable aqueous waste streams, but a number of them have effluent streams containing more difficult pollutants such as heavy metal compounds or complexes. Where it is not practicable to prevent the generation of these difficult waste water streams in the first place, they need to be segregated and treated separately.
3.3 Wastes
The form of wastes resulting from SIC production may range from discrete solid items to highly fluid sludges with significant water content. The nature of wastes is very dependent on the process. Wastes may be hazardous due to the presence of toxic organic substances or heavy metals. The component parts of the general SIC production process presented in Section 2.2 (Figure 2.1) provide a useful structure for identifying the potential sources of wastes, and some of these are listed below.
38
Chapter 3
Figure 3.1 shows that the type and amount of wastes generated in a typical SIC installation heavily depend on the following elements: purity of raw and auxiliary materials process-integrated measures taken to reduce waste (e.g. re-use, recycling) integration of the SIC installation into a larger production site quality requirements on the product by customers.
Purity of raw and auxiliary materials Process-integrated measures (e.g. re-use, recycling)
Figure 3.1: Factors on which the type and amount of waste in a typical SIC installation depend
The sources of wastes may include (depending in particular on the process, raw and auxiliary materials, and operating conditions used): Raw and auxiliary materials supply, storage, handling and preparation
Possible sources of wastes Off-specification raw materials Waste packaging (e.g. spent drums, sacks) Product polymerisation in tanks Possible pollutants emitted Heavy metals, nitrates, VOCs
Synthesis/reaction/calcination
Possible sources of wastes Spent catalyst and catalyst support. Catalysts may become spent because of chemical deactivation, physical degradation or fouling. The composition of catalysts varies greatly and is generally subject to a high level of confidentiality in the SIC sector. Many are based on expensive, exotic metals and this prompts recovery (either on or off site) Products of corrosion and erosion inside equipment (e.g. oxides of iron and other metals) Possible pollutants emitted
39
Chapter 3
Explosive waste
Product handling and storage Detailed information on sources of emissions may be found in the ESB BREF [8, European IPPC Bureau, 2003], but in general terms emissions may arise from:
Possible sources of wastes Waste packaging (e.g. spent drums, sacks) Product polymerisation in tanks Possible pollutants emitted Explosive waste
Emissions abatement
Possible sources of wastes Adsorbents used for spill clean-up Solids produced by the abatement of air pollutants (e.g. dust from electrostatic precipitators and bag filters) Solids produced by the abatement of water pollutants (e.g. catalyst solids settled from waste water, filter cake) Possible pollutants emitted
PbCO3, PbSO4
Infrastructure
Possible sources of wastes Decommissioned plant equipment Construction materials (e.g. metal, concrete, insulation) General site wastes from offices, canteens and laboratories Spent cleaning agents Spent oils (lubrication, hydraulic, etc.) Spent heat transfer fluids Possible pollutants emitted
Energy
Possible sources of wastes Ash/soot from furnaces, heaters and other combustion equipment Possible pollutants emitted
Management systems Wastes may occur from process upsets or incidents that are attributable to the inadequacies of management systems or the failure of operators to adhere to procedures.
40 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Chapter 3
Chapter 3
Elsewhere, reporting requirements are such that only some of these waste categories are measured and controlled. In some cases, spent catalysts go for off-site regeneration and/or precious metal recovery, rather than disposal, and are difficult to evaluate. Likewise, SIC installations located on highly integrated chemical production sites may appear to have less waste as they have more opportunities for upgrading waste streams into products.
42
Chapter 4
Cross-media effects
Operational data Applicability Economics Driving force for implementation Example plants Reference literature
43
Chapter 4
The techniques presented are not grouped by environmental issues (e.g. emissions to air, water, soil, energy efficiency) because many techniques address, directly or indirectly, several of these issues. Neither are they grouped in process-integrated and end-of-pipe techniques, because there may not be a clear-cut boundary between the two categories. The reader can refer to Section 2.4 and Section 2.5 of this document in order to make their own judgement on whether a technique presented in this chapter pertains to one category or the other. Techniques that could fit under several of the headings related to the generic approach are grouped under cross-boundary techniques.
4.2 Raw and auxiliary materials and finished products supply, storage, handling and preparation
4.2.1 Recycling or re-use of used containers/drums
Description Suppliers of chemicals and additives take back their empty containers/drums (made of e.g. plastic, wood, metal) for recycling or re-use. The largest size container possible is used, taking into account the material behaviour. Some hygroscopic solid materials may form concrete-like blocks in large containers, under self-pressure (e.g. NaCl, FeSO4, cyanides). Other materials (e.g. sodium azide, nitrates) may present some risk of explosion or unexpected chemical reaction (e.g. self ignition of coal in humid air). Achieved environmental benefits reduction of waste.
Cross-media effects If containers are returned without further cleaning, no cross-media effects apply.
44
Chapter 4
Applicability The technique is only applicable for hard packaging like drums and containers starting with a specific size (60 litres) and is generally not applicable for bags. Only some big bags may be cleaned and recycled under special circumstances. There are generally restrictions for the recycling of containers/drums due to the nature of the product transported (e.g. if toxic/dangerous). Re-use of containers/drums for the same type of product is generally not seen as problematic. In some countries (e.g. Spain) any significant content of toxic/dangerous (raw and auxiliary) material in the packaging can make the disposal of the empty packaging as toxic waste mandatory. This technique is applicable in new and existing installations. Depending on the geographic origin of the containers/drums, it might not be economically viable to use the technique. Economics Economic data differ from site to site and depend on the conditions agreed with the supplier. Driving force for implementation prevention and recycling schemes for waste and packaging waste regulations.
Cross-media effects If soft packaging materials are returned without further cleaning, the following cross-media effect apply: release of contaminants to air and/or water at the place where the packaging is recycled (e.g. paper mill, incinerator) due to the residual contamination in the soft packaging.
45
Chapter 4
Applicability This procedure is applied for small and soft packaging material which cannot be cleaned for re-use and is not contaminated with toxic/dangerous substances. Economics The SIC companies that use the services of companies that recycle packaging materials pay licence fees for all their soft packaging material sold in Germany. Driving force for implementation Prevention and recycling schemes for waste and packaging waste regulations to fulfill the requirements of the Verpackungsverordnung in Germany. Example plants Clariant plant, Germany.
46
Chapter 4
4.3 Synthesis/reaction/calcination
4.3.1 Substitution of raw materials
Description Because impurities in the feed stream contribute to waste generation, one of the most common substitutions is to use a higher purity feedstock. This is accomplished by a combination of the following measures: working with suppliers to get a higher quality feed installing purification equipment at the installation substituting raw materials with less toxic and less water soluble materials to reduce water contamination, and with less volatile materials to reduce fugitive emissions.
Achieved environmental benefits The substitution or elimination of some of the raw materials used in the production of SIC can result in the combination of the following benefits: reduction of the amount of waste generated reduction of emissions to the air reduction of emissions to the receiving water.
Cross-media effects use of energy and materials for purifying the raw materials.
Applicability Applicability depends in particular on the cost of the substitute raw materials purchased, or on the cost of the purification equipment needed at the installation to purify the feedstock. Substitution of raw materials may not be possible in the production of explosives (see Section 6.4) because known impurities can be of paramount importance in obtaining the required product under all security and safety conditions (e.g. effect on shape and size of crystals). Economics Cost of installing and running the purification equipment at the site. Cost savings in the treatment of waste may result from the substitution or elimination of some of the raw materials used. However, this may be more than balanced by the increase of costs of a purer raw material. Driving force for implementation Production time is decreased as cleaning frequency is lower.
47
Chapter 4
Example plants CyPlus, Germany (see Section 6.5.4.10) phosphorus trichloride (PCl3) production plants (see Section 6.2.2.2.1.1 and Section 6.2.4.4): the use of phosphorus raw material (P4) with a low organic impurities content will result in a smaller amount of tarry carbon-mass remaining in the reactor per tonne of PCl3 produced.
Achieved environmental benefits reduction of raw materials consumption avoiding secondary reactions which form unwanted by-products.
Cross-media effects the shape and number of mixer plates, and the rpm of motor(s) have an effect on the consumption of energy.
Economics cost of installing new equipment (e.g. baffles or higher rotation speed motor).
Driving force for implementation Decreasing costs of production by achieving higher yield and generating less waste.
48
Chapter 4
Achieved environmental benefits reduced consumption of catalysts elimination or reduction of residue/by-product formation reduction of the heavy metals content in waste water reduction or elimination of emissions and effluents during catalyst activation reduced energy demand of the reaction.
Applicability Generally applicable in reaction processes that use a catalyst and/or can technically use a catalyst system.
49
Chapter 4
Achieved environmental benefits reduction of emissions to air reduction of emissions to water reduction of the consumption of water reduction of waste.
50
Chapter 4
These techniques are mainly used in combination with other operations, either as a first or a final clarification step. As a first step they, for example, protect other waste water treatment facilities against damage, clogging or fouling by solids. As a final step they remove solids formed during a preceding treatment operation or process, or remove oil before further biological treatment. They often follow treatment techniques applied to soluble pollutants, when these are transferred into solids (e.g. precipitation).
51
Chapter 4
Suspended solids
Sedimentation (including coagulation/flocculation) Air flotation Filtration Membrane filtration (MF, UF)
RECIPIENT
Solid-free (oil-free) waste water can either be segregated into a biodegradable and a nonbiodegradable part, or the contaminants responsible for the non-biodegradability may be separated before further treatment. The treatment techniques for the non-biodegradable waste water part are based on physical and/or chemical operations, such as: precipitation/sedimentation/filtration (see Sections 4.4.1.2.1, 4.4.1.1.1, and 4.4.1.1.3) crystallisation (see Section 4.4.1.2.2) chemical oxidation (see Section 4.4.1.2.3) chemical reduction (see Section 4.4.1.2.4) nanofiltration/reverse osmosis (see Section 4.4.1.2.5) adsorption (see Section 4.4.1.2.6) ion exchange (see Section 4.4.1.2.7) evaporation (see Section 4.4.1.2.8) stripping (see Section 4.4.1.2.9) incineration (see Section 4.4.1.2.10).
52
Chapter 4
After adequate treatment at the SIC installation, the waste water stream can either be discharged into a receiving water body, into a subsequent central biological WWTP or a municipal WWTP. In the SIC sector, most of the waste water content is inorganic and non-biodegradable. Biodegradable waste water or the remaining waste water part after elimination of the cause of the non-biodegradability normally undergoes treatment techniques, either centralised or decentralised, that are based on biological processes, such as: anaerobic biological aerobic biological nitrification/denitrification.
These biological processes are described in the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. The degraded waste water leaves the biological treatment plant and is piped to a clarification stage. Many waste water treatment techniques require or optionally use treatment aids, which in most cases are chemicals, or the treatment media/equipment need regeneration, which can cause the release of chemicals. These aids or process steps might generate, generally depending on local conditions, a pollution that needs to be taken into account when considering the use of a treatment technique. Thus, an assessment of treatment aids and chemicals released from regeneration facilities and their fate during the whole process might be necessary in specific situations. Almost all waste water treatment techniques have one thing in common: the production of solids during the process, which enables the pollutant to be separated from the aqueous medium, such as excess activated sludge or filtered or settled residue from filtration or sedimentation operations. If sludge is not recycled, it needs to be disposed of i.e. external treatment and disposal or treated on the site. Sludge treatment techniques are, e.g. thickening (see Section 4.4.4.1) dewatering (see Section 4.4.4.1) stabilisation (see Section 4.4.4.2) conditioning (see Section 4.4.4.2) thermal sludge reduction (see Section 4.4.4.3).
Description Sedimentation or clarification means the separation of suspended particles and floating material by gravitational settling. The settled solids are removed as sludge from the bottom, whereas floated material is skimmed from the water surface. When the particles cannot be separated by simple gravitational means, e.g. when they are too small, their density is too close to that of water or they form colloids, special chemicals are added to cause the solids to settle (e.g. aluminium sulphate, ferric sulphate, ferric chloride). For additional information on the description, application and advantages and disadvantages of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
53
Chapter 4
Achieved environmental benefits separation of heavy metals or other dissolved components after preceding precipitation (see Section 4.4.1.2.1), often with chemical support (e.g. flocculant), followed at the end by filtration processes (see Sections 4.4.1.1.3 and 4.4.1.1.4) clarifying collected rainwater from solid contents such as sand or dust in a sedimentation tank clarifying process waste water from reaction material such as emulsified metal compounds, supported by the addition of appropriate chemicals.
Cross-media effects sedimented sludge and skimmed scum, if not suitable for recycling or other use otherwise, need to be disposed of as waste. Depending on the waste water origin, this waste might contain hazardous compounds to be treated accordingly. These compounds can be carbonates, fluorides, sulphides or hydroxides (or oxides) of heavy metals, oily scum, etc. consumption of chemicals (coagulant/flocculant) consumption of energy noise and odour may be an issue.
Operational data see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
54
Description Flotation is a process where solid or liquid particles or particulates are separated from the waste water phase by becoming attached to air bubbles. The buoyant particles accumulate at the water surface and are collected with skimmers. Flocculant additives, such as aluminium and ferric salts, activated silica and various organic polymers, are commonly used to support the flotation process. Their function, besides coagulation and flocculation, is to create a surface or a structure able to absorb or entrap the air bubbles. For additional information on the description, application, limits/restrictions and advantages and disadvantages of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits separation of heavy metals from waste water removal of pigments from respective production waste water recovery of product or raw material, e.g. silver halides from production of photographic chemicals.
Cross-media effects the separated material, if not recyclable, is disposed of as waste. The amount depends on the material to be removed and the amount of coagulant and flocculant chemicals. Those can be quite different, according to the respective application of air flotation consumption of chemicals (coagulant and flocculant) consumption of energy.
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
55
Description Filtration describes the separation of solids from waste water effluents passing through a porous medium. Filters typically require a cleaning operation backwashing with reverse flow of fresh water and the accumulated material returned to the sedimentation tank (see Section 4.4.1.1.1). Commonly used types of filter systems are, e.g. the granular-medium filter, or sand filter, which is widely used as a waste water treatment device (the medium of sand filters need not be literally sand), mainly used with a low solids content the gravity drum filter, used for sewage treatment and removal of activated sludge flocs, its efficiency dependent on the screen fabric the rotary vacuum filter, well suited to pre-coat filtration, which is used for oily sludge dewatering and slop de-emulsification the membrane filter (see Section 4.4.1.1.4) the belt filter press, which is largely used for sludge dewatering, but also for liquid/solid separation operations the filter press, which is usually used for sludge dewatering, but also for liquid/solid operations, suitable for a high solids content.
In waste water treatment, filtration is frequently used as the final separation stage after sedimentation processes (see Section 4.4.1.1.1) or flotation (see Section 4.4.1.1.2), if low emissions of particulates are wanted. For additional information on the description, application, limits/restrictions and advantages and disadvantages of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits separation of floc, heavy metal hydroxides, etc. after sedimentation, to cope with discharge requirements dewatering of sludge, floating material, etc.
Cross-media effects consumption of water for backwashing filter aids energy noise and odour may be an issue.
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
Description Microfiltration (MF) and Ultrafiltration (UF) are membrane filtration processes that segregate a liquid that permeates through a membrane into permeate, which passes the membrane, and concentrate, which is retained. The driving force of the process is the pressure difference across the membrane. Membranes used for MF and UF are pore type membranes which operate like sieves. The solvent and particles of molecular size can pass the pores, whereas suspended particles, colloidal particles, bacteria, viruses, and even larger macromolecules are held back. For additional information on the description, application, limits/restrictions and advantages and disadvantages of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits Membrane filtration (MF and UF) is applied when a solid-free waste water for downstream facilities, e.g. reverse osmosis, or the complete removal of hazardous contaminants such as heavy metals, is desired. The choice between MF and UF depends on the particle size. Cross-media effects consumption of membrane material membrane treatment produces a residue (concentrate) of approximately 10 % of the original feed volume, in which the target substances are present at levels approximately 10 times their concentration in the original feed. An assessment should be made as to whether this residue can be disposed of consumption of chemicals (e.g. antifouling) consumption of energy.
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
57
Chapter 4
Description Precipitation is a chemical way to form particulates that can be separated by an additional process, such as sedimentation (see Section 4.4.1.1.1), air flotation (see Section 4.4.1.1.2), filtration (see Section 4.4.1.1.3) and if necessary followed by microfiltration or ultrafiltration (see Section 4.4.1.1.4). Fine separation by membrane techniques might be necessary to protect downstream facilities or to prevent the discharge of hazardous particulates. It might also be a useful technique to remove colloidal precipitates (e.g. heavy metal sulphides). A precipitation facility usually consists of one or two stirred mixing tanks, where the agent and possibly other chemicals are added, a sedimentation tank and storage tanks for the chemical agents. If needed as mentioned above further treatment equipment is added. The sedimentation tank might be replaced downstream by other sludge collecting systems. For additional information on the description, application and advantages and disadvantages of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits When used in conjunction with other techniques, precipitation enables: reduction of the heavy metals, sulphates, and fluorides concentration in the released waste water possibility to recover heavy metals and to recycle them back into the SIC production or in productions outside of the SIC installation.
Cross-media effects The main cross-media effects are: consumption of precipitation chemicals (e.g. lime, dolomite, sodium hydroxide, sodium carbonate, sulphuric acid), flocculants and/or coagulants consumption of chemicals to regulate the pH (e.g. NaOH, H2SO4) the precipitants usually have to be disposed of as sludge.
Noise and/or odour can also be an issue. For more information on this, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Operational data Operational data are presented in Table 4.2.
58
Chapter 4
Parameter Aluminium Cadmium Chromium (III) Chromium (VI) Total chromium Cobalt Copper Performance rate (%) Emission level (mg/l) 0 5.8 7 <0.01 7 <0.1 5 0.1 3 0.08 4 <0.05 7 1 2.5 5 0.07 4 0.01 4 0 0.08 7 In the absence of free NH3 or other Ca2+ complexing agents Precipitation chemical Flocculants Coagulants Remarks
Fluoride
<50 6
Ca(OH)2
Na2CO31, H2SO41
1 Values achieved at a SIC installation before discharge to a WWTP when lead is the only inorganic pollutant in the waste water 2 Values achieved at a SIC installation when lead is present together with chloride, fluoride, boron, vanadium, manganese and zinc in the waste water 3 Annual average from a SIC installation after pretreatment and before discharge to a biological WWTP 4 Measurement from a SIC installation after pretreatment and before discharge to a municipal WWTP 5 From a SIC installation after pretreatment and before discharge to a central WWTP 6 TWG comment 7 See Table 6.10
Table 4.2: Operational data associated with the use of precipitation techniques
Achievable emission levels for heavy metals vary greatly, depending on the particular situation, such as: removal of a single heavy metal species from an inorganic waste water matrix removal of a heavy metal mix from an inorganic waste water matrix removal of heavy metals from an organic waste water matrix with a tendency for formation of metal complexes, e.g. dye agents.
59
Chapter 4
Description Crystallisation is closely related to precipitation. In contrast to precipitation, the precipitate is not formed by a chemical reaction in the waste water, but is produced on seed material such as sand or minerals, working in a fluidised-bed process a pellet reactor system. The pellets grow and move towards the reactor bottom. The driving force of the process is the reagent dosage and pH adjustment. No waste sludge arises. For additional information on the description, application and advantages and disadvantages of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits abatement or recovery of heavy metals.
Cross-media effects consumption of reagents to form the precipitates presence of the reagent in the waste water noise.
Operational data see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
60
Description Chemical oxidation is the conversion of pollutants by chemical oxidation agents other than oxygen/air or bacteria to similar but less harmful or hazardous compounds and/or to shortchained and easily biodegradable organic components. Chemical oxidation is normally applied when the waste water contains contaminants that are not readily biodegradable, or not biodegradable at all (e.g. inorganic components), might disturb the biological or physico-chemical process in a downstream WWTP or have properties too harmful to allow them to be released into a common sewerage system. Oxidation reactions with active oxygen (ozone, hydrogen peroxide), often accompanied by UV irradiation, are used, e.g. to treat leachates from landfills or remove refractory COD, odorous components or colour pigments. Oxidation reactions are used to treat waste waters loaded with cyanides (see Section 6.5.4.1). For additional information on the description, application and advantages and disadvantages of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits conversion of pollutants to less harmful or hazardous compounds.
Operational data see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
61
Description Chemical reduction is the conversion of pollutants by chemical reduction agents to similar but less harmful or hazardous compounds. Common chemical reducing agents are, e.g. sulphur dioxide sodium hydrogen sulphite/metabisulphite ferrous sulphate sodium sulphide and sodium hydrogen sulphide urea or amidosulphonic acid (at a low pH).
They are brought into contact with the waste species under appropriate pH and concentration conditions. Chemical reduction normally results in products that can be treated more easily in downstream treatment facilities such as chemical precipitation. Chemical reduction is used to treat waste waters loaded with chromium (VI) in the production of some speciality inorganic pigments (see Section 6.1). For additional information on the description, application and advantages and disadvantages of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits conversion of contaminants to less harmful or hazardous compounds.
Examples of such contaminants are: chromium (VI), which is reduced to chromium (III) chlorine or hypochlorite, which are reduced to chloride hydrogen peroxide, which is reduced to water and oxygen nitrite, using urea or amidosulphonic acid at a low pH.
Cross-media effects use of reduction agent (e.g. sulphur dioxide, ferrous sulphate).
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
62
Description A membrane process is the permeation of a liquid through a membrane, to be segregated into permeate that passes the membrane and concentrate that is retained. The driving force of this process is the pressure difference across the membrane. NF and RO membranes can hold back all particles down to the size of organic molecules and even ions. Provided that the feed is particle-free, these membranes are mainly used when complete recycling of permeate and/or concentrate is desired. NF is applied to remove larger organic molecules and multivalent ions in order to recycle and re-use the waste water or reduce its volume and simultaneously increase the concentration of contaminants to such an extent that subsequent destruction processes are feasible. RO is a process to separate water and the dissolved constituents down to ionic species. It is applied when a high grade of purity is required. The segregated water phase is recycled and reused. An example of this is the final removal of heavy metals. NF and RO are often used in combination with post-treatment techniques for the permeate, e.g. ion exchange or GAC adsorption. For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits removal of heavy metals from waste water.
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
63
Description Adsorption is the transfer of soluble substances (solutes) from the waste water phase to the surface of solid, highly porous, particles (the adsorbent). The adsorbent has a finite capacity for each compound to be removed. When this capacity is exhausted, the adsorbent is spent and has to be replaced by fresh material. The spent adsorbent either has to be regenerated or incinerated. The most common adsorbents for adsorptive waste water purification in the SIC sector is activated carbon. It is used as a granulate (GAC) in columns or as a powder (PAC) dosed to a treatment tank or basin. Other common inorganic adsorbents are activated alumina or granular ferric hydroxide, suitable for removal of anions (e.g. phosphate, arsenate, antimonite). Since the adsorbent active surface is often liable to clogging and blockage, the waste water needs to be free from solid content as completely as possible, which often makes an upstream filtration step necessary. For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits removal of heavy metals from waste water removal of COD and particles causing coloration of waste water.
Cross-media effects consumption of adsorbent (e.g. activated carbon) consumption of energy and/or chemicals for regenerating the adsorbent release of contaminants to water and/or air during the regeneration process disposal of the adsorbent if it cannot be regenerated.
For additional information on the cross-media effects please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Operational data Operational data are presented in Table 4.3.
Parameter COD Performance rate % 60 1 Emission level mg/l <600 1 Remarks GAC, room temperature
Table 4.3: Operational data associated with the use of the adsorption technique
64
Chapter 4
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
Driving force for implementation Reduction of COD levels and removing particles causing coloration of waste water. Example plants UEB plant in Galdcano, Spain.
65
Description Ion exchange is the removal of undesired or hazardous ionic constituents of waste water and their replacement by more acceptable ions from an ion exchange resin, where they are temporarily retained and afterwards released into a regeneration or backwashing liquid. Ion exchange is feasible as an end-of-pipe treatment, but its greatest value lies in its recovery potential. It is commonly used as an integrated operation in waste water treatment, e.g. to recover rinse-water and process chemicals. For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits removal of heavy metal ions (cationic or anionic, e.g. Cr3+ or cadmium and its compounds, with low feed concentrations, CrO42- also with high feed concentrations) from waste water ionisable inorganic compounds, such as H3BO3.
Cross-media effects consumption of ion exchange resins consumption of energy and chemicals for regenerating the resins release of contaminants to water during the regeneration process.
For additional information on the cross-media effects, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Applicability generally applicable.
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
66
Description Evaporation of waste water is a distillation process where water is the volatile substance, leaving the concentrate as the bottom residue to be disposed of. The aim of this operation is to reduce the volume of waste water or to concentrate mother liquors. The volatile steam is collected in a condenser and the condensed water is, if needed after subsequent treatment, recycled. Operating under vacuum decreases the boiling temperature and enables the recycling of substances that would otherwise decompose. When material recovery is the main purpose, a pretreatment operation is required before evaporation can be started. Examples of pretreatments are: addition of acids, bases, etc. to lower the volatility of molecular compounds separation of insoluble, free liquid phases, e.g. oil chemical/physical operations to separate heavy metals and/or other solids.
Further treatment, e.g. incineration, after evaporation is required, if the concentrate is not recycled. For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits recovery of valuable substances removal of contaminants from the waste water effluent.
For additional information on the cross-media effects, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Applicability generally applicable.
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
Description Waste water stripping is an operation in which waste water is brought into contact with a high flow of a gas current in order to transfer volatile pollutants from the water phase to the gas phase. The pollutants are removed from the stripping gas so it can be recycled into the process and re-used. Volatile organics and inorganics are transferred from waste water to waste gas, greatly increasing the surface area of the contaminated water exposed. Water evaporation, however, decreases the temperature of the waste water, thus decreasing the volatility of the contaminants. Stripping is applied to separate volatile contaminants from water, e.g. ammonia and hydrogen sulphide, their volatility is strongly dependent on temperature and pH, thus pH control is essential (pH >9.5 with ammonia, pH 2 to 3 with hydrogen sulphide) ammonia and hydrogen sulphide together in a two-stage steam stripping unit.
For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits recovery of valuable substances removal of contaminants from the waste water effluent.
Cross-media effects consumption of energy consumption of chemicals to adjust pH consumption of antifouling agents.
Stripping is not used as an individual process. It needs at least downstream gas treatment. The removed volatiles are either recycled to a production process or treated (scrubbing, adsorption, thermal or catalytic oxidation). Generally speaking, the treatment of the stripping gas is an essential process step and sometimes more complicated than the stripping operation itself. To obtain an efficient treatment in total, both the stripping stage and the stripping gas treatment have to be carefully adjusted to each other. For additional information on the cross-media effects, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Applicability generally applicable.
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
Description Waste water incineration is the oxidation with air of organic and inorganic waste water contaminants and the simultaneous evaporation of the aqueous part at normal pressure and a temperature range between 730 and 1200 C, or below that range when catalysts are used. In the chemical industry, waste water incineration is often operated centrally or, as co-incineration, in waste combustion plants. Reaction products are carbon dioxide, water and other inorganic compounds (nitrogen oxides, sulphur oxides, hydrogen halides, phosphates, heavy metal compounds), depending on the contaminants present. For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits removal of contaminated waste water.
Cross-media effects consumption of supporting fuel (when the process cannot be operated autothermally) generation of waste gas from incineration (combustion exhaust gas potentially containing HCl, SOX, NOX, etc.).
For additional information on the cross-media effects, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Applicability The technique applies when the contaminated waste water: is not readily biodegradable might disturb the biological process in a downstream biological WWTP have properties too harmful to be released into an ordinary sewerage system.
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
69
Chapter 4
Source
Mixing Grinding /milling Drying
Temperature Humidity pH Dust caracteristics: Morphology/size of particles Particle weight Particle hardness Sticking properties Temperature of particles Properties of the carrier gas: Flowrate Temperature Humidity pH
Abatement
(individual or in combination)
Temperature
Scrubber
(neutral or alkaline)
includes conveying
Figure 4.2: Main sources of dust and abatement techniques used in the SIC sector
4.4.2.1.1 Separators
Description The waste gas stream is passed into a chamber where the dust, aerosols and/or droplets are separated from the gas under the influence of gravity/mass inertia, the effect increased by reducing the gas velocity by design means, e.g. baffles, lamellae or metal gauze. A separator is usually installed as a preliminary step to various dust filter systems, scrubbers, cooling towers, etc. It is used, e.g. to prevent entrainment of the washing liquid with the purified waste gas and/or to remove abrasive particles. It is not applicable to treat particulates in fluegas. For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits prevent entrainment of the washing liquid with the purified waste gas remove abrasive particles to protect dust filter systems.
70
Chapter 4
Cross-media effects residues are the separated dust and/or the separated droplets which have to be disposed of when re-use/recirculation is not possible. Depending on its source, the separated dust might be contaminated with a toxic and hazardous content which needs to be considered for further treatment or disposal consumption of energy for powering fans.
Performance rate % 10 90 1
Table 4.4: Operational data associated with the use of the separator technique
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
71
Description Cyclones use inertia to remove particles from the gas stream, imparting centrifugal forces, usually within a conical chamber. They operate by creating a double vortex inside the cyclone body. The incoming gas is forced into circular motion down the cyclone near the inner surface of the cyclone tube. At the bottom, the gas turns and spirals up through the centre of the tube and out of the top of the cyclone. Particles in the gas stream are forced towards the cyclone walls by the centrifugal force of the spinning gas but are opposed by the fluid drag force of the gas travelling through and out of the cyclone. Large particles reach the cyclone wall and are collected in a bottom hopper, whereas small particles leave the cyclone with the exiting gas. For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits Cyclones are used to control particulate material, and primarily for PM >10 [m. There are, however, high efficiency cyclones designed to be effective even for PM2.5. Cyclones themselves are generally not adequate to meet air pollution regulations, but they serve a purpose as precleaners for more expensive final control devices such as fabric filters (see Section 4.4.2.1.5) or electrostatic precipitators (see Section 4.4.2.1.4). They are extensively used after spray drying operations and after crushing, grinding and calcining operations. Cross-media effects if it is not recycled back into production, dust recuperated is emitted as a residue and has to be disposed of. The amount depends on the dust load of the waste gas. Depending on its source, the separated dust can be contaminated with toxic and/or hazardous substances.
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
72
Description Wet dust scrubbing is a variation of wet gas scrubbing (see Section 4.4.2.2.4), using the same or equivalent techniques to abate or recover particulate matter additionally to gaseous compounds. The different scrubbers operated are mainly: fibrous packing scrubbers moving bed scrubbers plate scrubbers spray towers impingement entrainment scrubbers venturi scrubbers.
For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits abate or recover PM.
Remarks Dependent on scrubber type used Dependent on scrubber type used Achieved with venturi scrubbers Achieved with venturi scrubbers
Table 4.5: Operational data associated with the use of wet dust scrubbers
73
Chapter 4
Economics See the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Example plants OMG in Harjavalta, Finland.
74
Description An ESP is a particulate control device that uses electrical forces to move particles entrained within a waste gas stream onto collector plates. The entrained particles are given an electrical charge when they pass through a corona where gaseous ions flow. Electrodes in the centre of the flow lane are maintained at high voltage and generate the electrical field that forces the particles to the collector walls. The pulsating DC voltage required is commonly in the range of 20 100 kV. Ion blast ESPs operate typically in the range of 100 150 kV to provide superior separation efficiency particularly in the sub-micron area. For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits ESPs are applied to remove particulate matter down to PM2.5 and smaller and hazardous air pollutants, such as most metals (with the notable exception of mercury). Cross-media effects consumption of energy.
Remarks
5 15 1
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
Description In a fabric filter, waste gas is passed through a tightly woven or felted fabric, causing particulate matter to be collected on the fabric by sieving or other mechanisms. Fabric filters can be in the form of sheets, cartridges or bags (the most common type) with a number of the individual fabric filter units housed together in a group. The dust cake that forms on the filter can significantly increase the collection efficiency. Fabric filters are useful to collect particulate matter with electrical resistivities either too low or too high for ESPs. The addition of a baghouse downstream of an ESP has been found to achieve very low particulate emissions. When the waste gas loading consists of relatively large particulates, upstream mechanical collectors such as cyclones, ESPs or spray coolers may be used to reduce the load for the fabric filter, especially at high inlet concentrations. For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits Primarily the fabric filter is used to remove particulate matter down to <PM2.5 and hazardous air pollutants in particulate form (PMHAP), such as metals (with the exception of mercury). In combination with injection systems (including adsorption, dry lime/sodium bicarbonate injection and semi-dry lime injection) upstream of the baghouse, it can also be applied to remove specific gaseous contaminants. Cross-media effects consumption of filter fabric consumption of energy.
Table 4.7: Operational data associated with the use of fabric and ceramic filters
76
Chapter 4
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
77
Description The two-stage dust filter contains metal gauze as filter material. A filter cake is built up in the first filtration stage and the actual filtration takes place in the second stage. Depending on the pressure drop across the filter, the second stage is cleaned and the system switches between the two stages (step one becomes the second and vice versa). A mechanism to remove the filtered dust is integrated in the system. The dust drops to the bottom of the chamber where it has to be removed. Since metal gauze has a larger load capacity than a fabric filter, less filter area (i.e. less filter material) is required. This advantage, however, is usually eliminated because of the two-stage system. For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits Primarily the two-stage dust filter is operated to remove particulate matter. In combination with injection systems (including adsorption, semi-dry lime injection), it can also be used to remove specific gaseous contaminants. Cross-media effects if it is not recycled back into production, the separated dust has to be disposed of accordingly. This type of dust might be classified as hazardous waste consumption of filter material consumption of compressed air for cleaning consumption of energy.
Performance rate %
Table 4.8: Operational data associated with the use of two-stage dust filters
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
Description The filter medium is paper or matted glass fibre with a high packing density. The waste gas stream is passed through the filter medium, where particulate matter is collected. The dust cake that forms on the filter medium can increase collection efficiency. HEPA filters are applicable to submicron particulate matter between PM0.12 and PM0.3 as well as hazardous air pollutants that are in particulate form, such as most heavy metals (except mercury). HEPA filters are best applied in situations where a high collection efficiency of submicron particulate matter is required, and where toxic and/or hazardous particulate matter cannot be cleaned by other filters, e.g. chemical and biological material. They are installed as the final component in a collection system, downstream from other devices such as ESP or bag filters. HEPA filters require pre-filtering to remove large particulate matter, such as cyclones or venturi scrubbers to reduce large PM, and standard bag or cartridge filters to filter out particulate matter >PM2.5. For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits submicron particulate matter between PM0.12 and PM0.3 is abated along with hazardous air pollutants that are in particulate form, such as most heavy metals (except mercury).
Cross-media effects if it is not recycled back into production, the separated dust has to be disposed of accordingly. This type of dust might be classified as hazardous waste consumption of filter material consumption of energy.
Remarks
Table 4.9: Operational data associated with the use of HEPA filters
Chapter 4
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
80
Description An HEAF is a flat bed filter in which aerosols combine into droplets. Highly viscous droplets remain on the filter fabric and can eventually clog the filter. When a preset value of pressure difference is reached, the filter fabric has to be replaced by a new and clean filter, which can be exchanged during continuous operations, because the filter fabric is set on a roll. The treated waste gas leaves the treatment device via a mist filter, which has to separate the entrained layer of viscous droplets. For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits Aerosols are removed, e.g. condensable VOCs.
Performance rate % 99 1 99 1
Remarks
Table 4.10: Operational data associated with the use of HEAF filters
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
81
Description The most common mist filters (mist eliminators, demisters) are mesh pads. Mesh pad filters usually consist of woven or knitted metallic or synthetic material monofilament in either a random or specific configuration and are operated as deep bed filtration, which takes place over the entire depth of the filter. Solid dust particles remain in the filter until it is saturated and thus has to be cleaned by flushing. When the mist filter is used to collect droplets and/or aerosols, it is usually self-cleaning, drained by the liquid. They work by mechanical impingement and are velocity-dependent. Baffle angle separators are also commonly used as mist filters. The basis for the filter dimension is the waste gas flowrate, the outlet contents and the filter load. Mist filters are designed to remove specific particle sizes. Because of the plugging potential of high efficiency mesh pads, cleaning is necessary on a regular basis. If cleaning is neglected, the contaminants can solidify deep inside the pads and further pad flushing becomes ineffective. For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits misty pollutants, such as droplets and aerosols are removed. When the filter material is cleaned in-situ, they are also applicable to solid particles soluble in liquids. Owing to clogging, they are less suitable for solid dusts and greasy vapours. They protect equipment from solid/liquid dust particles to prevent wear and friction on blower bearings and housings.
High efficiency mist filters can be used as primary devices. They are an increasingly viable option with regard to removal efficiency, water saving and economics in many processes that evolve mists such as sulphuric acid, nickel compounds, sodium hydroxide, nitric acid and chromium compounds. Cross-media effects consumption of filter material consumption of washing liquid consumption of energy.
Performance rate % 99 1 99 1
Remarks
Table 4.11: Operational data associated with the use of mist filters
82
Chapter 4
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
83
Chapter 4
4.4.2.2 Waste gas treatment techniques to abate VOCs and inorganic compounds
4.4.2.2.1 Membrane separation
Description Membrane separation of gases takes into account the selective permeability of organic vapours when permeating through a membrane. Organic vapours have a considerately higher permeation rate than oxygen, nitrogen, hydrogen or carbon dioxide (10 to 100 times higher). The waste gas stream is compressed and passed over the membrane. The enriched permeate can be recovered by methods such as condensation (see Section 4.4.2.2.2) or adsorption (see Section 4.4.2.2.3), or it can be abated, e.g. by catalytic oxidation (see Section 4.4.2.2.8). The process is most appropriate to higher vapour concentrations. Additional treatment is, in most cases, needed to achieve concentration levels low enough to discharge. Membrane separators are designed as modules, e.g. as capillary modules, manufactured as a polymer layer. A membrane separation system consists of: the membrane modules a compressor a recovery unit (e.g. condenser, adsorber) vents and ducts possibly a second stage for further treatment.
To create the necessary pressure difference between the feed and permeate sides of the membrane (0.1 1 MPa), the system works either by means of excess pressure on the feed side and vacuum (about 0.2 kPa) on the permeate side or both. During the rise of vapour concentration within the membrane unit, the concentration level can climb below to above the explosive limit and thus develop an explosive mixture. Safety is therefore a crucial issue and steps have to be taken to avoid these situations or to handle the risk. For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits VOC recovery.
84
Chapter 4
Remarks VOC recovery, upstream and downstream condensation unit Process for hydrocarbon recovery, upstream condensation unit
Table 4.12: Operational data associated with the use of membrane separation
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
85
Description Condensation is a technique that eliminates solvent vapours from a waste gas stream by reducing its temperature below its dew point. There are different methods of condensation, depending on the operating temperature range: coolant condensation, condensation temperature down to about 25 C refrigerant condensation, condensation temperature down to about 2 C brine condensation, condensation temperature down to about -10 C ammonia brine condensation, condensation temperature down to about -40 C (one-stage) or -60 C (two-stage) cryogenic condensation, condensation temperature down to about -120 C, in practice often operated between -40 and -80 C in the condensation device closed-cycle inert gas condensation.
Condensation is carried out by means of direct (i.e. contact between gas and cooling liquid) or indirect cooling (i.e. cooling via heat exchanger). Indirect condensation is preferred because direct condensation needs an additional separation stage. Recovery systems vary from simple, single condensers to more complex, multi-condenser systems designed to maximise energy and vapour recovery. Cryogenic condensation can cope with all VOC and volatile inorganic pollutants, irrespective of their individual vapour pressures. For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits volative inorganic compounds and odorous substances are abated.
Cross-media effects generation of waste water (the quantity generated by the condensation facility is directly proportional to the amount of condensate, which in turn is directly proportional to the moisture content and the chosen cooling temperature) consumption of cooling medium (e.g. air, water, brine, ammonia-brine, nitrogen) consumption of energy.
Performance rate % 60 90 1 20 60 1
Remarks
Table 4.13: Operational data associated with the use of condensation 86 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Chapter 4
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
Description Adsorption is a heterogeneous reaction in which gas molecules are retained on a solid surface (adsorbent) that prefers specific compounds to others and thus removes them from effluent streams. When the surface has adsorbed nearly as much as it can, the adsorbed content is desorbed as part of regenerating the adsorbent. When desorbed, the contaminants are usually at a higher concentration and can either be recovered or abated (destroyed). Major types of adsorption systems are: fixed-bed adsorption fluidised-bed adsorption continuous moving-bed adsorption Pressure-Swing Adsorption (PSA).
Typical adsorbents are, e.g. Granular Activated Carbon (GAC), the most common adsorbent with a wide efficiency range and not restricted to polar or non-polar compounds; GAC can be impregnated with, e.g. oxidants such as potassium permanganate or with sulphur compounds (improving retention of heavy metals) Zeolites (whose properties depend on its manufacture, working either as mere molecular sieves, selective ion exchanger or hydrophobic VOC adsorber) macroporous polymer particles, which are used as granules or beads, not being highly selective with respect to VOC silica gel sodium-aluminium silicates.
Besides the continuous and simultaneous regeneration methods, there are several methods to regenerate the adsorbent of fixed-bed adsorbers: thermal-swing regeneration vacuum regeneration PSA.
For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
87
Chapter 4
Achieved environmental benefits VOC recovery abatement of pollutants (hazardous substances from production or treatment facilities e.g. WWTP such as VOC, odours, trace gases etc.) that cannot be recirculated or otherwise used, possibly with GAC as the adsorbent, are not regenerated but incinerated.
The application as abatement technology is not recommended for waste gases with very high VOC concentrations, because the consequent regeneration requirements would adversely affect profitability. There are normally more suitable techniques. Cross-media effects consumption of adsorbents consumption of energy consumption of cooling water.
Performance rate % 80 95 1 80 95 1 80 95 1
Applicability see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
88
Description Wet scrubbing (or absorption) is a mass transfer between a soluble gas and a solvent often water in contact with each other. Physical scrubbing is preferred for chemical recovery, whereas chemical scrubbing is restricted to removing and abating gaseous compounds. Physicochemical scrubbing takes an intermediate position. The component is dissolved in the absorbing liquid and involved in a reversible chemical reaction, which enables the recovery of the gaseous component. Depending on the pollutants to be removed, several aqueous scrubbing liquids are used: water, to remove solvents and gases such as hydrogen halides or ammonia, with the main aim to recover and re-use these contaminants alkaline solutions, to remove acid components such as hydrogen halides, sulphur dioxide, phenols, chlorine; also used for second-stage scrubbing to remove residual hydrogen halides after first-stage aqueous absorption; biogas desulphurisation alkaline-oxidation solutions, i.e. alkaline solutions with sodium hypochlorite, chlorine dioxide, ozone or hydrogen peroxide sodium hydrogensulphite solutions, to remove odour (e.g. aldehydes) Na2S4 solutions to remove mercury from waste gas acidic solutions, to remove ammonia.
Various types of scrubbers are operated, e.g. fibrous packing scrubbers moving bed scrubbers packed bed scrubbers impingement plate scrubbers spray towers.
For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits removal of gaseous pollutants, such as hydrogen halides, SO2, ammonia, hydrogen sulphide removal of SO2 or hydrogen halides removal of dust with certain types of scrubbers (see Section 4.4.2.1.3).
89
Chapter 4
Emission level mg/Nm3 <50 1 <1 1 <50 1 <10 1 <0.1 1 1 <1 1 <40 1
Table 4.15: Operational data associated with the use of wet gas scrubbers
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
90
Description Hydrogen cyanide (HCN) and ammonia (NH3) are removed from waste gases using one alkaline scrubber with NaOH solution and one acidic scrubber with H2SO4 solution. For each scrubber, the solution is circulated between a buffer vessel and the scrubber. The solution in each scrubber is sampled regularly and exchanged if the content of free OH- is too low for the absorption of HCN from the waste gas stream or if the content of free H2SO4 is too low for the absorption of ammonia. When possible, the spent solution from the alkaline scrubber is recycled back into the process to substitute raw materials. The ammonium sulphate solution formed in the acidic scrubber can be recycled off-site (e.g. in plants producing fertilisers). For safety purposes, the secondary containment of the acidic scrubber is strictly separated from the secondary containment of the alkali scrubber and the rest of the production building. This is to avoid, in the case of an accident, acids coming into contact with solutions containing cyanide, a situation which would lead to the emission of HCN into the environment, primarily to the working areas. A schematic overview of this technique is shown in Figure 4.3.
Cleaned gas
Alkaline scrubber
Waste gas with traces of HCN and NH3
Buffer
NaCN solution
(NH4)2SO4 solution
Recycled back into the process Secondary containment only for alkaline substances
Recycled off-site
Achieved environmental benefits removal of HCN and NH3 from waste gases no waste water from the alkaline scrubber (re-use of the alkaline scrubber solution into the process to substitute raw materials) strict separation of acidic and alkaline containment reduces the potential for hazardous emissions in the case of an accident.
The achieved emission levels for the removal of HCN and NH3 from waste gases are shown in Table 4.16.
HCN NH3 Concentration 1 mg/m 1.2 mg/m Mass-flow 3 g/h 3 g/h Reference CyPlus, Germany
Table 4.16: Achieved emission levels for the removal of HCN and NH3 from waste gases
91
Chapter 4
Reference
Gas stream
CyPlus, Germany
Table 4.17: Operational data for the removal of HCN and NH3 from waste gases
Driving force for implementation removal of toxic compounds from waste gases.
92
Description A twin-bed RTO (Regenerative Thermal Oxidiser) system provides a way for solvent-laden gas to be converted into CO2 and H2O vapour. The oxidiser consists of a reinforced, insulated twin-bed chamber filled with ceramic heat exchanger media. The gas flow is automatically controlled by a zero leakage poppet valve mechanism that changes the direction of the gas flow at regular intervals via an integral Programmable Logic Control (PLC) system with remote modem-based telemetry diagnostics. Due to the abundant oxygen content of the process gas, complete combustion readily occurs when the ignition point is reached in the oxidiser (typically 870 to 927 C for RTO and 316 to 427 C for RCO Regenerative Catalytic Oxidation). Process hydrocarbons are converted to carbon dioxide and water vapour. With a sufficient concentration of solvents in the incoming process gas (400+ PPM), the exotherm of the solvent heat release will be enough so that the destruction of VOCs will be self-sustaining and flameless (no NOX), with no supplemental auxiliary heat energy required from the burner. The high degree of heat recovery (typically 95 % primary heat recovery) achieved is the result of regenerative heat transfer. The VOC-laden process air enters a porous bed filled with high temperature ceramic heat transfer media. The air is preheated by the first heat recovery bed, passes through a central combustion chamber where the hydrocarbons are oxidised to carbon dioxide and water vapour, and then exits a second heat recovery bed where heat is transferred from the hot air back into the bed. In order to avoid an uneven temperature distribution throughout the oxidiser, the gas flow direction is changed at regular intervals by the automatic poppet valve flow switching mechanism and PLC controls to maintain an even temperature profile between the two beds. Achieved environmental benefits >99 % VOC abatement >95 % heat recovery. NOX level is negligible.
Operational data The VOC-laden process air enters a porous bed filled with high temperature ceramic heat transfer media. The air is preheated by the first heat recovery bed, passes through a central combustion chamber where the hydrocarbons are oxidised to carbon dioxide and water vapour, and then exits a second heat recovery bed where heat is transferred from the hot air back into the bed. In order to avoid an uneven temperature distribution throughout the oxidiser, the gas flow direction is changed at regular intervals by the automatic poppet valve flow switching mechanism and PLC controls to maintain an even temperature profile between the two beds. Applicability For point sources of 1680 to 136200 m3/h, mobile units also exist for temporary usage.
93
Chapter 4 4.4.2.2.7 Incineration of exhaust gases containing Volatile Organic Compounds (VOCs)
Description Raw material used may contain small amounts of volatile organic compounds (e.g. benzene) which can be found in several gas streams of the production process. The gas streams which contain VOCs are identified and separated from the others. The VOCs are incinerated in an air heater which is run by natural gas. The energy from the incineration is recovered. The circulation drying air is heated with this energy. Figure 4.4 shows a scheme of this technique.
Combustion air natural gas Incineration with heat recovery Air with traces of VOCs Combustion air
Figure 4.4: Incineration of process air containing Volatile Organic Compounds (VOCs)
Because there is a risk of dioxin/furan (PCDD/F) formation when chlorinated compounds are incinerated, the following operating conditions are generally considered appropriate for the incineration of halogenated organic substances (these conditions are indicated in several EU regulations on incineration, e.g. Directive 2000/76/EC on the incineration of waste): temperature >1100 C (850 C when incinerating waste with less than 1 % of halogenated organic substances) residence time >2 s oxygen content >3 %.
In addition, conditions that favour formation of dioxins/furans immediately following combustion are to be prevented. This is achieved by a fast-quench of post-combustion gases by cooling them very quickly from high temperatures to below the temperature-window of dioxins/furans reformation. These measures are designed to keep PCDD/F emissions below 0.1 ng TEQ/Nm3. In the case of the combustion of halogenated VOC substances, an HCl scrubber is necessary. Achieved environmental benefits removal of VOCs (e.g. benzene) from waste gases saving of natural gas to run the air heater.
94
Chapter 4
Driving force for implementation removal of toxic compounds from waste gases.
95
Description Catalytic oxidisers operate in a very similar way to thermal oxidisers, with the main difference that the gas, after passing through the flame area, passes through a catalyst bed. The catalyst has the effect of increasing the oxidation reaction rate, enabling conversion at lower reaction temperatures than in thermal oxidation units. Catalysts, therefore, also allow smaller oxidisers to be used. The waste gas is heated by auxiliary burners to approximately 300 500 C before entering the catalyst bed. The maximum design exhaust temperature of the catalyst is typically 500 700 C. The method of contacting the gas stream with the catalyst serves to distinguish catalytic oxidation systems. Both fixed-bed and fluidised-bed systems are used. Catalysts for VOC oxidation are typically either: precious metals, such as platinum, palladium and rhodium, supported on ceramic or metals, or base metals, supported on ceramic pellets or single or mixed metal oxides, often supported by a mechanically strong carrier, such as oxides of copper, chromium, manganese, nickel, cobalt etc.
For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits reduction of VOC emissions reduction of CO and PM emissions (the latter require special operational devices).
Table 4.20: Operational data associated with the use of catalytic oxidation
96
Chapter 4
Applicability Catalytic oxidation is most suited to systems with lower exhaust volumes, when there is little variation in the type and concentration of VOC, and where catalyst poisons or other fouling contaminants are not present. Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
Reference literature CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. 4.4.2.3 Waste gas treatment techniques to abate gaseous pollutants in combustion exhaust gases
4.4.2.3.1 Sorbent injection for abating acid gases and fluorides
Description The reaction principle of Flue-Gas Desulphurisation (FGD) sorbent injection is the introduction of reactive material to, and its dispersion in, the waste gas stream. This material reacts with SOx species to form a solid, which has to be removed afterwards from the waste gas stream (e.g. using an ESP or a bag filter). The most used sorbents are: lime sodium hydrogencarbonate (sodium bicarbonate) sodium carbonate (soda).
The choice of the sorbent depends on its availability. It is, in most cases, a naturally occurring material, such as limestone, dolomite or hydrated compounds derived from these raw materials. These sorbents are also effective in removing other acid gases, particularly hydrogen chloride and fluoride. If these acid gases are intended to be recovered, the waste gas needs to be pretreated (water scrubbing, see Section 4.4.2.2.4). There are three types of sorbent injection techniques: dry sorbent injection semi-dry (or semi-wet) injection wet injection of lime milk.
With dry sorbent injection, the fine powdered sorbent is either injected into the flue-gas stream or added to a reaction tower, the latter being the more efficient method. When the sorbent is injected into the gas stream, this can be done at various positions according to the temperature and conditions at which it is most reactive. With semi-dry sorbent injection, the sorbent is added as a suspension or solution (droplets) in a reaction chamber in such a way that the liquid is continuously evaporating during the reaction. The result is a dry product, collected at the base of the chamber or in a particulate abatement device.
97
Chapter 4
With wet sorbent injection, SO2 is removed from the flue-gas in the FGD absorber by direct contact with an aqueous suspension of finely ground limestone (lime milk), after having left the particulate control system and passed through a heat exchanger. The scrubbed flue-gas passes through a mist eliminator and is released to the air by a stack or cooling tower. The reaction products are withdrawn from the absorber and sent for dewatering and further processing. For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits abatement of acid gases (e.g. SO2, SO3, HCl, HF) in the waste gas.
Cross-media effects in the case of dry and semi-dry sorption, the residue is a mixture of the original sorbent and the reaction products which, if it cannot be recovered or recycled, has to be disposed of consumption of sorbent consumption of energy for dry and semi-dry sorbent injection consumption of water for semi-dry and wet sorbent injection.
Operational data see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
Economics see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
98
Description Selective reduction of NOX involves the injection of NH2-X compounds (where X = H, CN or CONH2) into the flue-gas stream, reducing nitrogen oxides to nitrogen and water. The most common reduction agent is a 25 % aqueous solution of ammonia or pure ammonia. Other reaction agents are urea solutions, nitrolime or cyanamide. There are different variants of selective NOX reduction: selective non-catalytic reduction (SNCR) selective catalytic reduction (SCR).
With SNCR, the reduction agent is injected in the area where the exhaust gases have reached a temperature of between 930 and 980 C, whereas urea is injected in an area where the gas temperature is between 950 and 1050 C. The injection occurs after combustion and before other treatment. Temperature, NH3/NOX molar ratio and residence time are the main parameters for optimum reduction efficiency. Temperatures below the level mentioned above cause unconverted ammonia to be emitted (ammonia slip); temperatures significantly above the level oxidise ammonia to NOX. SNCR is operated with a NH3/NOX molar ratio range of 0.5 0.9. At higher levels (>1.2), ammonia slip can also occur, generating aerosols of ammonium chloride and sulphate, which pass through the filter and cause visible white plumes above the exhaust gas stack. The residence time and mixing quality are decisive for the reaction efficiency. Too short a residence time will cause ammonia slip. With SCR, the exhaust gas stream and the injected agent are passed over a catalyst, with operation temperatures of between 200 and 500 C, dependent on the catalyst. The optimum mixing, i.e. NH3/NOX molar ratio, over the catalyst is vital. The molar ratio level is usually kept below 1.1 to limit the potential for ammonia slip. The considerably lower temperatures compared to SNCR make possible the installation of SCR downstream of other treatment devices such as dust abatement and FGD. With this cold Denox process, a mixture of air (to control optimum oxygen content) and ammonia is added after FGD. The desulphurised flue-gas stream needs to be reheated at the necessary reaction temperature. The advantage of this procedure is that, because there is no adsorption to dust, there is no potential for ammonia slip. For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits abate nitrogen oxides from processes such as chemical production, combustion or process furnaces.
Cross-media effects consumption of ammonia consumption of steam to evaporate ammonia consumption of energy.
99
Chapter 4
Operational data see the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
Description Sulphur dioxide emissions are generated if sulphur is added as a reduction agent to the reaction process. There are several off-gas treatment methods for the elimination of SO2: washing with caustic soda.
When washing with caustic soda, SO2 is converted into sodium sulphite. In some cases, hydrogen peroxide can be added to the effluent, in order to accelerate the generation of sodium sulphate. SO2 + 2NaOH X Na2SO3 + H2O Na2SO3 + H2O2 X Na2SO4 + H2O (1) (2)
When washing with calcium carbonate, SO2 is converted into calcium sulphite or calcium sulphate slurry. SO2 + CaCO3 X CaSO3 + CO2 SO2 + CaCO3 X CaSO4 + CO (3) (4)
Reaction (4) can only take place at elevated temperature (>900 C): Achieved environmental benefits SO2 abatement.
Table 4.21: Achieved emission levels after SO2 abatement 100 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Chapter 4
Reconditioning
Return to process
H2O2
Water with low cyanide content pH adjustment Oxidation Waste water to biological treatment
NaOH/KOH or H2SO4
Figure 4.5: Scrubbing and recycling of cyanides from waste gases and waste waters
Using H2O2 based technology (as opposed to hypochlorite, for example) does not generate salts and AOX by-products. NaCN + OCl- X OCN- + NaCl (hypochlorite method) CN- + H2O2 X OCN- + H2O (peroxide method) Achieved environmental benefits removal of HCN/CN- from waste gases and waste waters re-use of waste water streams as raw materials no AOX in waste water no contaminated waste.
101
Chapter 4
Achieved emission levels for discharge to a biological WWTP are given in Table 4.22.
Waste gas Waste water Concentration 1 mg HCN/m 1.1 mg CN-/l Mass-flow 3 g HCN/h 2.3 g CN-/h Reference CyPlus, Germany
Table 4.22: Achieved emission levels after scrubbing and recycling of cyanides
Gas stream Treatment capacity Waste water with high CN- concentration Waste water with low CN- concentration 99.9 %
CyPlus, Germany
Overall efficiency
Table 4.23: Operational data for the scrubbing and recycling of cyanides
Economics Cost reduction for waste water treatment due to the absence of AOX load. The technique is in practice at some installations. Driving force for implementation removal of toxic compounds from waste gases and waste waters.
102
Chapter 4
For additional information on the description, application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits the volume of residues to facilitate subsequent treatment operations are reduced.
Cross-media effects consumption of energy consumption of chemicals (e.g. flocculants, polymers) consumption of washing water aqueous effluents need to be treated in the WWTP noise and odour may be issues.
Operational data Achievable emission levels/performance rates are indicated in the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
Speciality Inorganic Chemicals 103
Chapter 4
Economics economic information can be found in the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
104
Chapter 4
4.4.4.2 Stabilisation and conditioning Description Stabilisation of sewage sludge is a pretreatment operation prior to thickening and/or dewatering. Stabilisation techniques are: chemical stabilisation, chiefly using lime either as pretreatment, i.e. before dewatering, or as post-treatment, i.e. after dewatering, to raise the pH to >12 and thus kill pathogens thermal stabilisation, by heating the sludge in a pressure vessel at temperatures of up to 260 C and pressures of up to 2.8 MPa for approximately 30 minutes. This is also used as a conditioning technique aerobic digestion, working in a tank similar to the aerobic activated-sludge process for waste water treatment with air or pure oxygen and adequate stirring, resulting in a 75 to 80 % reduction of the activated sludge content; the technique is an attractive option when separate sludge digestion is considered anaerobic digestion, working in a tank without air either in the mesophilic (30 to 38 C) or the thermophilic (49 to 57 C) range and producing a combustible gas mixture (65 to 70 % methane, 25 to 30 % carbon dioxide, small amounts of nitrogen, hydrogen, hydrogen sulphide, etc.) with a low heating value of about 22 MJ/Nm3 dual sludge stabilisation, combining an upstream aerobic thermophilic and a downstream anaerobic mesophilic digestion.
The purpose of sludge conditioning is to improve the conditions for thickening and/or dewatering. Conditioning techniques are: chemical conditioning using, e.g. ferric chloride, lime, alum and organic polymers (coagulants and flocculants) thermal conditioning, by heating the sludge in a pressure vessel.
For additional information on the application, advantages/disadvantages and limits/restrictions of the technique, please refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits reduce or eliminate the amount of odorous constituents reduce the quantity of biodegradable sludge solids improve dewatering reduce pathogens reduce or eliminate the potential for putrefaction.
Applicability Generally applicable. Reference literature CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
Speciality Inorganic Chemicals 105
Chapter 4
4.4.4.3 Thermal sludge reduction Thermal sludge reduction is not generally performed at a SIC installation. Generally, only larger sites operate this type of sludge treatment, others commission their sludge to external discharge. The reasons are that skilled personnel are needed, the capital and maintenance costs are considerable and the benefits from generated heat are normally relevant only to larger plants or where equipment is already available [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
4.5 Infrastructure
4.5.1 Cleaning-In-Place (CIP) systems of equipment contaminated with solid hazardous compounds
Description During production, solid hazardous compounds (e.g. solid cyanide) can build up in pipelines, machines and vessels and can ultimately provoke equipment malfunction or blockage. A Cleaning-In-Place (CIP) system allows easy cleaning and rinsing of equipment in a closed system. With such a system, workers are not exposed to harmful emissions. The rinsing water containing the hazardous material is collected in a closed piping system and stored in tanks. The rinsing water is recycled back into production when possible to reduce the use of fresh water as a raw material. When the solid hazardous compounds are the products manufactured in the installation, off-specification products can (if they are soluble) be dissolved in the rinsing water collecting tanks and recycled back into the process in order to reduce the amount of hazardous waste produced. A schematic overview of this technique is shown in Figure 4.6.
Rinsing water
Figure 4.6: A Cleaning-In-Place-system (CIP) of equipment contaminated with solid hazardous compounds
Achieved environmental benefits no solid wastes containing hazardous compounds recycling of waste water containing hazardous compounds within the process reduction of raw material consumption (i.e. fresh water) protection of the workers reduction of emissions to the environment and to the working areas.
106
Chapter 4
As an example, the emission levels achieved at a plant producing cyanides in Germany are given in Table 4.24.
Concentration Solid waste Mass-flow 0 kg/yr Reference CyPlus, Germany
Table 4.24: Achieved emission levels associated with the CIP of equipment contaminated with cyanides
Operational data As an example, the operational data for a plant producing cyanides in Germany are given in Table 4.25.
Flow and concentration at the inlet of the treatment system 15 m/h variable cyanide concentration 99 %1 Reference CyPlus, Germany
Rinsing water
1 The remaining 1 % of the cyanides either desagregates (hydrolysis) to by-products or ends up in the cyanide detoxification unit
Table 4.25: Operational data for the cleaning of equipment contaminated with cyanides
Economics cost reduction for waste water treatment cost reduction for raw materials.
Driving force for implementation reduction of emissions to the environment and the working areas.
107
Chapter 4
Applicability This technique may not be applicable in certain cases. For example, the production of SIC explosives relies on manual operation because detonation risks are frequently detected by visual inspection, by long expertise and by highly qualified personnel. Economics slight reduction in production costs (e.g. energy, waste treatment).
Driving force for implementation more efficient control of process conditions reduction of emissions.
108
Chapter 4
4.6 Energy
4.6.1 Pinch methodology
Description Pinch is a methodology that is used in the chemical industry in order to optmise the production process vis--vis the utilisation of energy. The methodology consists of looking at the production process (and even at several production processes from different plants) in terms of hot and cold streams and building hot and cold composite curves on a temperature-enthalpy diagram which represents the total heating and cooling requirements of the process. The point at which the hot and cold composite curves come closest to touching is known as the pinch which indicates the maximum possible amount of process-to-process heat exchange. For a further description of the technique, please refer to the OFC BREF [18, European IPPC Bureau, 2004]. Achieved environmental benefits optimisation of the energy balance on a production site.
Operational data The key to applying pinch methodology in non-continuous processes is the data extraction. There are no shortcuts; detailed measurements and timings of all the process streams are essential if cost saving (= energy saving) opportunities are to be found. Applicability The application of pinch often results in installing plant equipment in different locations than to the location that would result from the logic of product flow. Design and layout may result in additional equipment (e.g. pumps, compressors, heat exchangers) and piping sections which would then incur extra costs. It should also be noted also that the complexity of the control system may increase dramatically which can increase, e.g. the risks of incidents. The compatability of substances (fluids) exchanging heat should be taken into account in the design of the heat exchange equipment. If substances (fluids) are very incompatible (e.g. risk of explosion if the two substances come into contact due to corrosion problems) then alternative energy saving techniques, e.g. energy exchange via an intermediate fluid, may need to be evaluated instead for safety reasons. Pinch methodology can better be used at the concept stage for new and large installations. Pinch methodology is usually not applicable for existing installations. There might be difficulties to apply pinch at installations operating in a non-continuous mode (which is the case for the vast majority of installations producing inorganic pigments for example).
109
Chapter 4
Economics The additional capital cost compared to a classical plant should be balanced by sufficient energy savings. Reference literature OFC BREF [18, European IPPC Bureau, 2004]
Operational data Measures for ground protection depend on the hazard arising from a handled substance. Retention volumes used at some SIC plants are provided in Table 4.26.
Retention volumes The larger of the two factors 110 % of the capacity of 25 % of the total storage the largest tank or drum capacity 100 % of the capacity of 10 % of the total storage the largest tank or drum capacity
Plant A Plant B
110
Chapter 4
The following operating measures can be implemented: the integrity and tightness of all structure boundaries and their resistance to penetration by water or other substances are tested and demonstrated the loading and unloading of materials are carried out only in designated areas protected against leakage run-off. While awaiting disposal, all materials are collected and stored in designated areas protected against leakage run-off all pump sumps or other treatment plant chambers from which spillages might occur are equipped with alarms activated by high levels of liquid a programme for the testing and inspection of tanks and pipelines is established and carried out inspections are carried out for leaks on all flanges and valves on pipes used to transport materials other than water. A log of these inspections is maintained a catchment system is provided to collect any leaks from flanges and valves on pipes used to transport materials other than water, except when the construction of flanges or valves is technically tight an adequate supply of containment booms and suitable absorbent material is provided all bunds are tested at least once every three to five years.
Driving force for implementation prevention of contamination to the ground, surface water and groundwater.
By regulation, all chemical installations in France, Germany and the Netherlands have to have ground protection measures. Example plants UEB plant in Galdcano, Spain Thermphos plants, Germany.
111
Chapter 4
Economics Better education and continuous training of personnel leads to better decision making when confronted by problems (including incidents and emergency situations) and finally to a reduction in production costs. Driving force for implementation enhanced safety standards leading to reduced environmental risks.
112
Chapter 4
Economics There are no savings to be made from applying the code. Costs depend on the standards a SIC producer already has in place it therefore means less costs for producers who already have a sound environmental management system in place, and higher costs for those who do not. Auditing can take a day, internal preparations for the audit can take several days to several weeks with the respective, e.g. personnel costs involved. Example plants CyPlus, Germany.
113
Chapter 4
114
Chapter 4
Operational data At the Marl chemical site, there is continuous monitoring of the following parameters in the rainwater and cooling water ducts: pH TOC (measured using a process analyser with a sampling frequency of one sample every three to five minutes) floating material turbidity (measured in a flow-through cell) toxicity to fish (measured in a flow-through fish tank with Golden Orf as the test species) volatile organic compounds (on a voluntary basis).
When elevated values are found (even for turbidity in the first flush of storm-water), rainwater is stored and treated at the central WWTP before being discharged to the Lippe river. Applicability Continuous monitoring may not be economically viable at small installations with small volumes of rainwater compared to the total volume of waste water to be treated. These installations may choose to systematically duct rainwater to treatment irrespective of whether it is contaminated or not. Example plants Marl chemical site in Germany.
115
Chapter 4
Start Process/plant Change process or change plant
Assessment
yes
yes
no
no Documentation End
Figure 4.7: Safety assessment procedure Note: (*) see Figure 4.8
Assessment of the substances under process conditions Process or plant requires modification Are all substances used and produced adequately stable ? yes Assessment of the required reaction as well as ancillary and secondary reactions no
Gas production ? no QR
yes
no
Assessment of the reaction output dQ/dt = QR/metering time for semi batch reaction
dQ/dt
no no
Figure 4.8: Iterative assessment strategy for normal operations 116 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Effects due to deviations of chemical processes Starting materials (specification, nature, property), e.g. contamination with catalytic effect increased/decreased concentration residues from previous use decomposition of activators/inhibitors (e.g. as a result of extended storage) Presence of starting materials/auxiliary materials, e.g. solvent used solution promoter activator/inhibitor Metering, e.g. wrong substance, wrong quantities/ratios changed metering sequence wrong metering rate Reaction conditions, e.g. change in pH value temperature increase/decrease reaction/residence time, delayed reaction start increase of by-products/residues Mixing, e.g. inadequate agitation separation of solids/catalysts Effects due to deviations in the operation of the plant Availability of auxiliary energy, e.g. compressed air, nitrogen electric current heating medium, cooling medium ventilation Heating/cooling medium (temperature), e.g. temperature exceeds/falls below the temperature defined for safe process operation Process equipment, e.g. failure Material flows, e.g. failure of pumps/valves incorrect operation of valves blocking of lines/valves/fittings (in particular venting pipes) backflow from other parts of the plant Filling level, e.g. overfilling leakage from a valve flooding of condensers (heat-exchangers) Agitation, e.g. failure increased viscosity mechanical introduction of heat Integrity of components, e.g. corrosion (in particular with resulting material overflow from/to heat transfer systems) mechanical damage Table 4.27: Template to analyse the effects due to deviations of chemical processes or to the operation of the plant
117
Chapter 4
All the relevant physico-chemical safety data of substances and reactions should be evaluated with respect to the necessary equipment along with technical and organisational safety precautions. Important physico-chemical parameters to be taken into account are, e.g: reaction enthalpies (aHR) both for the reaction concerned and for potential secondary reactions (e.g. decomposition) possible gas evolution (M) and the rate of gas evolution (dM/dt) or corresponding derived parameters from the reaction or the possible decomposition rate of heat production (dQR/dt), where appropriate as a function of temperature total heat removal capacity of the system (dQK/dt) limit temperature (Texo) for the thermal stability of the substances concerned and the reaction mixtures under process conditions formation of new unwanted products or by-products (an subst.), which lead to an increase in the reaction enthalpy or gas formation or a reduction of the limit temperature (Texo).
Measures to ensure that a process can be controlled adequately include (without ranking): Preventive measures (preferred) - organisational measures - concepts involving control engineering techniques - reaction stoppers - emergency cooling Achieved environmental benefits prevention of major accidents and substance releases. Design measures - pressure resistant construction - pressure relief including sufficient catch volume
Applicability similar to chemical reactions and also applicable to other operations, e.g. drying or distillation important safety examples are the handling of organic dusts or solvent vapours.
Economics additional costs for safety measures high costs in the case of pressure resistant construction.
118
Chapter 4
4.7.5.2 Prevention of runaway reactions Description The consequences of a runaway reaction can be severe. Therefore, facilities must focus on prevention of conditions favourable for a reaction excursion through process design control, instrumentation, and interlocks to prevent the recurrence of similar events. Facilities should take the following steps to prevent runaway reactions: modify processes to improve inherent safety. Consider inherently safer processes to reduce reliance on administrative controls minimise the potential for human error understand events that may lead to an overpressure and eventually to vessel rupture use lessons learned. Go beyond the issues of quality control and operator error and identify true root causes evaluate Standard Operating Procedures (SOPs) evaluate employee training and oversight evaluate measures to inhibit a runaway reaction (e.g. neutralisation, quenching) evaluate the effectiveness of the emergency relief system.
Applicability generally applicable, especially in the case of exothermic reactions also relevant for stored goods with potential for autoreaction.
Driving force for implementation prevention of accidents and consequent emissions to the environment.
119
Chapter 4
120
Chapter 4
(a) Definition of an environmental policy Top management are responsible for defining an environmental policy for an installation and ensuring that it: is appropriate to the nature, scale and environmental impacts of the activities includes a commitment to pollution prevention and control includes a commitment to comply with all relevant applicable environmental legislation and regulations, and with other requirements to which the organisation subscribes provides the framework for setting and reviewing environmental objectives and targets is documented and communicated to all employees is available to the public and all interested parties. (b) Planning, i.e.: procedures to identify the environmental aspects of the installation, in order to determine those activities which have or can have significant impacts on the environment, and to keep this information up-to-date procedures to identify and have access to legal and other requirements to which the organisation subscribes and that are applicable to the environmental aspects of its activities establishing and reviewing documented environmental objectives and targets, taking into consideration the legal and other requirements and the views of interested parties establishing and regularly updating an environmental management programme, including designation of responsibility for achieving objectives and targets at each relevant function and level as well as the means and timeframe by which they are to be achieved. (c) Implementation and operation of procedures It is important to have systems in place to ensure that procedures are known, understood and complied with, therefore effective environmental management includes: (i) Structure and responsibility defining, documenting and communicating roles, responsibilities and authorities, which includes appointing one specific management representative providing resources essential to the implementation and control of the environmental management system, including human resources and specialised skills, technology and financial resources. (ii) Training, awareness and competence identifying training needs to ensure that all personnel whose work may significantly affect the environmental impacts of the activity have received appropriate training. (iii) Communication establishing and maintaining procedures for internal communication between the various levels and functions of the installation, as well as procedures that foster a dialogue with external interested parties and procedures for receiving, documenting and, where reasonable, responding to relevant communication from external interested parties. (iv) Employee involvement involving employees in the process aimed at achieving a high level of environmental performance by applying appropriate forms of participation such as the suggestionbook system or project-based group works or environmental committees.
121
Chapter 4
(v) Documentation establishing and maintaining up-to-date information, in paper or electronic form, to describe the core elements of the management system and their interaction and to provide direction to related documentation. (vi) Efficient process control adequate control of processes under all modes of operation, i.e. preparation, start up, routine operation, shut down and abnormal conditions identifying the key performance indicators and methods for measuring and controlling these parameters (e.g. flow, pressure, temperature, composition and quantity) documenting and analysing abnormal operating conditions to identify the root causes and then addressing these to ensure that events do not recur (this can be facilitated by a no-blame culture where the identification of causes is more important than apportioning blame to individuals). (vii) Maintenance programme establishing a structured programme for maintenance based on technical descriptions of the equipment, norms, etc. as well as any equipment failures and consequences supporting the maintenance programme by appropriate record keeping systems and diagnostic testing clearly allocating responsibility for the planning and execution of maintenance. (viii) Emergency preparedness and response establishing and maintaining procedures to identify the potential for and response to accidents and emergency situations, and for preventing and mitigating the environmental impacts that may be associated with them. (d) Checking and corrective action, i.e.: (i) Monitoring and measurement establishing and maintaining documented procedures to monitor and measure, on a regular basis, the key characteristics of operations and activities that can have a significant impact on the environment, including the recording of information for tracking performance, relevant operational controls and conformance with the installation's environmental objectives and targets (see also the Reference document on Monitoring of Emissions) establishing and maintaining a documented procedure for periodically evaluating compliance with relevant environmental legislation and regulations. (ii) Corrective and preventive action establishing and maintaining procedures for defining responsibility and authority for handling and investigating non-conformance with permit conditions, other legal requirements as well as objectives and targets, taking action to mitigate any impacts caused and for initiating and completing corrective and preventive action that are appropriate to the magnitude of the problem and commensurate with the environmental impact encountered. (iii) Records establishing and maintaining procedures for the identification, maintenance and disposition of legible, identifiable and traceable environmental records, including training records and the results of audits and reviews.
122
Chapter 4
(iv) Audit establishing and maintaining (a) programme(s) and procedures for periodic environmental management system audits that include discussions with personnel, inspection of operating conditions and equipment and reviewing of records and documentation and that results in a written report, to be carried out impartially and objectively by employees (internal audits) or external parties (external audits), covering the audit scope, frequency and methodologies, as well as the responsibilities and requirements for conducting audits and reporting results, in order to determine whether or not the environmental management system conforms to planned arrangements and has been properly implemented and maintained completing the audit or audit cycle, as appropriate, at intervals of no longer than three years, depending on the nature, scale and complexity of the activities, the significance of associated environmental impacts, the importance and urgency of the problems detected by previous audits and the history of environmental problems more complex activities with a more significant environmental impact are audited more frequently having appropriate mechanisms in place to ensure that the audit results are followed up. (v) Periodic evaluation of legal compliance reviewing compliance with the applicable environmental legislation and the conditions of the environmental permit(s) held by the installation documentation of the evaluation. (e) Management review, i.e.: reviewing, by top management, at intervals that it determines, the environmental management system, to ensure its continuing suitability, adequacy and effectiveness ensuring that the necessary information is collected to allow management to carry out this evaluation documentation of the review. (f) Preparation of a regular environmental statement: preparing an environmental statement that pays particular attention to the results achieved by the installation against its environmental objectives and targets. It is regularly produced from once a year to less frequently depending on the significance of emissions, waste generation, etc. It considers the information needs of relevant interested parties and it is publicly available (e.g. in electronic publications, libraries, etc.). When producing a statement, the operator may use relevant existing environmental performance indicators, making sure that the indicators chosen: i. give an accurate appraisal of the installations performance ii. are understandable and unambiguous iii. allow for year on year comparison to assess the development of the environmental performance of the installation iv. allow for comparison with sector, national or regional benchmarks as appropriate v. allow for comparison with regulatory requirements as appropriate. (g) Validation by certification body or external EMS verifier: having the management system, audit procedure and environmental statement examined and validated by an accredited certification body or an external EMS verifier can, if carried out properly, enhance the credibility of the system.
123
Chapter 4
(h) Design considerations for end-of-life plant decommissioning: giving consideration to the environmental impact from the eventual decommissioning of the unit at the stage of designing a new plant, as forethought makes decommissioning easier, cleaner and cheaper decommissioning poses environmental risks for the contamination of land (and groundwater) and generates large quantities of solid waste. Preventive techniques are process-specific but general considerations may include: i. avoiding underground structures ii. incorporating features that facilitate dismantling iii. choosing surface finishes that are easily decontaminated iv. using an equipment configuration that minimises trapped chemicals and facilitates drain-down or washing v. designing flexible, self-contained units that enable phased closure vi. using biodegradable and recyclable materials where possible. (i) Development of cleaner technologies: environmental protection should be an inherent feature of any process design activities carried out by the operator, since techniques incorporated at the earliest possible design stage are both more effective and cheaper. Giving consideration to the development of cleaner technologies can for instance occur through R&D activities or studies. As an alternative to internal activities, arrangements can be made to keep abreast with and where appropriate commission work by other operators or research institutes active in the relevant field. (j) Benchmarking, i.e.: carrying out systematic and regular comparisons with sector, national or regional benchmarks, including for energy efficiency and energy conservation activities, choice of input materials, emissions to air and discharges to water (using for example the European Pollutant Emission Register, EPER), consumption of water and generation of waste. Standardised and non-standardised EMSs An EMS can take the form of a standardised or non-standardised (customised) system. Implementation and adherence to an internationally accepted standardised system such as EN ISO 14001: 2004 can give higher credibility to the EMS, especially when subject to a properly performed external verification. EMAS provides additional credibility due to the interaction with the public through the environmental statement and the mechanism to ensure compliance with the applicable environmental legislation. However, non-standardised systems can in principle be equally effective provided that they are properly designed and implemented. Achieved environmental benefits Implementation of and adherence to an EMS focuses the attention of the operator on the environmental performance of the installation. In particular, the maintenance of and compliance with clear operating procedures for both normal and abnormal situations and the associated lines of responsibility should ensure that the installations permit conditions and other environmental targets and objectives are met at all times. Environmental management systems typically ensure the continuous improvement of the environmental performance of the installation. The poorer the starting point is, the more significant short-term improvements can be expected. If the installation already has a good overall environmental performance, the system helps the operator to maintain the high performance level.
124 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Chapter 4
Cross-media effects Environmental management techniques are designed to address the overall environmental impact, which is consistent with the integrated approach of the IPPC Directive. Operational data No specific information reported. Applicability The components described above can typically be applied to all IPPC installations. The scope (e.g. level of detail) and nature of the EMS (e.g. standardised or non-standardised) will generally be related to the nature, scale and complexity of the installation, and the range of environmental impacts it may have. Economics It is difficult to accurately determine the costs and economic benefits of introducing and maintaining a good EMS. A number of studies are presented below. However, these are just examples and their results are not entirely coherent. They might not be representative for all sectors across the EU and should thus be treated with caution. A Swedish study carried out in 1999 surveyed all 360 ISO-certified and EMAS-registered companies in Sweden. With a response rate of 50 %, it concluded among other things that: the expenses for introducing and operating EMS are high but not unreasonably so, save in the case of very small companies. Expenses are expected to decrease in the future a higher degree of co-ordination and integration of EMS with other management systems is seen as a possible way to decrease costs half of all the environmental objectives and targets give payback within one year through cost savings and/or increased revenue the largest cost savings were made through decreased expenditure on energy, waste treatment and raw materials most of the companies think that their position on the market has been strengthened through the EMS. One-third of the companies report increasing revenue due to EMS.
In some Member States reduced supervision fees are charged if the installation has a certification. A number of studies show that there is an inverse relationship between company size and the cost of implementing an EMS. A similar inverse relationship exists for the payback period of invested capital. Both elements imply a less favourable cost-benefit relationship for implementing an EMS in SMEs compared to larger companies. According to a Swiss study, the average cost for building and operating ISO 14001 can vary: for a company with between 1 and 49 employees: CHF 64000 (EUR 44000) for building the EMS and CHF 16000 (EUR 11000) per year for operating it for an industrial site with more than 250 employees: CHF 367000 (EUR 252000) for building the EMS and CHF 155000 (EUR 106000) per year for operating it.
125
Chapter 4
These average figures do not necessarily represent the actual cost for a given industrial site because this cost is also highly dependent on the number of significant items (pollutants, energy consumption...) and on the complexity of the problems to be studied. A recent German study (Schaltegger, Stefan and Wagner, Marcus, Umweltmanagement in deutschen Unternehmen - der aktuelle Stand der Praxis, February 2002, p. 106) shows the following costs for EMAS for different branches. It can be noted that these figures are much lower than those of the Swiss study quoted above. This is a confirmation of the difficulty to determine the costs of an EMS. Costs for building (EUR): minimum - 18750 maximum - 75000 average - 50000 Costs for validation (EUR): minimum - 5000 maximum - 12500 average - 6000 A study by the German Institute of Entrepreneurs (Unternehmerinstitut/Arbeitsgemeinschaft Selbstndiger Unternehmer UNI/ASU, 1997, Umweltmanagementbefragung ko-Audit in der mittelstndischen Praxis Evaluierung und Anstze fr eine Effizienzsteigerung von Umweltmanagementsystemen in der Praxis, Bonn.) gives information about the average savings achieved for EMAS per year and the average payback time. For example, for implementation costs of EUR 80000 they found average savings of EUR 50000 per year, corresponding to a payback time of about one and a half years. External costs relating to verification of the system can be estimated from guidance issued by the International Accreditation Forum (http://www.iaf.nu). Driving forces for implementation Environmental management systems can provide a number of advantages, for example: improved insight into the environmental aspects of the company improved basis for decision-making improved motivation of personnel additional opportunities for operational cost reduction and product quality improvement improved environmental performance improved company image reduced liability, insurance and non-compliance costs increased attractiveness for employees, customers and investors increased trust of regulators, which could lead to reduced regulatory oversight improved relationship with environmental groups.
Example plants The features described under (a) to (e) above are elements of EN ISO 14001: 2004 and the European Community Eco-Management and Audit Scheme (EMAS), whereas the features (f) and (g) are specific to EMAS. These two standardised systems are applied in a number of IPPC installations. As an example, 357 organisations within the EU chemical and chemical products industry (NACE code 24) were EMAS registered in July 2002, most of which operate IPPC installations.
126 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Chapter 4
In the UK, the Environment Agency of England and Wales carried out a survey among IPC (the precursor to IPPC) regulated installations in 2001. It showed that 32 % of respondents were certified to ISO 14001 (corresponding to 21 % of all IPC installations) and 7 % were EMAS registered. All cement works in the UK (around 20) are certified to ISO 14001 and the majority are EMAS registered. In Ireland, where the establishment of an EMS (not necessarily of a standardised nature) is required in IPC licenses, an estimated 100 out of approximately 500 licensed installations have established an EMS according to ISO 14001, with the other 400 installations having opted for a non-standardised EMS. Reference literature (Regulation (EC) No 761/2001 of the European parliament and of the council allowing voluntary participation by organisations in a Community eco-management and audit scheme (EMAS), OJ L 114, 24/4/2001, http://europa.eu.int/comm/environment/emas/index_en.htm) (EN ISO 14001: 2004, http://www.iso.ch/iso/en/iso9000-14000/iso14000/iso14000index.html; http://www.tc207.org)
127
Chapter 5
Expert judgment by the European IPPC Bureau and the relevant Technical Working Group (TWG) has played a key role in each of these steps and in the way in which the information is presented here. On the basis of this assessment, techniques, and as far as possible consumption and emission levels associated with the use of BAT, are presented in this chapter that are considered to be appropriate to the sector as a whole and in many cases reflect the current performance of some installations within the sector. Where consumption or emission levels associated with Best Available Techniques are presented, this is to be understood as meaning that those levels represent the environmental performance that could be anticipated as a result of the application, in this sector, of the techniques described, bearing in mind the balance of costs and advantages inherent within the definition of BAT. However, they are neither consumption nor emission limit values and should not be understood as such. In some cases it may be technically possible to achieve better consumption or emission levels but due to the costs involved or cross-media considerations, they are not considered to be appropriate as BAT for the sector as a whole. However, such levels may be considered to be justified in more specific cases where there are special driving forces. The consumption and emission levels associated with the use of BAT have to be seen together with any specified reference conditions (e.g. averaging periods). The concept of levels associated with BAT described above is to be distinguished from the term achievable level used elsewhere in this document. Where a level is described as achievable using a particular technique or combination of techniques, this should be understood to mean that the level may be expected to be achieved over a substantial period of time in a well maintained and operated installation or process using those techniques. Where available, data concerning costs have been given together with the description of the techniques presented in the previous chapter. These give a rough indication about the magnitude of the costs involved. However, the actual cost of applying a technique will depend strongly on the specific situation regarding, for example, taxes, fees, and the technical characteristics of the installation concerned. It is not possible to evaluate such site-specific factors fully in this document. In the absence of data concerning costs, conclusions on economic viability of techniques are drawn from observations on existing installations.
129
Chapter 5
It is intended that the general BAT in this chapter are a reference point against which to judge the current performance of an existing installation or to judge a proposal for a new installation. In this way they will assist in the determination of appropriate BAT-based conditions for the installation or in the establishment of general binding rules under Article 9(8). It is foreseen that new installations can be designed to perform at or even better than the general BAT levels presented here. It is also considered that existing installations could move towards the general BAT levels or do better, subject to the technical and economic applicability of the techniques in each case. While the BAT reference documents do not set legally binding standards, they are meant to give information for the guidance of industry, Member States and the public on achievable consumption and emission levels when using specified techniques. The appropriate limit values for any specific case will need to be determined taking into account the objectives of the IPPC Directive and the local considerations. Recommendations to help users/readers of this document The following issues are considered important enough for those who read this document: it is strongly recommended to read Chapter 5 in conjunction with Chapter 4. To help the reader in this, references to Chapter 4 have been included in Chapter 5 in addition to the BAT referenced in this chapter, BAT for a SIC installation will also contain elements from other IPPC documents. In this context, special attention is drawn to the following BAT Reference Documents: - Emissions from Storage (ESB BREF, [8, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]) - Industrial Cooling Systems (CV BREF, [31, European IPPC Bureau, 2000]) - Waste Water and Waste Gas Treatment/Management Systems in the Chemical - Sector (CWW BREF, [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]) - Waste Incineration (WI BREF, [34, European IPPC Bureau, 2004]) - Waste Treatments (WT BREF, [35, European IPPC Bureau, 2004]) - General Principles of Monitoring (MON BREF, [36, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]).
With regard to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003], it is worth noting the following points: this SIC document allows a more in-depth look into the application of some of the environmentally beneficial techniques identified in the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003] for the production of SIC in order to reduce the need for the reader of this document to consult the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003], Chapter 4 of this document briefly presents techniques that are described in more detail in the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. This also offers the advantage of including operational data derived from, and specific to, the SIC sector for each technique considered.
In this document, the BAT conclusions for the SIC sector are set out on two levels. Chapter 5 presents generic BAT conclusions, i.e. those that are generally applicable to the whole sector. If there are exceptions when the BAT is not applicable in certain circumstances or cases, this issue is mentioned in the BAT conclusion. Sections 6.X.5 (i.e. Section 6.1.5, Section 6.2.5, Section 6.3.5, Section 6.4.5, Section 6.5.5) contain more specific BAT conclusions, i.e. those for the families of SIC substances under the scope.
130
Chapter 5
Raw and auxiliary materials supply, storage, handling and preparation BAT is to: 5.1 reduce the amount of packaging materials disposed of by, e.g. recycling hard and soft used packaging materials (see Sections 4.2.1 and 4.2.2), unless safety or hazard considerations prevent it. Synthesis/reaction/calcination BAT is to: 5.2 reduce emissions and the amount of residues generated by implementing one or more of the following measures: a. using high purity feedstock (see Section 4.3.1) b. improving reactor efficiencies (see Section 4.3.2) c. improving catalyst systems (see Section 4.3.3). For discontinuous processes, BAT is to: 5.3 optimise yields, lower emissions and reduce waste by sequencing the addition of reactants and reagents (see Section 4.3.4). For discontinuous processes, BAT is to: 5.4 minimise cleaning operations by optimising the sequences for addition of raw and auxiliary materials (see Section 4.3.4). Product handling and storage BAT is to: 5.5 reduce the amount of residues generated by, e.g. using returnable product transportation containers/drums (see Section 4.2.1). Waste gas emissions abatement BAT is to: 5.6 minimise emissions of total dust in off-gases and achieve emission levels of 1 - 10 mg/Nm3 by using one or more of the following techniques: a. cyclone (see Section 4.4.2.1.2) b. fabric or ceramic filter (see Section 4.4.2.1.5) c. wet dust scrubber (see Section 4.4.2.1.3) d. ESP (see Section 4.4.2.1.4). The lower end of the range may be achieved by using fabric filters in combination with other abatement techniques. However, the range may be higher, depending on the carrier gas and particle characteristics (see Section 4.4.2.1). Using fabric filters is not always possible e.g. when other pollutants have to be abated (e.g. SOx) or when the offgases present humid conditions (e.g. presence of liquid acid). The particulate matters recovered/removed are recycled back into production when this is feasible. The scrubbing medium is recycled when this is feasible. BAT is to: 5.7 reduce HCN emissions and achieve emission levels of <1 mg/m3 by scrubbing with an alkaline solution. The scrubbing medium is recycled when this is feasible (see Section 4.4.2.2.5).
131
Chapter 5
BAT is to: 5.8 reduce NH3 emissions and achieve emission levels of <1.2 mg/m3 by scrubbing with an acidic solution. The scrubbing medium is recycled when this is feasible (see Section 4.4.2.2.5). BAT is to: 5.9 reduce HCl emissions, e.g. by wet gas scrubbing under alkaline conditions (see Section 4.4.2.2.4). If HCl is the main pollutant to be treated and alkali scrubbing is used, BAT is to achieve 3 10 mg/Nm3 HCl. Waste water management and water emissions abatement Waste water treatment in the SIC sector follows at least three different strategies: pretreatment within the premises of the SIC installation and final treatment(s) in a central WWTP within the premises of a larger site where the SIC installation is located pretreatment and/or final treatment(s) in a WWTP within the premises of the SIC installation pretreatment within the premises of the SIC installation and final treatment(s) in a municipal WWTP.
This document gives no preference to any of these strategies. All three strategies are considered as BAT when properly applied to the actual waste water situation provided that Article 2(6) regarding indirect releases to water is observed. The approach follows a decision pathway to come to BAT conclusions for appropriate waste water treatment for a chemical site, which is illustrated in Figure 4.1. No generic BAT conclusions on the abatement of heavy metals in waste water were derived. However, BAT conclusions on heavy metals abatement from waste water specific to three of the five illustrative families of SIC substances addressed in this document have been drawn: for speciality inorganic pigments (see Section 6.1.5, BAT 6.1.11 and BAT 6.1.12), for silicones (see Section 6.3.5, BAT 6.3.14) and for inorganic explosives (see Section 6.4.5, BAT 6.4.7). For information on heavy metals abatement in the production of substances not covered in the illustrative families sections of this document, it is recommended to refer to the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. As a general measure, BAT is to: 5.10 allocate contaminated waste water streams according to their pollutant load. Inorganic waste water without relevant organic components is segregated from organic waste water and ducted to special treatment facilities (see Section 4.4.1 and Figure 4.1). For rainwater, BAT is to: 5.11 minimise pollution to receiving watercourses by applying all of the following measures: a. minimising the contamination of rainwater from activities carried out at the installation in particular by applying measures for reducing fugitive and diffuse emissions (see BAT 5.12 and BAT 5.13 and BAT 5.17) b. ducting and storing rainwater (see Section 4.7.4) expected to be contaminated from activities carried out at the installation and treating it if necessary. Other rainwater may be directly discharged (see Section 4.7.4) c. monitoring the discharge of this other rainwater as outlined in Section 4.7.4. Rainwater found to be contaminated is treated as in b. above (see Section 4.7.4). In some cases, the use of rainwater as process water to reduce fresh water consumption may be environmentally beneficial.
132
Chapter 5
Infrastructure For diffuse emissions, BAT is to: 5.12 minimise diffuse dust emissions where dust may arise (in particular from the storage and handling of materials/products) by applying one or more of the following techniques: a. storing materials in closed systems (e.g. silos, see Section 6.3.4.1) b. using covered areas protected from rain and wind (see Section 6.3.4.1) c. having production equipment, e.g. conveyors, totally or partially enclosed (see Section 2.2) d. having equipment designed with hooding and ducting to capture diffuse dust emissions (e.g. during loading into storage) and abating it (e.g. using a fabric filter, see Section 6.3.4.1) e. carrying out housekeeping regularly, e.g. by vacuuming (see Section 4.7.6). 5.13 minimise fugitive gaseous and liquid emissions by applying (according to the substances that may require controlling) one or more of the following techniques: a. having periodic leak detection and repair programmes (see Sections 4.7.1 and 2.6.6) b. operating equipment at slightly below atmospheric pressure (see Section 6.3.4.16) c. replacing flanges by welded connections (see Section 2.6) d. using seal-less pumps and bellow valves (see Section 2.6) e. using high performance sealing systems (e.g. effective gaskets and flanges, valves and pumps with high integrity packing, see Section 2.6) f. carrying out housekeeping regularly (see Section 4.7.6).
For new installations, BAT is to: 5.14 use a computerised control system to operate the plant (see Section 4.5.2). However, this does not apply where safety issues do not permit automatic operations (e.g. in the production of SIC explosives). For installations where solid hazardous compounds can build up in pipelines, machines and vessels, BAT is to: 5.15 have in place a closed cleaning and rinsing system (see Section 4.5.1). Energy BAT is to: 5.16 reduce the consumption of energy by optimising plant design, construction and operation, e.g. by using pinch methodology, except if safety issues prevent it (see Section 4.6.1). Cross-boundary techniques BAT is to: 5.17 minimise soil and groundwater pollution by designing, building, operating and maintaining facilities, where substances (usually liquids) which represent a potential risk of contamination of ground and groundwater are handled, in such a way that material escapes are minimised (see Section 4.7.1). This includes all of the following: a. having facilities sealed, stable and sufficiently resistant against possible mechanical, thermal or chemical stress. This is particularly important for highly toxic substances e.g. cyanides, phosphorus compounds b. providing sufficient retention volumes to safely retain spills and leaking substances in order to enable treatment or disposal
133
Chapter 5
c. d. e. f. g.
i. j. k.
providing sufficient retention volume to safely retain fire fighting water and contaminated surface water carrying out loading and unloading only in designated areas protected against leakage run-off storing and collecting materials awaiting disposal in designated areas protected against leakage run-off fitting all pump sumps or other treatment plant chambers from which spillage might occur with high liquid level alarms or having pump sumps regularly inspected by personnel establishing programmes for testing and inspecting tanks and pipelines including flanges and valves h. providing spill control equipment, such as containment booms and suitable absorbent material testing and demonstrating the integrity of bunds equipping tanks with overfill prevention storing materials/products in covered areas to keep rainfall out.
BAT is to: 5.18 have a high level of education and continuous training of personnel (see Section 4.7.2). This includes all of the following: a. having personnel with sound basic education in chemical engineering and operations b. continuously training plant personnel on the jobs c. regularly evaluating and recording the performance of personnel d. regularly training personnel on how to respond to emergency situations, health and safety at work, and on product and transportation safety regulations. BAT is to: 5.19 apply, if available, the principles of an Industry Code (see Section 4.7.3). This includes all of the following: a. applying very high standards for safety, environmental and quality aspects in the production of the SIC substances b. carrying out activities such as auditing, certification, training of plant personnel (related to BAT number 5.18 and 5.22). BAT is to: 5.20 carry out a structured safety assessment for normal operation and to take into account effects due to deviations of the chemical process and deviations in the operation of the plant (see Section 4.7.5). In order to ensure that a process can be controlled adequately, BAT is to: 5.21 apply one individual or a combination of the following techniques (without ranking, see Section 4.7.5): a. organisational measures b. concepts involving control engineering techniques c. reaction stoppers (e.g. neutralisation, quenching) d. emergency cooling e. pressure resistant construction f. pressure relief. A number of environmental management techniques are determined as BAT. The scope (e.g. level of detail) and nature of the EMS (e.g. standardised or non-standardised) will generally be related to the nature, scale and complexity of the installation, and the range of environmental impacts it may have. BAT is to: 5.22 implement and adhere to an Environmental Management System (EMS) that incorporates, as appropriate to individual circumstances, the following features (see Section 4.7.6):
134 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Chapter 5
a. b. c.
d.
e.
definition of an environmental policy for the installation by top management (commitment of the top management is regarded as a precondition for the successful application of other features of the EMS) planning and establishing the necessary procedures implementation of the procedures, paying particular attention to: structure and responsibility training, awareness and competence communication employee involvement documentation efficient process control maintenance programmes emergency preparedness and response safeguarding compliance with environmental legislation checking performance and taking corrective action, paying particular attention to: monitoring and measurement (see also the Reference Document on General Principles of Monitoring) corrective and preventive action maintenance of records independent (where practicable) internal auditing in order to determine whether or not the environmental management system conforms to planned arrangements and has been properly implemented and maintained review by top management.
Three further features, which can complement the above stepwise, are considered as supporting measures. However, their absence is generally not inconsistent with BAT. These three additional steps are: f. having the management system and audit procedure examined and validated by an accredited certification body or an external EMS verifier g. preparation and publication (and possibly external validation) of a regular environmental statement describing all the significant environmental aspects of the installation, allowing for year-by-year comparison against environmental objectives and targets as well as with sector benchmarks as appropriate h. implementation and adherence to an internationally accepted voluntary system such as EMAS and EN ISO 14001:1996. This voluntary step could give higher credibility to the EMS. In particular EMAS, which embodies all the abovementioned features, gives higher credibility. However, non-standardised systems can, in principle, be equally effective provided that they are properly designed and implemented. Specifically for the SIC sector, it is also important to consider the following potential features of the EMS: i. the environmental impact from the eventual decommissioning of the unit at the stage of designing a new plant j. the development of cleaner technologies k. where practicable, the application of sectoral benchmarking on a regular basis, including energy efficiency and energy conservation activities, choice of input materials, emissions to air, discharges to water, consumption of water and generation of waste.
135
Chapter 6
Besides their function for the colouring of materials, they can also be classified as follows: magnetic data storage pigments: e.g. iron oxides (doped or non-doped), chromium oxide, metallic iron pigments, barium ferrite pigments corrosion-inhibiting pigments: e.g. phosphate pigments, borate pigments, chromate pigments interference pigments: e.g. on the basis of mica and titanium dioxide transparent pigments: e.g. iron oxide, cobalt blue phosphorescent pigments: e.g. alkaline earth sulphides fillers: e.g. calcium carbonate, synthetic amorphous silica.
137
Chapter 6
Nearly all inorganic pigments are oxides, sulphides, oxide hydroxides, silicates, sulphates or carbonates. They generally consist of particles with uniform chemical composition with the exception of effect pigments and mixtures of different pigments. 6.1.1.1 Uses The main uses of pigments are in paints and varnishes, plastics, printing inks for paper, textiles and leather, construction materials, cosmetics and ceramics. The following properties are important when determining the use of pigments: general physico-chemical properties: chemical structure, humidity content, salt content, content of substances soluble in water and/or acid, particles size distribution, density and hardness resistance to light, heat, weather conditions and chemicals (maintaining stable optical and anti-corrosive properties) properties in combination with the coating system (e.g. dispersion ability, compatibility with certain binders).
Table 6.1 gives the main application fields for some inorganic pigments in Western Europe.
Application fields Paints and varnishes Construction materials Plastics Inks for paper Ceramics and enamels Others Iron oxides 29 % 60 % 6% 2% 1% 2% Chromium oxides 50 % 25 % 10 % 7% 8% CIC 30 % 5% 45 % 20 % -
Table 6.1: Main application fields for some inorganic pigments in Western Europe
In Europe, inorganic pigments are produced in installations mainly located in Germany, Italy and Spain. Production of pigments are also reported in France, Portugal, the United Kingdom and the Netherlands.
6.1.1.1.1 Iron oxide pigments
Iron oxide pigments represent the main group of coloured pigments. Worldwide production in 1995 amounted to 600000 tonnes of synthetic pigments (pigments produced by chemical processes) and some 110000 to 120000 tonnes of natural (mined) pigments. The growing importance of iron oxide pigments is based on their chemical stability, large hue variety (yellow, orange, red, brown, black) and competitive prices compared to CIC and organic pigments. Iron oxides consist of chemically very different colouring substances, such as: h-FeOOH (yellow) i-FeOOH (yellow-orange) Fe3O4 (black) i-Fe2O3 (brown) h-Fe2O3 (red).
138
Chapter 6
The high demand of pigments for the paints and construction materials industries can virtually be satisfied by synthetic iron oxide pigments. They possess the required chemical purity and can be produced in different particle sizes, which enables variation in both hiding power and hues to be achieved. Iron oxide pigments attain their maximum scattering power at a particle size of about 0.2 [m, the hiding power being lower for both larger and smaller particles. Particles smaller than 0.01 [m lose their scattering power completely and are used for transparent colourants. Hues of synthetic iron oxide pigments can be adjusted by the selection of different qualities and particle sizes.
6.1.1.1.2 Complex Inorganic Coloured (CIC) pigments
Formerly named mixed-phase metal oxide pigments, Complex Inorganic Coloured (CIC) pigments have been renamed in order to express the fact that these pigments are not a mixture, but consist of a stable crystal lattice of different metal cations. The most important host-lattices are rutile, spinel, zircon, and haematite/corundum, but other stable structures exist.
139
Chapter 6
Rutile pigments
Spinel pigments
Zircon pigments
Haematite/corundum pigments Periclase Phenacite Olivine Baddeleyite Cassiterite Sphene Garnet Pyrochlore
Table 6.2: Examples of existing Complex Inorganic Coloured (CIC) pigments 140 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Chapter 6
In the manufacture of rutile pigments, the rutile lattice of titanium dioxide absorbs nickel (II) oxide, chromium (III) oxide, manganese (II) oxide or vanadium (III) oxide as colouring components and antimony (V) oxide, niobium (III) oxide or tungsten (III) oxide (or other modifiers) to maintain an average cation valency of four, similar to titanium. Incorporation of these oxides in the inorganic complex colour pigment results in the loss of their chemical identity and consequently of their original chemical, physical and physiological properties. Therefore, these rutile pigments are not considered as, e.g. nickel, chromium or antimony compounds, but as titanium compounds. Most of these rutile pigments are clearly defined in terms of toxicity and environmental behaviour by their own CAS and EINECS number. The same can be said about the other CIC pigment systems. The importance of CIC pigments is steadily growing due to their extremely high stability and their resistance to high temperatures.
6.1.1.1.3 Zinc sulphide pigments and precipitated barium sulphate (blanc fixe)
Zinc sulphide pigments (pure zinc sulphide and lithopone) are pigments with very high whiteness. They are important speciality chemicals and find increasing application in paints and coatings as well as in plastics and synthetic fibres. Zinc sulphide is particularly suitable for incorporation in glass fibre reinforced plastics because it is significantly less hard than titanium dioxide. Zinc sulphide does not, therefore, damage the sensitive glass fibres embedded in the plastic. Final consumers are, e.g. the building, automotive and textile industries. Glass fibre reinforced plastics are used, inter alia, for the construction of high-tech sailing yachts, plastic car bodyshells and attractively styled sports equipment. Lithopone is a mixture of zinc sulphide and precipitated barium sulphate, also containing some zinc oxide. High purity precipitated barium sulphate (also called blanc fixe) is used as a functional additive in paints and coatings, plastics and paper. In paints and coatings, it enhances the efficiency of coloured pigments by acting as a spacer between pigment particles; it is used, for example, in high quality top coats in the automotive industry. In powder coatings, it improves rheology as well as the mechanical performance parameters and permits optimum gloss values. Precisely defined particle sizes and geometries are the reason for many specialised uses of blanc fixe in plastic applications. In injection moulding, for instance, blanc fixe pigments facilitate the removal of the plastic component from the mould, while simultaneously enhancing the materials strength. In translucent plastic sheets, special blanc fixe grades ensure systematic light scattering. Used in paper production, blanc fixe has a beneficial effect on the papers brightness and photostability leading to improved printing performances. As a contrast agent in medicine, high purity barium sulphate is used in the X-ray examination of the gastrointestinal tract. 6.1.1.2 Toxicity Due to their low solubility (in water as well as in acids and alkalis), inorganic pigments bioavailability and toxicity are very low. Most inorganic pigments are respirable fine particulate matter and contain heavy metals, so precautions have to be taken to protect the health of the workers at the place of production. Although some of the raw materials used for the manufacture of CIC pigments are classified as dangerous, during the calcination process at high temperatures (around 1200 C) a reaction takes place that forms a new substance with an extremely low solubility in water as well as acids and bases, with physical, chemical and toxicological properties that are very different from the properties presented by the raw materials of origin. Chemical elements have been fixed inside a very stable cristalline structure. Therefore, for most of the CIC pigments, calcination at high temperatures acts as an inertisation process where the final product achieved presents no danger.
141
Chapter 6
6.1.1.3 Speciality inorganic pigments production and consumption in Europe and worldwide The formidable increase of manufactured coloured products has led to the significantly growing demand of colourants in the last few decades. As natural (mined) pigments have not been able to satisfy this demand, the production of inorganic pigments has steadily increased. The 1995 worldwide production of inorganic pigments (including TiO2 and carbon black) amounted to some five million tonnes for colouring purposes. The main producers are the US and Western Europe (each representing about 30 % of worldwide production). The estimated worldwide production of inorganic pigments in 1995 is given in Table 6.3 (some of the volumes reported can vary depending on the information source).
Inorganic pigments Titanium dioxide Iron oxides (natural and synthetic) Carbon black Lithopone and zinc sulphide Chromate Chromium (III) oxide Zinc oxide Molybdate Luster pigments Complex Inorganic Coloured (CIC) pigments Iron blue Ultramarine Production in kilotonnes/year 3170 720 530 190 145 48 <48 <48 <48 <48 <24 <24 Market share in % 66 15 11 4 3 1 <1 <1 <1 <1 <0.5 <0.5
The largest manufacturer of synthetic iron oxide pigments worldwide is located in Germany, with an annual production of 300000 tonnes. In 2002, the worldwide annual consumption of rutile pigments amounted to 30000 tonnes. The worldwide annual consumption of spinel and zircon pigments was about 20000 tonnes. The consumption of haematite/corundum based CIC pigments was estimated to be about 15000 tonnes. In 2002, the world production of precipitated barium sulphate was about 150000 tonnes, of which 110000 tonnes were produced in Europe. The exclusive worldwide producer of zinc sulphide pigments is located in Duisburg, Germany. At the Duisburg plant, there is integrated production of zinc sulphide, barium sulphate and lithopone with a capacity of 20000 tonnes of zinc sulphide and 75000 tonnes of barium sulphate and lithopone (composed of a mixture of barium sulphate and zinc sulphide). As the production of lithopone was shifted to China (except for the production of specialities), the Duisburg plant focuses on the production of zinc sulphide and barium sulphate pigments. It should be noted that the production of cadmium pigments has decreased strongly over the years, in part due to European legislation encouraging substitution. There is no production of these pigments in Germany, although production has been reported in France and the UK. In Europe, a speciality inorganic pigments facility produces between a few tonnes and 100000 tonnes of pigments per year.
142
Chapter 6
6.1.1.4 Features of the European speciality inorganic pigments industry In Europe, large enterprises (over 250 employees), medium sized enterprises (between 50 and 249 employees) and small companies (below 50 employees) manufacture speciality inorganic pigments. Within these companies, the workforce employed to run a pigments production facility is generally below 50. Production is carried out in small to large facilities using a continuous or a batch mode of operation. Production is carried out in standalone installations or in installations that are part of a larger chemical complex. 6.1.1.5 Economics The speciality inorganic pigments industry is a mature industry. Most processes have been developed and adapted over the past 200 years. Emerging competition from outside the EU makes further expansion of this industry within the EU difficult. Zinc sulphide, barium sulphate and the majority of lithopone pigments are already produced outside the EU.
Figure 6.1 shows the main steps in the synthesis and processing of inorganic pigments.
143
Chapter 6
Pigment synthesis
Raw material A + purity check Raw material B + purity check Raw materials + purity check Off-gas
Mixing
Pigment processing
Water Washing Wash-water Residues Off-gas Energy Drying Product
Energy
Calcination
Off-gas
Off-gas
Product
Water
Mixing/milling (wet)
Fractionating/ screening(wet)
Sludge
Waste water
6.1.2.1 Pigment synthesis There are two possible routes for pigment synthesis: the wet chemical process (wet route) the dry calcination process (dry route).
144
The wet chemical process is based on a precipitation reaction of dissolved raw material substances followed by product isolation. After a sometimes necessary purification step (e.g. for the production of zinc sulphide pigments), the raw materials are individually dissolved in water, acid, alkaline or salt solutions. The solutions are then mixed together and led into a precipitation tank for reaction. The solubility of the reaction product is much lower than the solubility of the starting materials. After the reaction step, the product is dehydrated in chamber filter presses. The dehydration step causes a leachate containing some residues of the starting raw materials, by-products of the reaction (mainly salts) and, in some cases, also a dissolved share of the desired pigment product. The wet chemical process is used when the raw materials are soluble, which is the case for metal sulphates, chlorides or hydroxides. In the case of oxides, which are sparingly soluble or insoluble, the dry calcination process is used instead. In most technologies dissolving and/or precipitation of (pre)pigments need a given acidity/alkalinity of solution (optimal pH range). Consequently, the pH value of the waste water resulting from the production of inorganic pigments using a wet chemical process may have environmental importance.
6.1.2.1.2 Dry calcination process
Calcination can be divided into thermal decomposition/conversion and high temperature reaction. In thermal decomposition/conversion, the raw material is decomposed at high temperatures (between approximately 150 and 1300 C), e.g. oxidation of iron sulphate with oxygen to form Fe2O3 and SO3. This process requires the strict monitoring of the temperature/time curve of the reaction. In the high temperature reaction, the raw materials react with each other in a so-called solid phase reaction, which leads to the formation of the desired pigments. The reaction takes place at temperatures between 500 and 1400 C, below the individual melting temperatures of the raw materials. The raw materials used are essentially metal oxides, hydroxides or carbonates, and only exceptionally other metal compounds. In some cases, mineralisers (such as sulphates, chlorides and fluorides) are used in minor amounts, which give rise to emissions of such substances into the air. Gaseous reaction products leave the reaction chamber through the same emission point (not necessarily at the same time) as the off-gas in both thermal decomposition/conversion and high temperature reaction processes.
6.1.2.1.3 Environmental impact of pigment synthesis
The wet chemical and the dry calcination processes have different environmental impacts. The wet chemical process requires a large amount of water and produces a large amount of waste water, whereas the dry calcination process requires less water but more energy. In the wet chemical process, a reduction of emissions can mainly be obtained by suitable waste water treatment methods, while in dry calcination, environmental measures concentrate on the minimisation of off-gas emissions and energy use. Rarely can either of the two routes be used to manufacture the desired pigment product. The product quality specifications often impose the production route to use.
145
Chapter 6
6.1.2.2 Pigment processing The following process steps can be found in pigment processing: product washing for eliminating soluble by-products (e.g. salts) drying (after wet processing steps) calcination for restructuring the pigment particles mixing/milling for adapting the particle size (milling can be carried out through wet or dry processes) followed by filtration/screening and drying in the case of wet milling.
All these steps are not necessarily applied for producing every type of pigment; the choice of applying all or some of these steps depends on the following conditions: the required quality of the end-product the raw materials used the pigment synthesis process used (wet chemical process or dry calcination).
Regardless of which pigment synthesis process is used, in some cases pigments require a washing step in order to eliminate soluble salts. The washing step generates waste water heavily loaded with salts. After washing, pigments have to be thermally dried. The drying provokes offgases and condensate residues. Because the very fine pigment particles fuse into larger units (known as aggregates, which, on cooling, flocculate to form agglomerates) in the outlet of the dryer, the product must be milled after the drying step in order to obtain the required very fine particle size. Dry milling may cause dust emissions. Washing, drying and milling production steps are carried out for the production of pigments such as chromium yellow, molybdate orange, iron blue, cadmium yellow, bismuth vanadate and lead chromate as well as anti-corrosive pigments such as zinc potassium chromate, zinc or strontium chromate, zinc and chromium phosphate. For the production of some pigments (e.g. cadmium pigments), an additional calcination step is required in order to restructure the pigment particles. 6.1.2.3 Measures for reduction of emissions Without the necessity of analysing the processes of pigment manufacturing in more detail, the systematic classification of the possible processes described earlier already reveals the basic principles of waste gas and waste water treatment in the production of inorganic pigments.
6.1.2.3.1 Principle of waste gas treatment
The main sources of exhaust gas emissions are kilns (rotary, chamber, tunnel kilns), as well as dryers and grinders (in the dry milling of pigments). Selection of a particular off-gas treatment depends on the off-gas constituents. Table 6.4 gives examples of off-gas treatments depending on the pollutants contained in the off-gas.
146
Chapter 6 Off-gas treatment - cyclone Kiln CIC pigments - electrostatic precipitator Dust and heavy Grinder (dry Chromium (III) oxide pigments - neutral or alkaline metals milling) Iron oxide pigments washing Dryer Zinc sulphide pigments - fabric filter CIC pigments - oxidation of SO2 to SO3 SO2 Kiln Chromium (III) oxide pigments and washing to H2SO4 - alkaline washing Zinc sulphide pigments NOX Kiln CIC pigments CIC pigments (i.e. zircon Kiln Fluoride - lime washing pigments) - combustion - condensation (for high Iron oxides by the Laux Organic compounds Reactor VOC concentration) process - catalytic oxidation (for low VOC concentration) Table 6.4: Off-gas treatments for the production of inorganic pigments Pollutant Source Pigment production
6.1.2.3.1.1
Depending on the desired quality of the product, the required pigment particle size has to be between 0.01 and 30 [m, which generally causes dust containing heavy metal (most of the pigments produced contain heavy metals) emissions from the pigment production processes. To reduce total dust emissions, off-gas streams from calcination kilns are led into a cyclone. In a second step, pigment producers mainly use other dry processes like fabric filters or electrostatic precipitators to further abate total dust (the treatment techniques chosen fabric filters or electrostatic precipitators largely depend on the temperature of the exhaust gases and the particle weight). The particulates abated can be recycled back into the process. Alternatively, washing can be used, which however, causes effluents, which have to be treated. Washing processes are preferred only in cases where other pollutants, besides dust, also have to be eliminated. The calcination of pigments in ceramic saggars normally generates very low total dust levels and no additional off-gas treatment (besides the cyclone) is required. This is because saggars are very tightly stacked together in the kiln leaving a very small quantity of pigment powder in contact with the atmosphere of the kiln. Normally, natural gas is used as the energy source for the kiln and the dryer. Figure 6.2 shows an off-gas treatment for reducing total dust from the exhaust gas of a dryer and from the exhaust gas resulting from a miller/grinder.
147
Chapter 6
Pigment suspension from pigment manufacturing Dust Cyclone Energy Dryer Dust Cyclone Miller/ grinder Filter Off-gas Filter Off-gas
Product
Figure 6.2: Off-gas treatment for reducing total dust from the exhaust gas of a dryer and a miller/grinder
6.1.2.3.1.2
Sulphur dioxide emissions are generated if sulphur is added as a reduction agent to the reaction process or as a raw material impurity (e.g. in the production of chromium (III) oxide pigments). Two different off-gas treatment methods are reported to be used in the production of inorganic pigments for the elimination of SO2: alkaline washing with caustic soda when washing with caustic soda, SO2 is converted into sodium sulphite. In some cases, hydrogen peroxide (H2O2) can be added to the effluent, in order to accelerate the generation of sodium sulphate: SO2 + 2NaOH X Na2SO3 + H2O Na2SO3 + H2O2 X Na2SO4 + H2O conversion of SO2 to SO3 with subsequent H2SO4 recovery whereas the alkaline washing of the off-gas results in waste water, the oxidation of SO2 to SO3 results in the production of sulphuric acid, which can be recycled: SO2 + O2 X SO3 SO3 + H2O X H2SO4 Another technique has been reported to be applicable: dry fluidisation using lime powder: SO2 + CaCO3 X CaSO3 + CO2
148
In the production of inorganic pigments, waste water mainly originates from: off-gas scrubbing mother liquor washing of product (pigments) cleaning of vessels and floors.
Water effluents from the manufacture of inorganic pigments, mainly in the case of wet chemical processes, are loaded with the following pollutants: dissolved heavy metal compounds (e.g. lead, chromium, cobalt, copper, nickel cadmium, zinc) suspended pigments and insoluble by-products from the reaction (e.g. Cr(OH)3) alkaline salts of the used mineral acids single materials (depending on the production process) such as sulphides from the production of zinc sulphide pigments, nitrate and nitrite from the production of lead chromate, bismuth vanadate, cadmium pigments, and fluoride and vanadium from the production of zircon pigments.
Such compositions of the water effluent determines which waste water treatment to apply: concentration of waste water volumes (e.g. evaporation, drying) pretreatment, in the case of high pollutant loads with material recovery (by precipitation and flocculation) and recycling back into the pigment production treatment by single measures (e.g. chromium (VI) reduction) neutralisation and precipitation/flocculation of the total waste water.
Figure 6.3 shows a flow diagram of the treatment of water effluents (in certain cases a pretreatment is not necessary). As the production of pigments by wet chemical processes is usually discontinuous, leachates are led into a buffer tank before being treated. In order to avoid resulting toxicity problems for fishes in complex chemical plants, effluents from certain production processes can be mixed with other less loaded effluents before being released to the receiving water (in the case of large SIC pigment installations) or before being discharged into municipal waste water treatment plants (in the case of smaller SIC pigment installations).
149
Chapter 6
Leachate from wet chemical processes
Buffer tank
Washwater
Mixing unit
Sedimentation+ dehydration
Neutralisation+ precipitation/flocculation
Sedimentation+ dehydration
Residues to disposal
In precipitation/flocculation, the pH value is adjusted by adding sodium hydroxide (NaOH), lime milk (Ca(OH)2) or soda, and heavy metals are precipitated as hydroxides. After sedimentation and dehydration, filtration residues can be recycled back into the process when there is no adverse effect on pigment quality, e.g. in the manufacture of cadmium pigments, lithopone pigments, precipitated barium sulphate pigments, chromium oxide and iron oxide pigments. For lead chromate, recycling of sludge is not viable. The pretreated effluents may be mixed with other water streams from the production process, (e.g. rinsing and cleaning water) and are led again to precipitation/flocculation, where the pH value is adjusted, in order to achieve an optimised separation of pollutants. Solid residues are filtered, dehydrated, recycled back into the process or disposed of. Water effluents can be discharged to the receiving water or led into a central Waste Water Treatment Plant (WWTP) in the case of large production plants. A biological treatment for the elimination of organic traces is necessary for the Laux process in the manufacture of iron oxide pigments, a special process which is described in Section 6.1.2.4.2. The Laux process is reported to be used by only one company in Europe and by companies in India as a unique process. It therefore has no general validity. Biological treatment (denitrification) is also necessary for nitrate-loaded streams from the production of bismuth vanadate and lead chromate pigments.
150 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Chapter 6
Besides the treatment of water effluents, measures for reducing waste water volumes can be applied, such as: optimisation of washing processes by the multiple use of leachate in order to concentrate salts to facilitate disposal treatment methods used for dry waste gases.
If the waste gases are treated by scrubbing (because of the reliability and good cleaning results of scrubbers), the waste water generated by the scrubbing operation is treated as described above. 6.1.2.4 Iron oxide pigments Iron oxide pigments mainly consist of iron oxides or iron oxide hydroxides in different crystal modifications. Several chemical processes are used industrially in Europe for producing iron oxide pigments: precipitation process (yellow, red, orange and black pigments) Penniman-Zoph process (yellow, red, orange, and black pigments) Laux process (black, brown, yellow and red pigments).
Further information on the production of iron oxide pigments can be found in the LVIC-S BREF [24, European IPPC Bureau, 2004].
6.1.2.4.1 Precipitation and Penniman-Zoph processes
By the oxidation of iron (II) sulphate solutions under certain reaction conditions and the use of certain germs, yellow, black and red pigments can be manufactured, the most important being the yellow pigments (h-FeOOH). Crystalline h-FeOOH germs are very fine and can be used as transparent pigments. In order to obtain pigments with high hiding power, these germs have to grow to a certain size necessary for the hue. Either the precipitation process or the Penniman-Zoph process can be used to grow the pigment particles. Aqueous oxidation processes generally have two phases: generation of defined germs growth to a certain particle size.
151
Chapter 6
Steam Air
Germ reactor
Off-gas Off-gas
Precipitation process
Penniman-Zoph process
Scrap iron
Germ solution
Steam Air
Pigment reactor
Steam Air
Off-gas
Figure 6.4: Wet processes for the production of iron oxide pigments and measures for the reduction of emissions
In the precipitation process, an iron (II) sulphate solution, sodium hydroxide and air are added for achieving the particle growth. Iron oxidation is carried out in a reactor at a temperature of about 70 C with the addition of steam. The reaction equation is as follows: (1) 2FeSO4 + 4NaOH + O2 X 2FeOOH + 2Na2SO4 + H2O
The iron (II) sulphate solutions are residues coming from other industries, such as titanium dioxide production or liquor from the pickling of iron and steel. In order to ensure a stable product quality, these production residues can only be used if they do not contain colouring ions, such as manganese (II) or chromium (III), because of their adverse effect on the quality of the iron oxide pigments. The Penniman-Zoph process (the most widely used production method for yellow iron oxide pigments) takes place by the addition of scrap iron, which is dissolved and oxidised with air in the pigment reactor without adding any other chemical substances. By defined rusting of the scrap iron, a pigment suspension with a slightly acidic pH value is obtained. The advantage of the Penniman-Zoph process in comparison to the precipitation process is that it considerably reduces the quantity of neutral salts (e.g. Na2SO4, NaCl) formed as by-products because the sulphuric acid generated by iron (II) sulphate hydrolysis-oxidation (reaction (3) below) reacts with the scrap iron to produce iron (II) sulphate (reaction (4) below): Summarising reaction: (2) 2Fe + 3H2O + O2 FeSO4 X catalysis 2FeOOH + 2H2
152
Chapter 6
Basic reactions: (3) (4) 2FeSO4 + 3H2O + O2 X 2FeOOH + 2H2SO4 Fe + H2SO4 X FeSO4 + H2
For accelerating the reaction, the temperature is kept stable at about 80 C by adding steam. The air quantity has to be controlled to minimise the risk of explosions, but also to minimise emissions of heat and waste gas. One solution to achieve this is to operate above the temperature at which the vapour pressure of water is high enough to blanket the reactors dome. Scrap iron residues from other industries are used. In the Penniman-Zoph process for the production of yellow iron oxide, different yellow hues may be obtained by variation of the process parameters (different germ size). The same process can also be used for the manufacture of black iron oxide pigments. For the pigment growth, however, the precipitation process is preferred. For obtaining black pigments, iron (II) salt solutions are neutralised by adding alkali and is oxidised by the addition of air at temperatures of between 90 100 C, up to the point where an iron (II)/iron (III) ratio of 0.5 (Fe3O4) is obtained. Under suitable conditions for germ growth and after the complete oxidation, a similar process can also be used to produce very fine h-Fe2O3 germs necessary for easily dispersible h-Fe2O3 red pigments with a high colour strength. The wet processes for the manufacture of iron oxide pigments as well as measures for the reduction of emissions are presented in Figure 6.5.
153
Chapter 6
Iron (II) sulphate NaOH+ purity check Scrap iron solution Air Steam
Synthesis
Off-gas
Separation
Mother liquor
Cyclone
Drying/ calcination
Electrostatic precipitator
Off-gas
Cyclone
Mixing/milling/ packaging
Rinse-water
Textile filter Product Off-gas Waste Waste water to receiving water or WWTP Precipitation/flocculation
Figure 6.5: Process steps of aqueous oxidation processes in the production of iron oxide pigments
The pigment synthesis carried out by the precipitation process (FeSO4 solution and NaOH) or the Penniman-Zoph process (scrap iron) is followed by pigment separation. As already described above, the pigments are washed, dried and, if necessary, calcined and milled.
154
Thermic process steps such as drying, calcination or dry milling are potential sources of dust emissions. In many cases, the first off-gas treatment takes place in cyclones, but their cleaning performance is generally not sufficient, because they can only separate coarse particles. Further off-gas treatments are selected according to different aspects. Due to the small size of the pigment particles, electrostatic precipitators or fabric filters have to be used. As fabric filters are easily jammed under humid conditions, electrostatic precipitators are often preferred for the cleaning of waste gas coming from dryers. In milling processes which cause an off-gas with a low humidity content, textile filters may be advantageous.
6.1.2.4.1.2 Waste water treatment
As shown in Figure 6.5, water effluent streams consist of leachate, wash-water and rinse-water. Pigments insoluble in water are separated in a sedimentation basin and recycled back into production, when possible. Residual effluents from the precipitation process or the PennimanZohp process are quite different. In the precipitation process, as revealed by reaction equation (1), Na2SO4 is generated as a byproduct. Residual FeSO4 is also discharged with the water effluents, so that the waste water contains high concentrations of salts and suspended solid materials. In the Penniman-Zoph process, scrap iron is added and converted into the desired product by the addition of water and oxygen. In the chemical reaction, sulphuric acid is obtained as an interim product equation (3) which is immediately consumed equation (4) . Alkali salts are not added or generated in this process. Consequently, the effluents from the Penniman-Zoph process contain fewer salts than the waste water from the precipitation process. For the Penniman-Zoph process, as well as for the precipitation process, the water effluent treatment consists of an oxidation step to transform iron (II) to iron (III) by aeration with oxygen followed by a precipitation/flocculation step (with the addition of a base and a soda as precipitation chemicals if necessary). In some cases, a defoaming agent and/or a flocculant are added into the waste water. The iron (II) content can also be diminished in a neutralisation phase after the reaction step: an alkali solution and oxygen/air react with iron (II) to produce iron (III) oxide.
6.1.2.4.2 Laux process
Another aqueous oxidation process for the production of iron oxide pigments is the Laux process, presented in Figure 6.6. By adding iron (II) chloride or aluminium chloride solutions, sulphuric acid and phosphoric acid (acting as catalysts), Laux modified the former aniline process (reduction of aromatic nitro compounds with metallic iron) to avoid unsuitable iron oxide residues and to yield high quality iron oxide pigments with a high colour strength. Fe3O4 pigments can directly be used or can be converted further to high quality red pigments hFe2O3 by calcination. The addition of aluminum chloride (instead of iron (II) chloride) leads to the formation of high quality h-FeOOH yellow pigments. Further addition of iron (II) or aluminum chloride solution and phosphoric acid can modify the properties of the iron oxide pigments.
155
Chapter 6
Nitrobenzene Iron Water Cooling water FeCl2 Additives Steam
Traces of hydrogen and aniline
To combustion
Reactor
Fe3O4 paste FeOOH paste
Condenser
Aniline
Classifier
Water
Thickeners
Leachates
Biological treatment Waste to disposal To receiving water To receiving water Waste to disposal
Off-gas
Water
Washwater
Precipitation/ flocculation
Dehydration
Off-gas
Filter
Energy
Energy
Filter Dust
Cyclone
Off-gas
Dryer
Rotary kiln
Cyclone
Off-gas
Red pigments
The raw iron materials for the Laux process are mainly iron grindings from iron casting or forging that must be virtually free of oil and grease. Iron particle size, metallurgical state and the rate of addition of the iron and nitrobenzene (or other nitro compound) determine the quality of the resulting pigments. The iron (II) chloride solutions come from steel staining plants, among other sources. The chemical reaction equations for the production of Fe3O4 black pigments and h-FeOOH yellow pigments are respectively: 4C6H5NO2 + 9Fe + 4H2O X 3Fe3O4 + 4C6H5NH2 C6H5NO2 + 2Fe + 2H2O X 2FeOOH + C6H5NH2
156 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Chapter 6
The black pigments (Fe3O4) and yellow pigments (h-FeOOH) are formed in the absence of bases, and nitrobenzene (C6H5NO2) is used as an oxidation agent. At the end of the reaction most of the aniline (C6H5NH2) is separated by condensation, the residue being distilled off by steam distillation. The waste gas from the condenser containing hydrogen and traces of aniline is led to a power plant for combustion. The pigment in the reactor is a paste, which, besides FeCl2, also contains residual iron. Excess iron chips are separated from the pigment in a classifier. They can be re-used in the cement/steel industry or have to be disposed of. After iron separation, the pigment paste is washed and directed, free of salts, into thickeners and then into rotary vacuum filters. While aniline containing leachates from the thickeners are fed into the central waste water treatment plant, the wash-water from filtration is led to the central waste water precipitation plant. Depending on the desired product, the pigment paste is subsequently dried and ground (black or yellow pigments) or calcined in a rotary kiln and ground (red pigments). The waste gas from the dryer and the rotary kiln is led over cyclones for total dust separation and further on into electrostatic precipitators. 6.1.2.5 Chromium (III) oxide pigments A plant in Germany produces chromium oxides in a solid state process. The manufacturing process and the subsequent pigment preparation processes are shown in Figure 6.7. In this solid state process, sodium dichromate (Na2Cr2O7) is reduced with sulphur by intensively mixing the components and subsequent calcination in a rotary disc kiln at 800 to 1000 C. Na2Cr2O7 + S X Cr2O3 + Na2SO4 The calcination by-product is sodium sulphate. The reaction generates SO2 emissions. After the reaction, water-soluble salts are separated off by washing-filtration. The product is then dried, ground and finally packed for transportation. Sodium dichromate raw material is produced together with sodium chromate by a process in which ground chrome ore and soda ash are mixed (lime and/or leached calcine are sometimes added as well), roasted in an oxidising atmosphere, and leached with weak chromate liquor or water. The impure sodium chromate resulting from these operations is further neutralised, filtered and converted to sodium dichromate.
6.1.2.5.1 Waste gas treatment
The main waste gas emission sources stem from the mixing step, the rotary disc kiln, the drying step and the milling of the product. The dust-loaded off-gas from the mixing is purified by a washer, which causes waste water charged with the pollutants removed from the waste gas. The waste gas from the rotary disc kiln is mainly loaded with dust, heavy metals and sulphur dioxide. The waste gas is purified from its total dust content in a washer where the abating water used is the spent water of the previous washer (see Figure 6.7). SO2 is oxidised to SO3, the latter being converted in a washer to 10 20 % sulphuric acid by the addition of water. The obtained washing liquor is used for the waste water acidification before the reduction of chromate. Waste gas streams from the dryer and the milling process are treated in the off-gas treatments for separation as described above.
157
Chapter 6
Off-gas Na2Cr2O7 Sulphur Off-gas Mixer Washer Off-gas Energy Off-gas Rotary disc kiln Washer NaOH SO2 Water Slurry SO3 Filtrate Precipitation/ flocculation FHM Water
Chromate reduction
Water
Sedimentation/ Dehydration
Energy
Dryer
Off-gas Dust
Mill Waste water Cyclone Off-gas Dust Water Dust ESP or bag filter Off-gas Washer Off-gas ESP or bag filter To receiving water
Packaging
158
The main water effluent streams and their composition are summarised in Table 6.5.
Process step Mixing Product washing Mixing/milling, packaging Effluent source Wash-water from off-gas washer Wash-water Rinse-water Pollutants Sodium dichromate Sodium sulphate Sodium dichromate Suspended pigments Suspended pigments
Table 6.5: Main water effluent streams for the production of chromium(III) oxide pigments
Chromium (VI) has to be separated from the waste water. Consequently, unreacted sodium dichromate is reduced first to chromium (III) by the addition of sulphur dioxide or sodium hydrogen sulphite. A slight excess of the reduction agent is dosed in order to yield a complete reaction. This causes a sulphite load and a COD in the waste water. The chromate reduction is carried out under slightly acidic conditions. In order to obtain the necessary pH value, sulphuric acid obtained from waste gas treatment of the calcination is added. After the chromate reduction, chromium (III) is precipitated with a sodium base as chromium hydroxide by the addition of flocculation agents (FHM). The sediment is mechanically dehydrated and recycled back into the process. Together with other effluent streams, the total waste water from the chromium (III) oxide pigment production is purified again in a precipitation step and then discharged into the receiving water. The specific water demand is about 60 m3/t of pigments produced.
6.1.2.5.3 Waste
The chromium hydroxides obtained in the precipitation after the chromate reduction are recovered and recycled back into the process. Other residues from the precipitation step have to be discharged into a suitable disposal site. 6.1.2.6 Complex Inorganic Coloured (CIC) pigments The manufacture of complex inorganic coloured pigments is presented in a flow diagram in Figure 6.8. The production process of rutile and spinel pigments consists of a reaction of fine metal oxides, hydroxides or carbonates at temperatures of between 800 and 1400 C. The reaction process is accelerated by the selection of finely dispersed reaction materials. The starting materials in the manufacture of CIC pigments are weighed, intimately mixed and calcined either in a rotary or tunnel kiln (continuously) or in a chamber kiln (discontinuously). After the calcination process, the clinker obtained needs, in some cases, to be purified from soluble substances by intensive wet grinding, then dried and, if necessary, milled again.
6.1.2.6.1 Waste gas treatment
The manufacture of rutile pigments requires reactive anatase or titanium dioxide hydrolysate containing chemically bound sulphuric acid. For the oxidation of antimony, air is led into the calcination process. Waste gas leaving the combustion process is purified from raw material dust particles and other gases (e.g. SO2, NOX) by particle separators and other off-gas treatments. The dust recuperated can often be recycled back into the process. Fluoride contained in the off-gases from the synthesis of zirconium silicate pigments could be removed by lime washing.
Speciality Inorganic Chemicals 159
The volume and content of pollutants of the water effluents resulting from the production process depend on the pigments produced. Water effluents contain dissolved neutral salts and suspended solid materials (oxides and pigments). The suspended solid materials are treated by flocculation and are separated from the waste water. Solid residues per tonne of pigment product are quite small (see Section 6.1.3.1.3 below).
Raw materials + purity check Wet process Dry process Off-gas
Water
Drying
Energy
Wet milling
Water
Dry milling
Washing
Water
Drying Cr Co Cu Ni Zn
Dry milling
160
Chapter 6
The processes used to produce zinc sulphide and lithopone (composed of a mixture of barium sulphate and zinc sulphide) pigments are very similar and closely connected to the processes used to produce barium sulphate pigments (the sodium sulphide by-product of barium sulphate precipitation is used in zinc sulphide precipitation). Additionally, a close connection exists in the field of waste water treatment. Figure 6.9 shows a flow diagram for the production of lithopone pigments. Zinc sulphide pigments are produced from zinc sulphate and sodium sulphide in accordance with the following equation: ZnSO4 + Na2S X ZnS + Na2SO4 Lithopone is produced by precipitation of zinc sulphate with barium sulphide: ZnSO4 + BaS X ZnS + BaSO4
Figure 6.9: Flow diagram for the production of lithopone pigments [1, Ullmann, 2001]
For the production of zinc sulphide and lithopone pigments, raw zinc salt solutions (zinc leachates) obtained from other companies are used.
Speciality Inorganic Chemicals 161
Chapter 6
The source of zinc can be zinc oxide from a smelter, zinc dross or sweepings, ammonium chloride slag from hot dip galvanising, or liquid waste such as pickle liquors from galvanising plants. The main source of zinc sulphate solutions is from electrolysis and the production of zinc scrap and zinc oxide [1, Ullmann, 2001]. The solutions of zinc salts containing impurities need to be purified. The first stage of purification consists of chlorination. Iron and manganese are precipitated as oxide-hydroxides, and cobalt, nickel, and cadmium as hydroxides. Subsequently, the solutions are mixed with zinc dust at 80 C (cementation). All the elements more noble than zinc (e.g. cadmium, nickel, cobalt, copper) are almost completely precipitated, while zinc develops into a solution. The zinc sludge is filtered off and taken to copper smelters for recovery of the noble metal components (second purification stage). Afterwards, the purified zinc sulphate solution is converted with sodium sulphide whereby zinc sulphide and sodium sulphate are formed. In the case of lithopone, barium sulphide is used instead of sodium sulphide. The sodium sulphide applied is a by-product of the production of barium sulphate which is made of barium sulphide and sodium sulphate. The further preparation of zinc sulphide pigments and lithopone is identical. In order to achieve the required pigment properties, the precipitated product is drained, dried and calcined. The hot product is then quenched in water, sedimented, dried, ground and packed for transportation.
6.1.2.7.1.1 Waste gas treatment
The main waste gas sources are from the thermic processes: drying and calcining of the pigments. Both processes are emission sources of dust, heavy metals and sulphur dioxide. The waste gases are purified in a two-step gas cleaning system. In the first step, dust is washed out with water; the pigment is recovered by sedimentation and recycled back into production. In the second step, sulphur dioxide reacts with the zinc oxide suspension, a zinc sulphite solution is formed, which is re-used as a starting material for the production of zinc sulphate.
6.1.2.7.1.2 Solid by-products
The solids, containing iron and manganese, which precipitate during the first purification step of the zinc leachate, are recycled externally. The metal sludges, produced during cementation, are supplied to zinc smelteries.
6.1.2.7.2 Precipitated barium sulphate pigments
Starting materials are natural barites with a barium sulphate content of more than 90 %. Barites are reduced to water soluble barium sulphide by reaction with coke: BaSO4 + 2C X BaS + 2CO2 BaSO4 + 4C X BaS + 4CO The by-products are carbon dioxide and sulphur dioxide. As there is a small excess of oxygen in the reaction, carbon monoxide is readily transformed to carbon dioxide. The barium sulphide is leached in water and purified by separation and filtration.
162
Chapter 6
The largest amount of barium sulphate is obtained by precipitation of barium sulphide with sodium sulphate: BaS + Na2SO4 X BaSO4 + Na2S The sodium sulphide by-product may be used in different ways: it can be concentrated and used as a dehairing agent in the leather industry or it can be used as an intermediate for the production of inorganic and organic sulphides. In some cases, it is transformed to hydrogen sulphide and used in the Claus process for the production of sulphur. In a plant in Germany, sodium sulphide is mainly used for the precipitation of zinc sulphide. Excess amounts are transformed to hydrogen sulphide, which is converted into sulphuric acid at a nearby sulphuric acid plant. Special barium sulphate is generally produced by the reaction of barium chloride with sodium sulphate: BaCl2 + Na2SO4 X BaSO4 + 2NaCl Barium chloride is obtained by the reaction of barium sulphide with hydrochloric acid. The hydrogen sulphide generated is also converted into sulphuric acid. The precipitated barium sulphate is then isolated by filtration or separation, purified by intensive washing with water, dried and ground. According to the different applications, inorganic and organic treatment is necessary either before or after drying.
6.1.2.7.2.1 Waste gas treatment
The waste gases from the production of barium sulphide contain dust, heavy metals and sulphur dioxide. Dust and heavy metals are removed by electrostatic precipitators. At the Sachtleben plant, the elimination of sulphur dioxide is carried out in a two step reaction: first sulphur dioxide is absorbed in cold polyglycolic ether; second, the waste gas is desorbed at elevated temperatures and led to the production of sulphuric acid. Waste gas of the barium sulphate drying process only contains dust which is washed out with water and recycled back into the production process.
6.1.2.7.2.2 Solid residues
The amount of solid residues remaining from the barium sulphide leaching and purification significantly depends on the quality of the natural barites used. The solid residues contain insoluble barium compounds, silica and carbon. They are dewatered and sent to landfill.
163
The production of zinc sulphide and barium sulphate pigments is an integrated process, which is tightly combined when considering waste water treatment. Waste water, containing zinc salts from the production of zinc sulphide pigments, is treated with sodium sulphide solution. Waste water, containing sulphide from the production of barium sulphate, is treated with zinc salt solution. In both cases, insoluble zinc sulphide precipitates and is recycled back into the production process. Possibly dissolved barium salt is precipitated with sodium sulphate and recycled back into the production process. As all solids arising from the process are recycled back into production, the waste water treatment works without any solid waste production. For the production of zinc sulphide, lithopone and barium sulphate pigments, the different sources of waste water are listed in Table 6.6 together with their main pollutants.
Process step Draining of preliminary products Drying of preliminary products Thermic process Washing and draining of finished products Drying of finished products Purification of production lines Type of waste water Filtrate water Off-gas scrubbing water Off-gas scrubbing water Filtrate water Off-gas scrubbing water Rinsing and purification water Pollutants Sodium chloride Sodium sulphate Suspended pigments Suspended solids Suspended pigments Sulphite Solved zinc Suspended pigments Suspended pigments Suspended pigments
Table 6.6: Sources of waste water from the production of zinc sulphide, lithopone and barium sulphate pigments
Energy consumption depends on the chemical process used, the technology used, as well as market needs and availability of energy sources such as natural gas as a clean energy source.
164
Chapter 6
Table 6.7 provides some examples for the consumption of energy in the production of SIC pigments.
Type of pigments produced Zinc sulphide Electricity consumption MWh/yr/t of pigments 5.74 Heat consumption MWh/yr/t of pigments Main source(s) of energy use Calcination in electric furnace Drying Calcination in electric furnace Milling in ball mills Sieving with standard mesh Calcination in intermittent kilns Drying
Example plants
F1
G1
Strontium aluminates
39.07
H2
1 2
CIC
6.54
Table 6.7: Consumption of energy at several plants producing SIC pigments in Europe
Concentration levels of pollutants measured in the off-gas after treatment at several plants in Europe are given in Table 6.8. The levels given are based on daily average values and data from a few months up to one year.
165
Example plants
Source(s) of off-gas
Drying a Milling b Product handling b
Off-gas treatment(s) i
NOX
NH3
SO2
Zn
Pb
Cr
A1
Bismuth vanadate Lead chromate Iron oxide Lead chromate CIC Iron oxide a Chromium oxide b Zinc sulphide
0.109
0.513
a b
<20
<16
D1
<100 4
Drying Raw materials weighting and mixing b Calcination a Drying b Raw materials weighting and mixing b Calcination b Milling Sieving b Raw materials weighting and mixing ab Calcination abc Grinding b Drying b
a a
Fabric filters ESP b Fabric filters Wet scrubber (alkaline) b Fabric filter
a
0.16
11.75
G2
Strontium aluminates
2.2
56
Fabric filter
CIC
24
ab
0.2 2
32 65
The values indicated in this table are daily average values in mg/Nm3. 1 TWG comments 2 TWG comment 3 TWG comment 4 limit set in the permit i To avoid the generation of waste water, dry treatment methods for waste gas are favoured [39, Karschunke, 2004] a b , or c refer to the off-gas treatment(s) mentioned on the same line in the last column of the table
Table 6.8: Concentration levels of pollutants measured in the off-gas after treatment at several plants producing pigments in Europe
166
In the precipitation and Penniman Zoph processes, emissions of dust and heavy metals are minimised by using cyclones and electrostatic precipitators (or fabric filters). In the Laux process, hydrogen is produced in the reactor. The off-gas containing hydrogen, which is loaded with traces of aniline, is disposed of by combustion in a central power plant. The waste gas from the dryer and/or the calcination kiln is mainly loaded with dust, and is treated in cyclones and electrostatic precipitators.
6.1.3.1.2.2 CIC pigments
In general, for the removal of total dust arising from the production of CIC pigments, an electrostatic precipitator or a bag filter is used in conjunction, where appropriate, with a dry or semi-dry acid gas scrubbing system. The emission level reported to be achieved with these techniques is <1.5 30 mg/Nm3 [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. The maximum value for NOX emissions is considered to be 400 mg/Nm3 at the O2 percentage existing in the off-gas. The above given emission levels are peak levels and do not represent the average level over the entire calcination process, as the majority of pigment production is discontinuous. For fluoride (where applicable), the maximum values are about 5 mg/Nm3. The maximum value for SO2 is 500 mg/Nm3 at the O2 percentage exiting in the off-gas using natural gas as fuel.
6.1.3.1.3 Water consumption and emission
The techniques used to treat waste water at several plants producing pigments in Europe are presented in Table 6.9. Concentration levels of pollutants measured in the waste water after treatment at several plants in Europe is given in Table 6.10. When the WWTP is operated by an external company, the operator charges its clients (e.g. the SIC producer) according to their load (e.g. COD, N, P) the conditions are fixed in a service provider contract. This entails a precise monitoring of the effluents coming in the WWTP and leads an efficient waste water treatment.
167
Waste water treatment(s) Precipitation, flocculation, sedimentation, sand filtration Additional effluent filtration with fabric cartridges (<=50 m) Final biological treatment in municipal WWTP Dewatering of sludge by filter press and disposal as hazardous waste Pretreatment of high-loaded streams (Pb, Sb): Flow balancing Precipitation, flocculation, sedimentation Dewatering of sludge by filter press The effluent from pretreatment is directed to the neutralisation step of the general waste water treatment General waste water treatment: Flow balancing Reduction Neutralisation (multistage) Precipitation/flocculation Sedimentation Filtration Sludge is dewatered in a filter press and disposed of Filtrate from dewatering or concentrate from backwash is led back to neutralisation Biological treatment (denitrification) for nitrate-loaded streams from the production of bismuth vanadate (350 kg/t) and lead chromate (90 kg/t): Some metals have to be removed prior to denitrification to prevent contamination of activated sludge Methanol, ethanol or sugar solutions are used as carbon nutrient sources Flow balancing First reaction stage Second reaction stage Separation (sludge is returned to the first reaction tank)
C1
Air scrubbing in wet or hot process steps like dissolution, oxidation of pigments/materials Mother liquor Washing of pigments Cleaning of vessels and floors
C1
Iron oxide Lead chromate CIC Iron oxide Chromium oxide Filtration Cleaning of vessels and floors
The effluent is discharged to a municipal waste water treatment plant Iron oxide sludge from waste water treatment is recycled back to the process Pretreatment of high-loaded streams (Crtotal >10 mg/l): Flow balancing Reduction of Cr(VI) to Cr(III) by sulphite Precipitation Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
168
The pretreated waste water and the waste water with Crtotal <10 mg/l (small amounts only) is sent directly to the central WWTP Chromium hydroxide resulting from precipitation is recycled back into the process Products not under specifications and dust from filters/scrubbers are also recycled back into the process The liquid efluents generated in the production of strontium aluminates (plant G) are treated together with liquid effluents generated in zinc sulphide production (plant F) in a WWTP located in plant F. The following steps are carried out: Sedimentation Precipitation Filter press Neutralisation After this treatment, the liquid effluents are then discharged into a municipal drainage system that transfer it to a municipal WWTP for final treatment. Evaporation/concentration Sedimentation bc Precipitation
bc a
F and G 2
H
1
CIC
a b
, or c refer to the waste water treatment(s) mentioned on the same line in the last column of the table
Table 6.9: Techniques used to treat waste water at several plants producing pigments in Europe
169
Chapter 6
Waste water volume treated m3/t i Type of discharge to receiving water I: indirect D: direct I
Chlorides
Example plant
NO3N
BOD5
Crtotal
COD
TOC
SO42-
TSS
Cd
Cu
Co
g/t i (mg/l)
g/t i (mg/l)
g/t i (mg/l)
g/t i (mg/l)
g/t i (mg/l)
g/t i (mg/l)
g/t i (mg/l)
g/t i (mg/l)
g/t i (mg/l)
g/t i (mg/l)
g/t i (mg/l)
g/t i (mg/l)
A 1a
27
B 1b
(<0.01)
(0.08)
(0.07)
(0.05)
400 500
20 40
5 10
(100)
(30)
100
50
E1
(6)
C1
F and G 2 H3
The values indicated in the table are annual average values. When Bi, V, W occur, they are minimised to values below 1 mg/l. 1 TWG comments; 2 TWG comments, parameters measured four times a year; 3 TWG comments; i Of finished pigment products; a Discharge data after treatment (specific load, concentration), prior to final biological treatment; b For lead chromate, a recycling of sludge is not viable. Reduction of waste water volume by use of dry filters for waste gas treatment; c Crtotal after pretreatment and before WWTP; d Cr(VI) after pretreatment and before WWTP
Table 6.10: Concentration levels of pollutants measured in the waste water after treatment at several plants producing pigments in Europe
170
0 1.47 (0 0.08)
0 107 (0 5.8)
0 160 (0 9.8)
(<0.01)
(<0.05)
(<0.05)
18.37
(0.13)
Zn
Pb
Sb
Al
The precipitation and Penniman-Zoph processes The manufacture of iron oxide pigments has an average water demand of 100 m3/t of finished product. However, for the manufacture of transparent and high purity iron oxide pigments, the water demand increases to 400 m3/t of finished product. Pollutant loads and concentrations on a basis of 100 m3 of water per tonne of finished product in the precipitation process are summarised in Table 6.11.
Parameter Concentration Fetotal SO42<5 g/m3 <16 kg/m3 Load of pollutants per tonne of finished product <0.5 kg <1600 kg
Table 6.11: Pollutants loads and concentrations for the production of iron oxide pigments
The Laux process The Laux process only requires a catalytic acid volume to dissolve the iron. The aromatic nitro compound oxidises Fe2+ to Fe3+. By the formation of insoluble pigments, free acid is generated, which can be re-used for dissolving the iron further. The acid demand is much lower than the stoichiometric volume. Consequently, the sulphate load of <40 kg/t in the water effluent is considerably lower than in the case of the precipitation process. Also, the base demand for the precipitation of iron from the waste water is significantly lower. Due to an aniline concentration of up to 3 kg/t of finished product, the leachate is fed into a biological waste water treatment plant after precipitation. Moreover, the effluent is loaded with ammonium, which also has to be eliminated in the biological treatment plant. Waste water from the central water treatment plant is discharged after separation of solid materials (aniline <0.2 kg/t of finished product).
6.1.3.1.3.2 Chromium (III) oxide pigments
The specific water demand is about 60 m3/t of pigments produced. The maximum sulphate concentration does not exceed 1200 kg/t. The total chromium concentration in the waste water is <0.02 kg/t of pigments produced.
6.1.3.1.3.3 CIC pigments
The manufacture of complex inorganic coloured pigments has a water demand of up to 150 m3/t of pigments produced. In waste water treatment, the average value of dried solid waste is 40 kg/t of pigments produced. The maximum concentrations of Co, Cr, Cu, Ni, Zn at the output of the WWTP reported by Germany, before mixing with other streams, is 0.5 mg/l, except for Co which is <1 mg/l. Precipitation and flocculation (e.g. lime milk, caustic soda) are suitable methods used to comply with these requirements.
171
Table 6.12: Average amount of waste water treated in the production of zinc sulphide, barium sulphate and lithopone pigments
The above figures can vary depending on the required qualities of the finished products. The waste water is characterised by the concentration of pollutants as indicated in Table 6.13.
Pollutants Barium Cadmium Sulphide Zinc Concentration (mg/l) <2 <0.01 <1 <2
Table 6.13: Pollutants contained in the waste water from the production of zinc sulphide, barium sulphate and lithopone pigments
Precipitation and Penniman-Zoph processes Most of the waste results from the sedimentation stage of the waste water treatment plant. The waste volume (mainly hydroxide sludge) is about 20 to 30 kg of dry material per tonne of pigments produced. If the residues cannot directly be recycled back into the process, several possibilities may be considered: recycled and used in the cement industry converted into iron brown pigments by calcination disposed of appropriately (e.g. controlled landfilling).
Chromium (III) oxide pigments
6.1.3.1.4.2
The main waste from the production of chromium (III) oxide pigments is chromium hydroxide which can be partly recycled, sold to other industries or disposed of in a controlled landfill. The amount of waste strongly depends on the product quality required by customers. Maximum values reported for disposed materials are 80 kg/t of pigments produced. Packaging materials (i.e. paper bags) from the raw chromate material are 100 % thermally recycled (i.e. incinerated): Empty paper sacks cannot be cleaned to the extent that they can be recycled without any interference to the paper recycling process. There is still colouring material in the paper bags, which would give colour to the recycled paper. There are no toxicological reasons for not recycling the packaging materials.
172
By-products are recycled back into production; waste deriving from, e.g. broken saggars, packaging materials or waste from water treatments, depends on the type of pigment produced and on the production process used. Waste recovering systems are used where applicable.
6.1.3.1.5 Noise
Technical measures such as encapsulation of process equipment are used where necessary.
6.1.3.1.6 Odour
Generally, odour is not a problem in the production of inorganic pigments. In the case of the production of zinc sulphide and barium sulphate, the reaction is strictly controlled as regards pH value, so that no (odorous) hydrogen sulphide is generated.
173
Chapter 6
6.1.4.2 Penniman-Zoph process to manufacture yellow iron oxide pigments [1, Ullmann, 2001] Description The Penniman-Zoph process is probably the most widely used production method for yellow iron oxide pigments. This method considerably reduces the quantity of neutral salts formed as by-products. The raw materials are iron (II) sulphate, sodium hydroxide solution, and scrap iron. If the sulphate contains appreciable quantities of salt impurities, these must be removed by partial precipitation. The iron must be free of alloying components. The process usually consists of two stages. In the first stage, nuclei are prepared by precipitating iron (II) sulphate with alkali (e.g. sodium hydroxide solution) at 20 50 C with aeration. Depending on the conditions, yellow, orange, or red nuclei may be obtained. The nuclei suspension is pumped into vessels charged with scrap iron and diluted with water. Here, the process is completed by growing the iron oxide hydroxide or oxide onto the nuclei. The residual iron (II) sulphate in the nuclei suspension is oxidised to iron (III) sulphate by blasting with air at 75 90 C. The iron (III) sulphate is then hydrolysed to form FeOOH or h-Fe2O3. The liberated sulphuric acid reacts with the scrap iron to form iron (II) sulphate, which is also oxidised with air. The reaction time can vary from approximately two days to several weeks, depending on the conditions chosen and the desired pigment. For accelerating the reaction, the temperature is kept stable at about 80 C by adding steam. The air quantity has to be controlled to minimise the risk of explosions, but also to minimise emissions of heat and waste gas. One solution to achieve this is to operate above the temperature at which the vapour pressure of water is high enough to blanket the reactors dome. At the end of the reaction, metallic impurities and coarse particles are removed from the solid with sieves or hydrocyclones; water-soluble salts are removed by washing. Drying is carried out with band or spray dryers and disintegrators or jet mills are used for grinding. The iron oxide pigments produced by the Penniman-Zoph process are soft, have good wetting properties, and a very low flocculation tendency. Under suitable conditions, the Penniman-Zoph process can also be used to produce red pigments directly. The residual scrap iron and coarse particles are removed from the pigment, which is then dried and ground using disintegrators or jet mills. These pigments have unsurpassed softness. They usually have a purer colour than the harder red pigments produced by calcination. Achieved environmental benefits The main advantage of this process over the precipitation process lies in the small quantity of alkali and iron (II) sulphate required. The bases are only used to form the nuclei and the relatively small amount of iron (II) sulphate required initially is continually renewed by dissolving the iron by reaction with the sulphuric acid liberated by hydrolysis. The process is thus considered environmentally friendly. The advantage of the Penniman-Zoph process in comparison to the precipitation process is that it considerably reduces the quantity of neutral salts (e.g. Na2SO4, NaCl) formed as by-products because the sulphuric acid generated by iron (II) sulphate hydrolysis-oxidation reacts with the scrap iron to produce iron (II) sulphate. Reference literature [1, Ullmann, 2001]
174 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Chapter 6
6.1.4.3 Fluoride and boron abatement by lime washing Description The production of some pigments (e.g. zircon pigments, zirconium silicate pigments) cause the presence of fluorides (generated in the calcination process) in the exhaust air coming from the kilns. To abate them, micro-batchers are installed on the outlet of the kiln exhaust gas. Hydrated ventilated lime is the reacting agent contained in the micro-batchers and is introduced into the exhaust airflow using a mixing Venturi tube positioned on the outlet of the kiln exhaust gas. The hydrated lime batched in the system not only reacts with the acidic fumes by virtue of the mixing obtained with the Venturi tube, but also subsequently deposits onto the exterior surface of the filter sleeves forming a thin layer that allows the capture of the gaseous pollutants (i.e. fluorides) that have not yet been neutralised and which are forced to pass through the reactant layer formed. The hydrated lime also serves to abate boron. Achieved environmental benefits reduction of fluoride and boron emissions to the air.
Operational data At the COLOROBBIA plant in Italy, the efficiency of the fluoride abatement system is in the range of 90 to 98 % and fluoride emission levels are in the range of 0.2 to 2 mg/Nm3. Applicability Applicable for the production of pigments that generate fluorides in the exhaust air coming from the kilns. Driving force for implementation environmental regulations.
175
Chapter 6
6.1.4.4 Use of distilled water coming from the evaporation/concentration system for washing pigments Description Using distilled water coming from the evaporation/concentration part of the waste water system allows a lesser quantity of water to be used for the washing of pigments because of the elevated solubility power of the distilled water. Achieved environmental benefits less consumption of water to wash the pigments.
Operational data COLOROBBIA, Italy makes use of about 6.5 litres of water per kg of pigments produced.
176
Chapter 6
6.1.4.5 Chromium removal from waste water Description Oxidation of chromium (III) to chromium (VI) occurs in the production of pigments from high temperature calcination in alkaline conditions. Hexavalent and trivalent chromium compounds chromium (VI) and chromium (III) differ very greatly in their effects. Chromium (VI) compounds have a strong tendency to change into chromium (III) while driving out oxygen. Therefore, chromium (VI) compounds have a strong oxidising action and a toxic effect on biological materials. For humans and animals, as well as for plants, they are more than 1000 times more toxic than trivalent chromium compounds [10, ANFFECC/CERAMICOLOR/EPSOM/VdMi, 1998]. Waste water loaded with chromium (VI) is commonly treated in a two-stage process. The first stage changes chromium (VI) to chromium (III) by a reduction reaction (see Section 4.4.1.2.4) using sulphite (e.g. iron (II) sulphate, sulphur dioxide, sodium bisulphite, sodium metabisulphite). The efficiency of the reaction is highly dependent on pH. The second stage is the addition of calcium hydroxide for the precipitation (see Section 4.4.1.2.1) of chromium hydroxide to occur. The efficiency of the reaction is highly dependent on pH, and most conventional processes are operated with a high pH (>8). The precipitate (sludge) is separated, dehydrated and sent to disposal. Presence of iron (II) in the precipitation/flocculation step reduces chromium (VI) to chromium (III). Achieved environmental benefits less emissions of chromium (VI) compounds to the environment, which are the most toxic chromium compounds minimise emissions of chromium (III) to the environment.
Cross-media effects consumption of reducing agents (e.g. sulphur dioxide, sodium bisulphite, sodium metabisulphite) consumption of precipitating agents (e.g. calcium hydroxide) consumption of flocculatants consumption of chemicals to regulate the pH (e.g. H2SO4, NaOH) consumption of electricity to operate the agitators in the reaction tank(s).
Operational data At two German plants, the following concentrations are achieved at the outlet of the treatment: Crtotal: 1 2.5 mg/l Cr(VI): <0.1 mg/l.
Chapter 6
6.1.4.6 Strict control of the pH value of the reaction Description In the production of zinc sulphide and barium sulphate pigments, the reaction is strictly controlled as regards pH value, so that no odorous and toxic hydrogen sulphide is generated. Achieved environmental benefits avoids generation of odorous hydrogen sulphide.
Applicability generally applicable in the production of zinc sulphide and barium sulphate pigments.
6.1.4.7 Recycling of precipitation sludges back into production Description Precipitation sludges (hydroxides), resulting from the precipitation of the waste water stream from the production of cadmium pigments, lithopones, precipitated barium sulphate, chromium oxide and iron oxide pigments, are recycled back into the production process. Achieved environmental benefits minimise the amount of waste to be disposed of minimise the amount of raw materials used.
Applicability Generally applicable in the production of cadmium pigments, lithopones, precipitated barium sulphate, chromium oxide and iron oxide pigments.
178
Chapter 6
6.1.4.8 Biological treatment of waste water loaded with nitrates Description The nitrate loaded streams from the production of bismuth vanadate and lead chromate pigments can be denitrified biologically using carbon nutrient sources such as methanol, ethanol or sugar solutions. In the cases where metals (such as Zn) interfere with the biological processes, they are removed prior to the biological treatment to prevent contamination of the activated sludge. The treatment steps consist of: flow balancing first reaction stage (denitrification NO3 to N2 in a stirrer tank where the external carbon source is added) second reaction stage (degradation of residual organics in a stirrer tank by addition of small amounts of nitrate) separation (the activated sludge is returned to the first reaction stage).
Achieved environmental benefits minimises the amount of nitrate emitted to receiving waters.
Operational data At a pigments production plant in Germany, the waste water streams with high nitrate-loads are treated using the biological treatment described above. The effluent coming out of this biological treatment is sent to the central WWTP (mainly for neutralisation and precipitation of heavy metals). The following emission levels sent to receiving waters are reported at the outlet of the central WWTP: NO3-N: 40000 80000 g/t of end-products; 300 680 mg/l (with an annual waste water volume treated of 100 m3/t of end-products) as indicated in Table 6.10 under Example plant B.
Applicability This technique is applicable for precipitation processes using metal nitrates (e.g. lead nitrate, bismuth nitrate) as precursors. Driving force for implementation prevention of eutrophication in receiving waters.
Example plants SIC pigments production plant in Germany (see Example plant B in Table 6.10).
179
Chapter 6
6.1.4.9 Pretreatment of waste water loaded with heavy metals Description The pretreatment of waste water loaded with heavy metals (e.g. Pb, Sb, Cd) in the production of SIC pigments can consist of: equilibration tank reduction (of chromate), neutralisation precipitation, flocculation, sedimentation multistage filtration, membranes dewatering of sludge by filter press concentrates (filtrate from sludge dewatering, backwash, membranes) are fed back to neutralisation.
It should be noted that the effluent from the pretreatment is directed to the neutralisation step of the waste water treatment plant to prevent any re-dissolution. Achieved environmental benefits minimises the amount of heavy metals emitted to water.
Operational data Table 6.14 presents the emission levels achieved after pretreatment and final treatment of waste water loaded with heavy metals. Example plants SIC pigments production plant in Germany.
180
Chapter 6
6.1.4.10 Final treatment of waste water loaded with heavy metals Description The final treatment of waste water loaded with heavy metals (e.g. Pb, Sb, Cd) in the production of SIC pigments can consist of: equilibration tank neutralisation precipitation, flocculation, sedimentation filtration dewatering of sludge by filter press filtrate from sludge dewatering and concentrates from backwash are fed back to neutralisation.
Achieved environmental benefits minimises the amount of heavy metals emitted to water.
Operational data Table 6.14 presents the emission levels achieved after pretreatment and final treatment of waste water loaded with heavy metals.
Parameter Pb Cr Sb COD BOD5 Bi, V, W Cd
1
Concentration 1
Table 6.14: Emission levels achieved after pretreatment and final treatment of waste water loaded with heavy metals
181
Chapter 6
182
Chapter 6
Minimisation of total dust emissions to the air BAT is to: 6.1.8 minimise the emission of total dust from the activities carried out at the installation and achieve emission levels of 1 10 mg/Nm3 (see Table 6.8) by using one or more of the following abatement techniques (see Section 6.1.2.3.1): a. cyclone (see Section 4.4.2.1.2) b. fabric filter (see Section 4.4.2.1.5) c. wet scrubber (see Section 4.4.2.1.3). The waste water generated by the scrubbing operation is re-used as scrubbing media or recycled d. ESP (see Section 4.4.2.1.4). The lower end of the range may be achieved by using fabric filters in combination with other abatement techniques. Using fabric filters is not always possible, e.g. when other pollutants have to be abated (e.g. SOx) or when the off-gases present humid conditions (e.g. presence of liquid acid). Choice of waste gas treatment system In order to reduce the consumption of water, BAT is to: 6.1.9 use a dry treatment system to treat off-gases from calcination kilns except when other pollutants, besides total dust, also have to be abated (see Section 6.1.3.1.2). In order to ensure high abatement efficiency of pollutants, BAT is to: 6.1.10 use ESPs to clean off-gases from dryers under humid conditions and bag filters under low humidity conditions (see Section 6.1.2.4.1.1). Waste water treatment BAT is to: 6.1.11 (pre)treat waste water contaminated with Cr(VI) and achieve a Cr(VI) concentration of <0.1 mg/l (see Table 6.10) by applying both of the following measures before sending the effluent for further treatment (see Sections 4.4.1 and 6.1.4.5): a. flow buffering b. reduction of Cr(VI) to Cr(III) e.g. by sulphite, iron(II) sulphate BAT is to: 6.1.12 treat waste water loaded with heavy metals and achieve the emission levels indicated in Table 6.15 before discharging to the receiving water by a combination of precipitation (see Section 4.4.1.2.1), flocculation, sedimentation (see Section 4.4.1.1.1) and filtration (see Section 4.4.1.1.3). The filtration residues recovered from waste water treatment may be recycled back into production (see Sections 4.4.1, 6.1.2.3.2 and 6.1.3.1.3).
Pollutant Cd Crtotal Pb
1
In the manufacture of iron oxide pigments by the Laux process, BAT is to: 6.1.13 use biological treatment for the abatement of organic traces in the waste water (see Section 6.1.2.3.2).
183
Chapter 6
In the manufacture of bismuth vanadate and lead chromate pigments, BAT is to: 6.1.14 reduce NO3-N emissions to water by approximately 50 % by using denitrification treatment (see Section 6.1.4.8). Recycling of precipitation residues containing pigments In the production of cadmium pigments, lithopones, precipitated barium sulphate, chromium oxide and iron oxide pigments, BAT is to: 6.1.15 recycle back into production filtration residues from the precipitation steps of the waste water stream (see Section 6.1.4.7).
184
Chapter 6
Chapter 6
Phosphorus pentachloride (PCl5) is mainly used as a chlorinating agent in organic chemistry. It is also used in the pharmaceutical industry for the manufacture of penicillin and cephalosporin antibiotics. As all three compounds can be used to produce nerve gases, their use is strictly controlled according to the Chemical Weapons Convention. 6.2.1.2 Toxicity On contact with moisture, phosphorus trichloride is hydrolysed in an exothermic reaction forming phosphorous/phosphonic acid and hydrogen chloride. Therefore, it is strongly irritating to the skin, eyes, and respiratory tract. Severe corrosion of the skin and mucous membranes may occur upon contact with liquid PCl3 [1, Ullmann, 2001]. Phosphoryl chloride hydrolyses slowly but exothermically to give phosphoric acid and hydrogen chloride. Therefore, phosphoryl chloride primarily has an irritant action, whereas deeper penetration into the respiratory tract is possible due to delayed hydrolysis. Often, no complaints are felt at the beginning; only after a latent period of several hours does damage to the deeper respiratory tract occur. Irreversible damage may occur following high exposure. For this reason, POCl3 is regarded toxicologically as the most dangerous of the phosphorus chlorides [1, Ullmann, 2001]. Phosphorus pentachloride vapours are similarly strongly irritating to the mucous membranes and respiratory tract [1, Ullmann, 2001]. These properties necessitate special arrangements for the production, storage and handling of PCl3, POCl3 and PCl5. 6.2.1.3 Explosions and fire hazards Phosphorus trichloride, phosphoryl chloride, and phosphorus pentachloride do not burn or explode, but when they come into contact with water, they may splash over a wide area. The violent reaction of these substances with water may ignite other combustible materials. When heated to decomposition, they emit toxic fumes. During fires, containers should be kept cool with water spray but only if there is no risk of contact between the product and the water. In emergency situations, a positive pressure-demand/self-contained breathing apparatus, with complete chemically resistant clothing, should be used, and fire-fighters should wear compressed-air breathing apparatus. For mixed fires, if there is no risk of contact between the phosphorus trichloride, phosphoryl chloride or phosphorus pentachloride and the fire-fighting medium, the medium can be chosen according to the other chemicals involved. Otherwise, dry foam or inert gases (e.g. argon) should be used as the fire-fighting medium. 6.2.1.4 Phosphorus compounds production in Europe and worldwide In 2005 in Europe, phosphorus trichloride, phosphoryl chloride and phosphorus pentachloride were produced by six companies at six sites (three in Germany, one in France, one in Poland, and one in the United Kingdom), each producing between 10000 and 95000 tonnes of these products per year. The estimated 2002 production capacity of phosphorus trichloride in western Europe and the US amounted to 600000 tonnes (20000 tonnes in Japan). The world production capacity in 2002 was estimated to be greater than 900000 tonnes. The estimated 2002 production capacity of phosphorus oxychloride in western Europe was 110000 tonnes (40000 tonnes in the US and 30000 tonnes in Japan).
186 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Chapter 6
6.2.1.5 Features of the European phosphorus compounds industry In Europe, large enterprises with over 250 employees manufacture phosphorus compounds. Production is carried out in multipurpose plants using a continuous mode of operation. The workforce employed to run the phosphorus compounds production facilities within these large companies, is generally below 60. Production is generally carried out in installations that are part of a larger chemical complex where the chlorine raw material is produced. 6.2.1.6 Economics The purchase of the elemental phosphorus raw material represents a vast amount of the total PCl3 production cost and, therefore, of the POCl3 and PCl5 derivatives. There is only one producer of elemental phosphorus in Europe. Competition from within Europe is strong due to the presence of a total of six producers of phosphorus compounds (four major producers and two minor ones). In addition, European producers are exposed to competition from Indian and Chinese producers, but only to a limited extent because of the high costs of shipment. The main markets for phosphorus compounds are in agriculture and in the production of flame-retardants. The growth rate of these two markets is moderate (2 to 4 % per year). Due to the high transportation costs, European producers mainly serve the European markets and only a small proportion of phosphorus chlorides is exported outside Europe.
Phosphoryl chloride is obtained by oxidising phosphorus trichloride with air or oxygen. 2PCl3 + O2 X 2POCl3 (-279.5 kJ/mol) (2)
Phosphorus pentachloride can be prepared by the reaction of excess chlorine with phosphorus trichloride. The reaction is slightly exothermic. PCl3 + Cl2 X PCl5 6.2.2.2 Production processes Production of PCl3, POCl3 and PCl5 are closely related as PCl3 is the starting material for the production of the other two compounds. For this reason, production of all three compounds is often carried out in the same installation.
6.2.2.2.1 Production of PCl3
(-125 kJ/mol)
(3)
In Europe, phosphorus trichloride is manufactured by two different processes: the gas-liquid reaction process the gas phase reaction process.
187
In a typical continuous process, molten elemental phosphorus and gaseous chlorine are continuously fed into a reactor filled with boiling (and previously produced) phosphorus trichloride as shown in Figure 6.10. The reaction is highly exothermic, the heat being discharged by evaporation of PCl3. The yield of the reaction is over 99.9 % related to the use of chlorine. N2 is used to suppress moisture and oxygen in the reactor in order to avoid the formation of unwanted POCl3. The formation of phosphorus pentachloride is prevented by the presence of a small excess of elemental phosphorus. The heat of the reaction, about ten times the heat of evaporation, keeps the system at its boiling point, and the phosphorus trichloride distils off. The vapours are fractionated as reflux takes place, and PCl3 condenses at 75.5 C in air-cooled or water-cooled condensers. The rate of removal of PCl3 (i.e. the production rate) is equivalent to the feed rate of phosphorus and chlorine. The process is controlled by the boiling temperature, which is determined by the phosphorus trichloride content. The rate of chlorine flow is fixed, and the phosphorus feed rate is adjusted manually. The phosphorus trichloride produced contains no free phosphorus and needs no further treatment [1, Ullmann, 2001, 2, Dr. Kppke, 2003]. The organic impurities from the phosphorus used remain in the reactor, and are removed periodically, i.e. the phosphorus trichloride is completely driven off by distillation, and the tarry mass remaining is removed as waste and sent to a suitable waste treatment facility. The volume of organic residues significantly depends on the purity of the phosphorus raw material.
Elemental + Purity check phosphorus Heat Water Solution of NaOH in water or neutral water
Chlorine (gas)
Phosphorus storage
P oxides
Scrubbing
Phosphorus oxides
Liquid phosphorus N2
Reaction
Evaporated PCl3
Distillation
Solution of NaOH in water
Condensation
Traces of PCl3
Scrubbing
HCl
N2
PCl3 storage
To receiving water
Solid waste
188
In another process (Figure 6.11), phosphorus and gaseous chlorine are reacted in a combustion chamber to form phosphorus trichloride at about 1800 C. The yield of the reaction is over 99.5 %, relating to the use of phosphorus (which is equivalent to over 99.9 % yield relating to the use of chlorine), and depending on the purity of the white/yellow elemental phosphorus raw material (impurities such as arsenic and antimony as well as organic constituents can be found in the phosporus raw material). N2 is used to suppress moisture and oxygen in the combustion chamber in order to avoid formation of unwanted POCl3. Crude PCl3 undertakes two steps of distillation/condensation. The first step is used to separate pure PCl3 from by-products such as organic chlorides. By-products are sent to the second distillation/condensation step. Distillate PCl3 is recycled back into the process and liquid residues are collected and sent for incineration.
Elemental + Purity check Phosphorus Heat Water Solution of NaOH in water or water Phosphorus oxides
Scrubbing
Chlorine (gas)
Phosphorus storage
N2 NaOH Liquid phosphorus
To receiving water
Scrubbing
N2
HCl
Condensation
Distillate PCl3
PCl3-raw feed
Residues Final emissions to water Waste water from the process Final emissions to air Off-gas from the process
Phosphoryl chloride can be manufactured either batch wise or in a continuous process [1, Ullmann, 2001]. Industrially, phosphoryl chloride is manufactured in a continuous mode of operation in two reactors, which are connected by a line as shown in Figure 6.12. O2 required for converting PCl3 to POCl3 is first led countercurrently to the follow-up reactor. The unreacted part of the O2 is then fed into the reactor, so that all of the O2 brought into the process reacts. The yield of the reaction is over 99.9 % related to the use of PCl3. The presence of impurities in the PCl3 raw material such as copper and cobalt, or of sulphur compounds, decreases the reaction rate. The reaction product can be distilled in fractions for further purification [1, Ullmann, 2001, 2, Dr. Kppke, 2003].
189
Chapter 6
O2 PCl3 Solution of NaOH in water
Reactor
Scrubbing
HCl
P Cl To receiving water
N2
POCl3 storage
Waste gases leaving the reactors contain traces of PCl3 and POCl3. Before being discharged to the air, they are led over an alkaline or neutral scrubber. The wash-water discharged from the scrubber is fed to a waste water treatment plant with biological treatment [2, Dr. Kppke, 2003].
6.2.2.2.3 Production of PCl5
Phosphorus pentachloride can be manufactured industrially by reacting phosphorus trichloride with chlorine as shown in Figure 6.13. The heat of the reaction is removed by the latent heat of evaporation of PCl3 and by indirect cooling of the reactor. The conversion takes place up to a point where all of the PCl3 has reacted. Phosphorus pentachloride is discharged from the reactor as a fine yellow crystalline powder. Vaporised PCl3 is recovered and can be recycled back into the production process. Waste gases leaving the reactors contain traces of PCl3. Before being discharged to the air, it is led over an alkaline scrubber. The wash-water discharged from this process is fed to a waste water treatment plant with biological tretament.
190
Chapter 6
Cl2
PCl3
Reactor
PCl5 powder
Traces of PCl3
Scrubbing
HCl
PCl5 storage
N2
PCl3 storage
6.2.2.3 Raw material storage and handling For the production of PCl3, elemental white/yellow phosphorus arrives in solid form to the installation, in 50 tonnes railcars or 25 tonnes ISO tank containers. Elemental phosphorus is heated up with steam while in the railcar (the heating process lasts approximately six hours) and is transferred in liquid form to storage tanks. A water blanket is permanently maintained on top of the liquid elemental phosphorus in the storage tanks in order to avoid contact with air (elemental white/yellow phosphorus ignites spontaneously when in contact with air). Storage tanks are maintained at a heated temperature of approximately 60 C to ensure that the elemental phosphorus remains in a liquid form. Chlorine is generally produced in a nearby plant located on the premises of the chemical complex and sent by pipes in gaseous form to the phosphorus production plant. If not produced nearby, chlorine can be transported by road or rail to the phosphorus production plant. PCl3 and O2 are the raw materials used for the production of POCl3. PCl3 comes from the phosphorus installation tank farm and O2 is provided as a utility from the chemical complex. PCl3 and chlorine are the raw materials used for the production of PCl5. PCl3 comes from the tank farm and chlorine is provided by a nearby plant or transported by road or rail to the phosphorus production plant. NaOH is the only auxiliary chemical used in the production of phosphorus chlorides. It is used in the scrubbers needed to abate the pollutants contained in waste gases. 6.2.2.4 Finished products storage and handling Storage of liquid PCl3 and POCl3 necessitates maintaining an N2 atmosphere on top of the tanks. Liquid PCl3 and POCl3 are both pumped from storage tanks into steel drums, road or rail containers for transportation to customers.
191
Chapter 6
6.2.2.5 Materials used for production equipment Production equipment is made of stainless steel, nickel or nickel alloy (reactors), enamelled or plastic coated iron (distillation part).
6.2.3.3 Air emissions HCl is the major pollutant emitted to the air in the production of phosphorus compounds. Most of the phosphorus chloride plants produce more than one phosphorus compound but have a combined off-gas treatment. It is, therefore, difficult to determine the off-gas stream and monitor the air emission corresponding to the production of each phosphorus compound. In the production of phosphorus trichloride (Figure 6.10 and Figure 6.11), the waste gas originates from the reactor and contains traces of PCl3 which is abated in a scrubber. The waste gas volume is very small (40 100 m/day; estimated as part of the total off-gas stream of the plant). Final emissions to the air contain traces of HCl. Vent gases from the railcar and storage of elemental phosphorus need to be led to a scrubber to remove traces of phosphorus oxides. In the production of phosphoryl chloride (Figure 6.12), the waste gas originates from the reactors and contains traces of PCl3 and POCl3. The waste gas is led to an alkaline scrubber to abate the pollutants. Final emissions to the air contain traces of HCl. In the production of phosphorus pentachloride (Figure 6.13), the waste gas originates from the reactor and contains traces of PCl3. It is abated in an alkaline scrubber. Final emissions to the air contain traces of HCl. HCl emissions at the three German plants are reported to be in the range of 3 15 mg/Nm3. This corresponds to the range of emissions observed during normal, steady-state operating conditions. It has to be kept in mind that the range indicated takes into account that the emission profile is not constant and does not stem from only one production line, but consists of the added emissions of two to four different parallel production lines. Some of these lines produce substances other than PCl3, POCl3 and PCl5.
192 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Chapter 6
6.2.3.4 Water emissions In the production of phosphorus trichloride (Figure 6.10 and Figure 6.11), waste water from waste gas scrubbing is led to a waste water treatment plant with biological treatment. The waste water is characterised by a (organic) chloride and phosphorus compound pollutant load. The type of pollutant results from the different scrubbing conditions (neutral or alkaline scrubbing). Neutral scrubbing conditions cause phosphorous/phosphonic acid (H3PO3) and HCl loads in the waste water. The following reaction occurs in the neutral scrubber: PCl3 + 3H2O X H3PO3 + 3HCl (4)
Sodium phosphate (Na3HPO3)/sodium hypophosphite monohydrate (Na2HPO3H2O) and NaCl are produced with alkaline conditions. The concentration of the above-mentioned pollutants depends on the scrubbing water volumes and on the type of scrubbing process and can widely differ. The following reactions occur in an alkaline scrubber: PCl3 + 3H2O X H3PO3 + 3HCl H3PO3 + 2NaOH X Na2HPO3 + 2H2O (5) (6)
In the production of phosphoryl chloride (Figure 6.12), waste water caused by alkaline off-gas scrubbing is led to a waste water treatment plant with biological treatment. In the production of phosphorus pentachloride (Figure 6.13), wash-water from the off-gas scrubbing is led to a waste water treatment plant with biological treatment. Total waste water volume from the production of phosphorus compounds greatly varies from one producer to the other and are reported to be <10 m3/t of elemental phosphorus used. The pollutants load in total waste water are reported to be the following: 0.5 2 kg P/t of elemental phosphorus 5 10 kg Cl/t of elemental phosphorus.
As described in the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003], Cl normally passes unchanged through a waste water treatment plant; and the excess of phosphates, as long as they are not used and consumed as bacteria feed in the WWTP with biological treatment, are generally removed by precipitation (using iron or aluminum salts) depending on the amount present so that phosphorous removal is very efficient. 6.2.3.5 Wastes White/yellow phosphorus raw material used in the production of phosphorus trichloride contains organic and inorganic impurities, which are released during the production process and have to be eliminated as waste. Such waste arises as distillation residues from PCl3 production. The most important impurity in the white/yellow phosphorus raw material being arsenic, waste from the production of phosphorus trichloride is hazardous. The share of waste typically represents about 0.5 % of the used phosphorus raw material (by weight), essentially depending, however, on the quality of the phosphorus sources. Wastes are generally led to incineration. Wastes (i.e. distillation residues from PCl3 production) sent to incineration are reported to be in the range 4 8 kg/t of elemental phosphorus. No residues are produced in the manufacture of phosphoryl chloride due to the high purity of the PCl3 raw material. The manufacture of phosphorus pentachloride does not generate any kind of waste due to the high purity of the PCl3 raw material.
Speciality Inorganic Chemicals 193
Chapter 6
Applicability generally applicable when condensate water is available at, or close to the installation.
194
Chapter 6
6.2.4.2 Use of an inert gas (typically N2) to blanket elemental phosphorus raw material Description Elemental phosphorus is flammable in contact with air and, therefore, needs to be blanketed with an inert medium up to the reaction step. An inert gas (typically N2) can be used for this purpose. Achieved environmental benefits reduced risk of fire.
Driving force for implementation For safety reasons, elemental phosphorus which is flammable when in contact with air, needs to be blanketed with an inert medium. 6.2.4.3 Use of water to blanket the elemental phosphorus raw material and recycling of the water for off-gas scrubbing Description Phosphorus is flammable when in contact with air and, therefore, needs to be blanketed with an inert medium up to the reaction step. Water can be used for this purpose. Before being released to the waste water treatment plant, the water can additionally be used to wash the off-gases (containing phosphorus oxides) generated during the unloading and storage of elemental phosphorus. Achieved environmental benefits reduction of the risks of fire reduction of the volume of water used in waste gas scrubbing.
Chapter 6
6.2.4.4 Use of elemental phosphorus raw material containing low organic and inorganic impurities Description White/yellow elemental phosphorus raw material used for the production of phosphorus trichloride contains impurities which are released during the production process and have to be eliminated as waste. Using white/yellow elemental phosphorus raw materials with a low content of impurities allows the amount of waste generated in the production process to be reduced. Achieved environmental benefits reduction in the amount of waste generated in the process.
196
Chapter 6
6.2.4.5 Use of neutral scrubbing for abating PCl3 and phosphorus oxides in waste gases Description Waste gases are cleaned by means of neutral scrubbers. Achieved environmental benefits reduce emissions of PCl3 (HCl) and P2O5 (H3PO4) to the air.
6.2.4.6 Use of alkaline scrubbing for abating PCl3 in waste gases Description Waste gases are cleaned by means of alkaline scrubbers. Achieved environmental benefits reduce emissions of PCl3 (HCl) and P2O5 (H3PO4) to the air.
Cross-media effects generation of HCl(NaCl)/H3PO4(Na3PO4) in the waste water consumption of sodium hydroxide (NaOH).
197
Chapter 6
6.2.4.7 Use of strictly enclosed systems Description As phosphorus trichloride, phosphoryl chloride and phosphorus pentachloride are highly reactive and hazardous corrosive materials, they are handled in strictly enclosed systems. Warnings and information labels are placed on all pipes and equipment. Achieved environmental benefits protection of the workers reduction of spills.
Reference literature [3, UNEP, et al., 1989] 6.2.4.8 Incineration of the distillation residues from the PCl3 production Achieved environmental benefits energy recovery.
Example plants
198
Chapter 6
6.2.4.9 Storage measures for phosphorus compounds Description [3, UNEP, et al., 1989] Phosphorus trichloride, phosphoryl chloride, and phosphorus pentachloride are stored in properly sealed and labelled drums, or in suitable bulk containers, in a cool, dry, well ventilated place. Drums are handled carefully to prevent puncturing. Precautions are taken in order to avoid water coming into contact with the material or packaging. Containers (cylinders, carboys) are made of stainless steel and steel-jacketed lead and road tankers are nickel-lined. Phenol resins are used as additional lining. Carbon steel is used for phosphorus trichloride, but not for phosphoryl chloride. Achieved environmental benefits protection of the workers accident prevention prevention of spills.
199
Chapter 6
200
Chapter 6
Emissions to water BAT is to: 6.2.8 minimise emissions of phosphorus and chloride to the receiving water by treating water effluents in a WWTP equipped with biological treatment and achieve emission levels of P to the receiving water of 0.5 2 kg/t of raw elemental phosphorus and emission levels of Cl to the receiving water of 5 10 kg/t of raw elemental phosphorus (see Section 6.2.3.4). Waste BAT is to: 6.2.9 achieve emission levels of distillation residues from PCl3 production to 4 8 kg/t of raw elemental phosphorus (see Section 6.2.3.5). BAT is to: 6.2.10 incinerate distillation residues from PCl3 production (see Section 6.2.4.8).
6.3 Silicones
6.3.1 General information
Silicones are a special variety of polymers. Although they are partially organic in composition, silicone molecules differ from those of most polymers in that the backbone of their structure does not contain carbon, the characteristic element of organic compounds, but is a chain of alternating silicon and oxygen atoms, modified with various organic groups attached to the silicon atoms. In industrially important silicones, these groups are usually methyl or phenyl. Polyorganosiloxanes is the scientific name for silicones. Silicones have many outstanding properties. In general, methyl silicones exhibit greater stability to high temperatures, ultraviolet radiation, and weathering than organic polymers. They also generally exhibit good dielectric properties, as well as low temperature dependence of their physical properties. Several thousands of different silicone products are on the market, and a production site often manufactures over a thousand different silicone products. The SIC silicones addressed in this document concentrate on the most important silicone compound, namely polydimethylsiloxane (PDMS). There are also other important silicones, which are only briefly mentioned in this document.
201
Chapter 6
6.3.1.1 Uses Silicones are used for a very wide variety of applications. They are utilised as sealants, electric isolators, lubricants, elastomers (i.e. rubbers), water-resistant coatings or as additives in lacquers, paintings or cosmetic products. Generally, the very large variety of silicone products can be broken down into five main product groups: intermediates fluids specialities (adhesives/abhesives, emulsions/antifoams, resins and paint additives for coatings, foam stabilisers, impregnating agents, and others) elastomers (Heat Cure Rubber HCR, Liquid Silicone Rubber LSR, Room-Temperature Vulcanisation RTV component) sealants.
From an end use point of view, the business of silicones comprises several thousands of micromarkets, depending on the specific application for which the silicones are used. 6.3.1.2 Toxicology and environmental aspects for the use of silicones Unless otherwise specified, the following information derives from Ullmanns encyclopedia [1, Ullmann, 2001]. The toxicology of silicones, especially polydimethylsiloxanes (PDMS), has been thoroughly studied because silicones are used in medicine and medical technology, as well as in cosmetics. The inertness of silicones towards warm-blooded animals has been demonstrated in a number of tests. A panel of experts from the Food and Agriculture Organisation (FAO) and the World Health Organisation (WHO) considers the daily intake by human beings of 1.5 mg of PDMS per kilogram of body weight in the form of food additives to be unobjectionable. In the case of organofunctional polysiloxanes, toxic effects cannot be excluded, because of the reactivity of the organofunctional groups. Polysiloxanes containing trifluoropropyl groups form toxic decomposition products when they are heated above 280 C. The conditions of use take these properties into account. Liquid and volatile siloxanes enter the environment as a result of use. Soil (sewage sludge) and sediment are sinks, and siloxanes are found in trace amounts in these environmental compartments. Siloxanes have no marked harmful effects on organisms in the environment. Siloxanes ultimately degrade to silica, carbon dioxide and water. Therefore, they are assumed not to represent an environmental hazard. Volatile methyl siloxanes having negligible photochemical reactivity show, therefore, a negligible contribution to tropospheric ozone formation. However, methylchlorosilanes used to produce methyl siloxanes are substances that, if emitted to the air, would contribute to tropospheric ozone formation.
202
Chapter 6
6.3.1.3 Production capacity The production capacity of raw siloxanes (i.e. polydimethylsiloxanes or PDMS) in Europe is given in Table 6.16.
Location Barry, United Kingdom Roussillon, France Burghausen, Germany Leverkusen, Germany Nnchritz, Germany
1 2
Production capacity in 2004 130000 tonnes of PDMS1 100000 tonnes of PDMS1 90000 tonnes of PDMS2 75000 tonnes of PDMS1 30000 tonnes of PDMS1
2002, from Silicones, CEH Marketing Research Report, SRI International 2003 1999, from Silicones, CEH Marketing Research Report, SRI International 2000
6.3.1.4 Features of the European silicone industry In Europe, four large enterprises (one producing at two sites) of over 250 employees manufacture silicones, in medium sized installations. Production is carried out in multipurpose plants using a continuous mode of operation. The workforce employed to run the silicone production facilities within these large enterprises, is between 120 and 200 persons. Production is carried out in installations that are part of a larger chemical complex where the raw chlorine material is produced. 6.3.1.5 Economics In 2002, the global market for silicones totalled about EUR 8000 million, corresponding to a production volume slightly above two million tonnes. Between 1995 and 1998, the average global growth rate of silicone production was about 6 %, the major part of which can be attributed to growth in Asia. In 2002, the main areas of silicones sales were in Europe (33 %) and in North America (34 %).
203
Chapter 6
The production of silicones may be seen as a rather complicated production process, compared to other SIC production processes, involving many process steps (Figure 6.14). The main process steps in the production of silicones are: methyl chloride synthesis grinding of silicon direct synthesis (Mller-Rochow synthesis) distillation hydrolysis/condensation or methanolysis polymer synthesis (equilibrium polymerisation or polycondensation).
The first five process steps lead to the formation of PDMS that is further processed into thousands of silicone products in later process steps. 6.3.2.1 Auxiliary chemicals and utilities A number of auxiliary chemicals and utilities are used to support the production of silicones. These may include: nitrogen for inertisation of certain process steps and pumping of elemental silicon natural gas or fuel for steam production or thermal oil heating, and for the vent incinerator thermal oil for heat-transfer in the direct synthesis catalysts for fostering the reaction steam for heating electricity to power process equipment refrigerant liquids/gases for cryocondensation cooling water sulphuric acid sodium hydroxide or sodium carbonate.
204
Chapter 6
Methanol HCl Catalyst H2SO4 NaOH Water Methylchloride synthesis CH3Cl purification HCl circle HCl treatment Distillation Dimethyldichlorosilane (>80 %) Trimethylchlorosilane Tank HCl acid Hydrolysis HCl gas Water Cyclic and linear oligosiloxane Catalysts Solvents Condensation Tank Tank Methyltrichlorosilane Water To synthesis of fumed silica CH3Cl circle Condensation Other silanes Tank Silicon (purity check) + activator Process boundaries for the production of PDMS
CH3Cl tank
Grinding
Direct synthesis
Dust abatement
Washing Drying
6.3.2.2 Raw materials and auxiliary chemicals storage and handling The main raw materials for the production of silicones are elemental silicon, HCl, and methanol. Auxiliary chemicals used in the production of silicones include catalysts (e.g. copper catalyst in the direct synthesis), activators and solvents. Elemental silicon (also called silicon metal) at greater than 98 % purity is delivered to the plant in pellets by trucks. The pellets are unloaded in a covered storage area or directly into a storage silo. Loaders or mechanical transport devices (e.g. bucket elevators) are used to take the elemental silicon from the loading area into the grinder. Once sieved to the appropriate size, the elemental silicon is stored and processed in a closed system under nitrogen. Other solid raw materials (e.g. catalysts) are delivered on site in drums or other small packaging units. All the liquid materials used in the production of siloxanes are stored in closed tanks and handled by closed piping systems (with nitrogen inertisation). 6.3.2.3 Methyl chloride synthesis Methyl chloride (CH3Cl) is synthesised from methanol (CH3OH) and hydrogen chloride (HCl) in the gas phase or in the liquid phase (Figure 6.15). The catalyst used to foster the reaction may vary from one producer to another (e.g. Al2O3, ZnCl2). The operating temperatures are normally 150 to 200 C and the pressure range is from 2 to 3 bars. The hydrogen chloride used in this process step can be partly recovered from the hydrolysis process (see Section 6.3.2.7 below).
Speciality Inorganic Chemicals 205
Chapter 6
CH3OH HCl
Evaporator/ overheater
Reactor
Catalyst
NaOH
Separation
H2SO4
Purification
Liquefaction
CH3Cl
The conversion of methanol is nearly complete (98 99 %) in this reaction. A by-product is dimethylether. Unreacted hydrogen chloride (1 2 %) is discharged as hydrochloric acid together with the reaction water. HCl and, in some cases, unreacted methanol are recovered and recycled back into the process. Remaining traces of hydrochloric acid vapour, water and a small volume of dimethylether is absorbed in sulphuric acid, which can be recovered by a sulphuric acid recovery plant. The methyl chloride is then liquefied by cryocondensation, and sent to storage tanks to serve as feedstock for the direct synthesis. The cryocondensation is executed, e.g. with refrigerant liquids or gases. Alternatively, the methyl chloride can be compressed and liquefied by water condensation. 6.3.2.4 Grinding of silicon Silicon powder is an essential raw material in the production process of silicones. The technology of the direct synthesis operation determines the particle size of the elemental silicon powder. Therefore, the grinding unit usually includes a grinder and a siever to control particle size distribution. Grinding is carried out in a low oxygen content atmosphere or by taking other special technical measures to prevent explosions. 6.3.2.5 Direct synthesis In the Mller-Rochow process, the elemental silicon powder reacts with methyl chloride in a fluidised-bed reactor (the main catalyst used is copper) to produce dimethyldichlorosilane (the yield of the reaction is typically >78 %) according to the following equation: Si + 2CH3Cl silicon methylchloride
206
Cu X
(CH3)2SiCl2 dimethyldichlorosilane
Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Chapter 6
The operating temperatures are normally 280 330 C. The impurities contained in the elemental silicon and the catalysts used heavily influence the performance of the chemical reaction. Details of the specifications for the elemental silicon and catalysts used are confidential. The main by-products of the reaction are methyltrichlorosilane (5 12 %) and trimethylchlorosilane (2 4 %). Other by-products are methylhydrogendichlorosilane (CH3HSiCl2), dimethylhydrogenchlorosilane ((CH3)2HSiCl), tetramethylsilane, tetrachlorosilane, disilane, trisilane and silicon-free compounds. The mixture of silicon, copper and other co-catalysts (detailed information on catalyst composition is confidential) is continuously fed into the fluidised-bed reactor along with superheated methyl chloride (liquid methyl chloride which has been evaporated before being superheated). The elemental silicon particle size is <1 mm, so that no product separation and no greater product emission takes place. The gas coming out of the reaction is composed of dimethyldichlorosilane, of by-products and of unreacted methyl chloride. Cyclones and/or bag filters separate any dust (e.g. composed of a mixture of silicon, copper, impurities from silicon) carried out of the reactor, so that only gaseous substances can continue further along the process. The remaining residues from the separation are partly recycled back into the reactor (Figure 6.14). The gaseous products which are free of dust pass through condensers in order to extract the unreacted methyl chloride which is then recycled back into the process (Figure 6.14). Most of the uncondensable gases (mainly nitrogen, light hydrocarbons and small quantities of methyl chloride) are incinerated on or off site. The direct synthesis step is a net producer of energy which is recuperated and used particularly for the distillation step. 6.3.2.6 Distillation The bulk of the methylchlorosilanes obtained are distilled in several columns to recover high purity methylchlorosilanes such as: dimethyldichlorosilane: methyltrichlorosilane: trimethylchlorosilane: methylhydrogenodichlorosilanes: dimethylhydrogenochlorosilanes: tetramethylsilane: tetrachlorosilane: 78 90 % 5 12 % 2 4% 2 5% <1 % <1 % <1 %.
Due to extremely high purity requirements, some of the separations are difficult and require columns with a large number of separation stages. The separation of the methylchlorosilane mixture is energy intensive. The difference in boiling points between the two main products from the direct process, dimethyldichlorosilane and methyltrichlorosilane, is 4 C. In view of the highly reactive nature of chlorosilanes, which readily hydrolyse when in contact with water to form corrosive hydrochloric acid, the reaction is highly regulated and controlled and is designed to ensure process containment under normal operating conditions.
207
Chapter 6
6.3.2.7 Hydrolysis/condensation or methanolysis After separating the different products and by-products by distillation, dimethyldichlorosilane is hydrolysed to produce polydimethylsiloxane (PDMS). The chlorine atom in the methyl-chlorosilane is replaced by an OH-group, which is the basis for further condensation reactions to produce higher molecular weight siloxanes. The complete hydrolysis of dimethyldichlorosilane leads to an oligomer mixture, consisting of cyclic dimethylsiloxanes and hydroxyl-terminated linear dimethylsiloxanes. Complete hydrolysis with water, or a mixture of methanol and water, is carried out continuously in the liquid phase with saturated hydrochloric acid, or in the gas phase. Liquid-phase hydrolysis gives cyclic and linear oligomeric dimethylsiloxanes (the ratio depends on the hydrolysis conditions). The siloxane products which are insoluble in water, are separated and purified.
Neutralisation/washing Na2CO3 Water Raw siloxane Waste water
H2O (CH3)2SiCl2
Settling vessel
Hydrolysis generates hyperazeotropic hydrochloric acid, which is recycled for recovering HCl. The gaseous hydrogen chloride which is generated can be used directly for the synthesis of methyl chloride. The aqueous hydrogen chloride obtained in liquid phase reactions can be sold or recovered and re-used in the process depending on its quality. In most cases, recovery is only economical for large volumes. The recovery of gaseous hydrogen chloride from the hydrolysis of dimethyldichlorosilane is, for example, integrated into the hydrolysis process. HCl recovery is not economical for low production volumes. In these cases, hydrogen chloride is neutralised and discharged into the sewerage system.
208
Chapter 6
6.3.2.8 Polymer synthesis In the polymer synthesis, PDMS forms different polymeric structures depending on process conditions. Over 4000 different products can be manufactured at a given plant starting with raw PDMS. Silicone polymers can be synthesised in two ways, depending on the end-product required: equilibrium polymerisation polycondensation.
In the cyclisation reaction, equilibrium polymerisation is utilised to convert cyclic dimethylsiloxanes into polydimethylsiloxane polymer chains. As the products from the hydrolysis process consist of both linear and cyclic siloxanes, the oligomeric mixture must be distilled or totally converted into cyclic molecule structures. This can be achieved by heating the hydrolysis mixture with potassium hydroxide or other catalysts in a solvent mixture. The catalysts promote an equilibrium reaction, in which the Si-O-Si bonds are cleaved and reformed (cyclisation). As easily volatile cyclic dimethylsiloxanes are continuously distilled off, the equilibrium is shifted in a direction favouring the desired cyclic siloxane, so that all of the siloxane mixture is finally converted into cyclic dimethylsiloxane. Trifunctional impurities are retained. From the mixture of simple cyclic organosiloxanes obtained, ultrapure octamethylcyclotetrasiloxane (D4) is distilled off, which can be used for polymerisation. Other cyclosiloxanes are recycled back into the equilibration process or placed on the market. The polymerisation of D4 can be executed either anionically or cationically. Anionic polymerisation with alkali-metal hydroxide, especially KOH, is of industrial importance. In the presence of KOH and water, the cyclic organosiloxanes are converted via an intermediate product, to linear hydroxyl-group terminated polydimethylsiloxane chains. After neutralisation of the mixture, the remaining cyclosiloxanes are separated by distillation. Other raw materials can be added to obtain functional polymers. Cationic polymerisation of cyclosiloxanes is carried out with strong protonic or Lewis acids. An industrially important catalyst is sulphuric acid.
6.3.2.8.2 Polycondensation
Whereas the preferred starting materials for equilibrium polymerisation are cyclic siloxanes, polycondensation is only possible with hydroxyl-terminated linear oligomers. The polycondensation reaction takes place at normal temperatures in the presence of an acid catalyst, e.g. phosphonitrilic chloride, and is completed by neutralisation. Polycondensation generates a small volume of reaction water, which is distilled off under a vacuum and is discharged as waste water. Analogously to the manufacture of linear polysiloxanes on the basis of dimethyldichlorosilane, branched siloxanes can also be generated by the addition of tri- and tetrafunctional units. The viscosity of polysiloxanes significantly increases with increased branching. In some cases, solvents therefore have to be added to process these high viscosity fluids. These solvents must be recovered, as far as possible, from the manufacturing process. The kind of siloxane product obtained depends on the molecular weight and the number of branches and molecular networks. The main product groups are silicone fluids, resins, elastomers and emulsions.
Speciality Inorganic Chemicals 209
Chapter 6
? Polycondensation
Energy (steam)
H2SO4 Methanol HCl Catalyst NaOH (e.g. Al2O3, ZnCl2) Waste water treatment plant (WWTP)
Incinerator
Washing tower
Off-gas scrubber
Energy
Figure 6.17: Consumption of raw materials, auxiliary materials, energy and water for the production of silicones
In the direct synthesis, 85 95 % of elemental silicon is converted into methylchlorosilane monomers, 78 90 % of which are dimethyldichlorosilanes. The hydrolysis reaction is almost quantitative. The HCl and methanol yield is >94 %. Catalyst consumption in the direct synthesis represents 1 4 % (by weight) of the elemental silicon consumption.
6.3.3.1.2 Energy consumption
Energy sources used for the production of silicones are electricity, steam (1.2 bars, 6 bars, 10 bars and 30 bars) and natural gas. Electricity is used to run pumps, compressors, agitators and other electric motors. Direct synthesis is a net producer of energy which is recuperated and converted into steam used particularly for the distillation step. Natural gas is mainly used to operate the vent incineration units.
210 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Chapter 6
Utility consumption for silane distillation is optimised by pinch methodology. The electricity consumption for PDMS production is about 23 30 MJ/kg PDMS. The steam consumption cannot be estimated because steam is provided by central units or recovered by internal heat exchange. Each plant site has its own unique solution for optimising energy consumption.
6.3.3.1.3 Water consumption
Water is used in the production of silicones for: washing waste gases in scrubbers hydrolysing dimethyldichlorosilane cleaning equipment cooling equipment washing PDMS.
Water volumes are measured for the whole manufacturing process down to the finished products. The usage of water is optimised. The maximum specific consumption of process water is about 20 m3/t PDMS. 6.3.3.2 Air emissions Emissions to air from the production of silicones are shown in Figure 6.18. The specific data provided refer to PDMS production which ends with hydrolysis. The polycondensation and polymerisation process steps are not included.
Process boundaries for the production of PDMS Fugitive dust emission* Dust back into process Silicon storage + purity check Fabric filter Dust Silicon grinding and Methyl chloride synthesis (including CH3Cl purification) Hydrocarbons Dimethylether Nitrogen Methanol Methyl chloride Hydrocarbons Hydrogen Nitrogen Methane Methyl chloride Nitrogen Methyl chloride Methylchlorosilane Direct synthesis Distillation Hydrolysis Dust Dust back into process Equilibrium polymerisation or Polycondensation Dust: 8 <263 g/t PDMS Treatment
Incinerator Final emissions to air Off-gas from the process * One producer uses a fabric filter to abate dust
Washing tower
To HCl recovery or incineration or scrubbing Dust: <84 g/t PDMS HCl: <34 g/t PDMS Cl-: <63 g/t PDMS NOx: <840 g/t PDMS
Stockpiles of raw materials (e.g. silicon) can be a source of diffuse dust emissions.
211
Chapter 6
Off-gas from elemental silicon grinding, storage and handling. The dust-loaded off-gas streams from elemental silicon grinding, storage and handling are led to off-gas filters before being discharged into the air. The dust concentration in the treated off-gas streams is generally in the range of 8 <263 g/t PDMS (which approximately corresponds to a range of 10 - 50 mg/Nm3. Industry prefers to use g/t PDMS instead of mg/Nm3 because it gives comparable results using mg/Nm3 would not give comparable results between silicone producers because various amounts of nitrogen are used to convey elemental silicon). The filtered elemental silicon powder is recycled, e.g. back into the direct synthesis process. Off-gas from methyl chloride synthesis. The off-gas stream from methyl chloride synthesis and the CH3Cl purification unit mainly consists of nitrogen (87 89 %) and dimethylether (10 %), methyl chloride (1 3 %), methanol and traces of hydrocarbon. Due to its composition, waste gas from methyl chloride synthesis and the CH3Cl purification unit is treated in an incineration unit. After incineration, the off-gas is purified in a washing tower, in some cases, under alkaline conditions to minimise emissions of dust and chlorinated species. Off-gas from direct synthesis. The off-gas stream from direct synthesis mainly consists of nitrogen (70 80 %), methane (10 20 %), hydrogen (5 %), hydrocarbon (1 2 %) and methyl chloride (1 %). Due to its composition, waste gas from direct synthesis is led to an incineration unit. Off-gas from distillation. The off-gas stream from the distillation step contains nitrogen, methyl chloride and methylchlorosilanes. Due to its composition, waste gas is led to an incineration unit or washed out with water. Off-gas from hydrolysis. The off-gas stream from the hydrolysis process mainly contains nitrogen and hydrochloric acid. The off-gas stream is treated in a washing tower to eliminate hydrochloric acid. Off-gas from polycondensation. The composition and volume of the off-gas streams from the polycondensation step in the production of high molecular linear or branched silicones can vary significantly. They depend on the desired silicone end-product, so that the following waste gas treatments are necessary, in order to minimise emissions: if the off-gas is loaded with HCl and traces of chlorosilane, HCl is recovered and recycled back into the process if the off-gas is strongly loaded with hydrocarbons (e.g. >5 %) and silanes (e.g. >5 %), it is led to an incineration unit off-gas streams with a low load of siloxanes and hydrocarbons are led to an off-gas scrubber. The resulting waste water is discharged into a waste water treatment plant.
6.3.3.3 Water emissions Emissions to water from the production of PDMS are shown in Figure 6.19. The main waste water sources from PDMS production are: methyl chloride synthesis direct synthesis hydrolysis/condensation with subsequent purification.
212
Chapter 6
Process boundaries for the production of PDMS Silicon storage + purity check Treatment
Silicon grinding and Methyl chloride synthesis (including CH3Cl purification) Direct synthesis Distillation Hydrolysis Equilibrium polymerisation or Silanes Methanol Methyl chloride Cu Zn ClPolycondensation Siloxane Silanol Methanol ClLow load of: siloxane hydrocarbons Off-gas scrubber
Water volume: 24 m3/t PDMS COD: 14.4 kg/t PDMS AOX: 20.9 g/t PDMS Cu: 45 g/t PDMS Zn: 45 g/t PDMS Cl-: 154 kg/t PDMS SO4 : <60.9 kg/t PDMS Final emissions to receiving water Waste water from the process Waste Water Treatment Plant (WWTP)
To receiving water
Note 1: the specific data shown in Figure 6.19 regarding waste water emissions are maximum values of waste water volume and impurities before treatment and refers to PDMS production only (i.e. the polymerisation and polycondensation steps are not included). Note 2: the data refer to the inflow stream to the WWTP. Note 3: the waste water treatment is carried out in two steps: the waste water from PDMS production is pretreated by precipitation/flocculation followed by sedimentation to remove heavy metals and oils. After this pretreatment, the waste water is purified in a biological step together with water from other production processes. In one case, it is treated outside of the site boundaries in a municipal waste water treatment plant. The main organic impurities present in the waste water from the direct synthesis step are siloxane, methanol and methyl chloride. The main organic impurities from hydrolysis and methyl chloride synthesis are siloxanes, silanol, and methanol. Inorganic impurities in waste water arise from the use of different catalysts and other additives. The main inorganic compounds present in the waste water are copper, zinc, chlorides, and sulphates. Table 6.17 gives the typical copper and zinc concentrations after sedimentation.
Parameter Cu Zn Concentration (mg/l) <0.5 <2
The waste remaining after sedimentation is a mixture of organic residues and metal compounds. The sludge is dewatered before disposal either via combustion or at a dedicated hazardous waste disposal facility.
213
Chapter 6
The final purification of waste water takes place in a biological treatment plant, normally in combination with waste water from other manufacturing processes on site or with municipal waste water. 6.3.3.4 By-products and solid wastes
6.3.3.4.1 By-products
Table 6.18 indicates the possible use of by-products from the production of silicones.
By-product H2SO4 Methyltrichlorosilane Trimethylchlorosilane Other silanes HCl Process source Methyl chloride synthesis Direct synthesis Direct synthesis Direct synthesis HCl treatment Possible use External sales and internal use External sales (e.g. synthesis of pyrogenic silica or specialised silicones) and internal use External sales (e.g. synthesis of specialised silicones or hexamethyldisilazane) and internal use External sales (e.g. for synthesis of specialised silicones or specialised silanes) and internal use Recycling in methyl chloride production and external sales
6.3.3.4.2 Wastes
Residues from direct synthesis contain siloxanes, elemental silicon and heavy metals. The main residues from hydrolysis are siloxanes. Residues from the chlorosilane distillation mainly contain hydrocarbons and chlorosilanes. The amount of waste which is incinerated, landfilled or recycled outside of the process boundaries varies from one silicone installation to another. The total amount of waste produced at an installation is in the range of 46 313 kg/t PDMS. Such variations between installations are caused by: differences in process conditions differences in recycling inside the process boundaries local infrastructure (e.g. internal use of by-products in other production streams, central incineration, availability of waste site and disposal options) cost aspects.
Companies with a high level of recycling inside the process boundaries have the lowest waste volume, and therefore, by default, a lesser recycling level outside the process boundaries. Companies with a high waste volume are more likely to recycle outside of process boundaries. 6.3.3.5 Noise The main source of noise in the production of silicones comes from the grinding of elemental silicon and from compressors. Hooding of the grinder and compressors is a measure used to reduce noise level in the installation.
214
Chapter 6
6.3.4.2 Optimisation of utility consumption by pinch methodology Description In the PDMS production process, electricity, steam (1.2 bars, 6 bars, 10 bars, 30 bars) and natural gas (mainly to run the vent incineration units) are used. The energy from the MllerRochow synthesis is converted, for example, into steam. Utility consumption for silane distillation is optimised by pinch methodology. Data from the analysis are confidential. Electricity is mainly used to run pumps, agitators and other electric motors. For further information on Pinch methodology, please refer to Section 4.8.1. Achieved environmental benefits reduction of utility consumption.
215
Chapter 6
6.3.4.3 Dry dedusting system for elemental silicon grinding, storage and handling Description Filtration systems are used to reduce dust emissions to air from elemental silicon grinding, storage and handling. Fabric filters are generally used for this purpose. An example of a fabric filter system is shown in Figure 6.20.
Back-flush phase
4 6 5 6 6
Operating phase
3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Raw gas duct Filter bags Compartment casing Clean gas duct Air fan Solenoid valves Dust hopper Rotary valves
7 8 8
Figure 6.20: Example of a fabric filter system used in the production of silicones
Each silicone producer in Europe has between 5 to 20 fabric filters (usually one on each point source e.g. silo, grinder) in its filtration system. The dust separated is collected and recycled back into the process (direct synthesis). A description of fabric filters is provided in the Reference Document on Best Available Techniques in Common Waste Water and Waste Gas Treatment/Management Systems in the Chemical Sector [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits reduction of dust emissions to air reduction in raw elemental silicon consumption through the recycling of separated dust back into the process.
Cross-media effects General information on cross-media effects associated with the use of fabric filters is presented in the Reference Document on Best Available Techniques in Common Waste Water and Waste Gas Treatment/Management Systems in the Chemical Sector [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
216
Chapter 6
Operational data Industry reported that one plant producing silicones achieved as low as 5 mg/Nm3 by using fabric filters, but not consistently, and that 20 mg/Nm3 is a fairly challenging emission level to reach (Germany indicated that a plant in Germany easily meets the 20 mg/Nm3). Industry indicated that fabric filters manufacturers cannot guarantee levels lower than 20 mg/Nm3 due to the characteristics of the dust in silicones production (very fine and very abrasive dust). The majority of measurements made (one to three samples per year) show levels of between 5 and 20 mg/Nm3 as well as higher levels of up to 50 mg/Nm3 and even above. The loading of the filters changes drastically during the production process. The emission levels generally achievable with fabric filters are 2 10 mg/Nm3 [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. For more information on operational data associated with the use of fabric filters please refer to the Reference Document on Best Available Techniques in Common Waste Water and Waste Gas Treatment/Management Systems in the Chemical Sector [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Applicability General information on applicability is presented in the Reference Document on Best Available Techniques in Common Waste Water and Waste Gas Treatment/Management Systems in the Chemical Sector [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Economics General information on economics associated with the use of fabric filters is presented in the Reference Document on Best Available Techniques in Common Waste Water and Waste Gas Treatment/Management Systems in the Chemical Sector [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. Driving force for implementation local regulations.
217
Chapter 6
6.3.4.4 Optimisation of the chemistry for the direct synthesis Description The catalyst system, reactor design and physical parameters for direct synthesis are optimised to minimise the formation of light hydrocarbons that are led to incineration. Details of such optimisations are producer specific and are, therefore, confidential. Achieved environmental benefits reduction in the amount of waste sent to incineration reduction of fugitive VOC emissions.
Operational data Chemistries used in direct synthesis is confidential information and operational data cannot, therefore, be provided. 6.3.4.5 Recovery of methyl chloride through condensation with water heat exchangers Description At one plant, the off gas after distillation containing MeCl, N2 and chlorosilanes is condensed before incineration, firstly through a water-cooled condenser and then through an ammoniacooled condenser. In another plant, water condensers maximise recovery of methyl chloride for re-use. The residual, non-condensed methyl chloride and inert gases (mainly nitrogen) pass to the incineration unit. This condensation technique is used as an industrial example in a good practice guide published by Envirowise in the UK. Achieved environmental benefits reduction of methyl chloride emissions to the air reduction of consumption of raw methyl chloride through recovery and recycling back into the process.
Operational data Methyl chloride is compressed to about 6 bar to enable condensation with water. Operational details are confidential.
218
Chapter 6
Driving force for implementation Compliance with local regulations, economics and the statutes of the chemical industrys Responsible Care initiative. Example plants Dow Corning, United Kingdom GE Bayer Silicones, Germany Wacker-Chemie GmbH, Germany.
Reference literature www.envirowise.gov.uk; GG100 Solvent Capture and Recovery in Practice: Industry Examples. 6.3.4.6 Recovery of methyl chloride through condensation using cryogenic fluids Achieved environmental benefits reduction of methyl chloride emissions to the air reduction of consumption of raw methyl chloride through recovery and recycling back into the process.
Example plants Dow Corning, United Kingdom GE Bayer Silicones, Germany Rhodia, France Wacker-Chemie GmbH, Germany.
219
Chapter 6
6.3.4.7 Condensation of methylchlorosilanes by air condensers Description Methylchlorosilanes are condensed by air condensers. Achieved environmental benefits reduction of cooling water reduction of the risk that water enters methylchlorosilanes.
220
Chapter 6
6.3.4.8 Thermal oxidation of off-gases containing light hydrocarbons and chlorinated organic compounds Description Off-gases containing light hydrocarbons and chlorinated compounds from the production of silicones are treated in a thermal oxidiser. The thermal oxidiser must be authorised to burn chlorinated compounds. The amount of VOC, methyl chloride and chlorosilane emissions to the air are directly related to the reliability of the thermal oxidiser. To reduce chloride emissions, a scrubber is necessary after thermal oxidition. Achieved environmental benefits reduction of VOCs (light hydrocarbons) emissions reduction of methyl chloride emissions reduction of chlorosilane emissions.
Cross-media effects Thermal oxidition of chlorinated substances requires the use of fuels (e.g. natural gas), unless the chlorinated substances are incinerated together with other waste of proper fuel value. Operational data Data for emissions of individual substances (i.e. pollutants), in particular HCl, could not be derived as three out of four installations share end-of-pipe abatement equipment with other processes and waste streams that do not pertain to the SIC sector. To avoid the formation of polychlorinated dibenzodioxins/furans (PCDD/F) when incinerating chlorinated compounds with a content of more than 1 % of halogenated organic substances, the following special operating conditions are considered appropriate. These conditions are indicated in several EU regulations on incineration, e.g. Directive 2000/76/EC on the incineration of waste: temperature >1100 C (850 C when incinerating waste with less than 1 % of halogenated organic substances) residence time >2 s oxygen content >3 %.
In addition, conditions that favour formation of dioxins/furans immediately following combustion are to be prevented. This is achieved by a fast-quench of post-combustion gases by cooling them very quickly from high temperatures to below the temperature-window of dioxins/furans reformation. These measures are designed to keep PCDD/F emissions below 0.1 ng TEQ/Nm3. Waste gases are thermally oxidised with or without additional liquid or solid streams which may not be a part of PDMS production. These different feed stream compositions and technologies used result in different air discharge parameters and corresponding discharge concentrations.
221
Chapter 6
One PDMS producer typically runs its thermal oxidiser at 1150 C. The waste gas generally provides enough energy to achieve such an operating temperature with little or no supplementary fuel being required. To operate at lower temperatures would require additional energy in the form of cooling. Other producers operate at lower temperatures, e.g. 850 C due to the co-incineration of waste (solids and/or liquids). Operating at higher temperatures than this could require additional heat energy. Applicability generally applicable.
Example plants Wacker-Chemie GmbH, Germany GE Bayer Silicones, Germany Dow Corning, United Kingdom Rhodia, France.
222
Chapter 6
6.3.4.9 Treatment of waste water from PDMS production Description Certain metals are used as catalysts in the direct synthesis step (the specific catalyst systems are confidential). Traces of these metals are carried out in the water effluents coming from the following distillation step. The waste water from PDMS production is treated in two steps: the waste waster is pretreated by precipitation/flocculation followed by sedimentation to remove heavy metals. After this pretreatment, the waste water is purified in a biological step (on-site or off-site at a municipal waste water treatment plant). In the pretreatment step, the soluble heavy metal ions present in the waste water from PDMS production (e.g. Zn, Cu, Al) are converted into insoluble metal complexes by precipitation through the addition of e.g. calcium hydroxide (Ca(OH)2). The pH of the solution has to be brought to a suitable level allowing the soluble heavy metal ions present in the waste water to precipitate out of the solution. The pH should be between 8 to 10. It has to be noted that Zn and Al are amphoteric substances and therefore necessitate for precipitating to maintain the pH in a determined range. Flocculants are used to aid the precipitation process. The liquid/solid mixture passes to a clarifier which enables the solids to settle by gravity (sedimentation) prior to removal at the base of the clarifier. The removed solids (consisting of calcium and metal salts) are then dewatered using a filter prior to being sent for landfill or incineration disposal. Some solid residues can build up in the feed tank to the water treatment over time (years). These residues are periodically (~ every four years, taking advantage of the maintenance inspection of the tank) removed and sent to landfill or incineration. The sedimented sludge is a mixture of organic residues and metal compounds, which, after dewatering is sent for disposal to an incinerator or to a hazardous waste landfill. Unless the effluents containing organics were separated before being treated with lime, making further biological treatment unnecessary, the clarified effluent passes to a biological treatment process where micro-organisms (or biomass) are mixed with the effluent in a bioreactor to consume organic material present. As the biomass digests the organic material in the effluent, carbon dioxide is produced and this is absorbed into the water as carbonic acid which reduces the pH of the final effluent stream. Air or oxygen is fed to the bioreactor to keep the biomass active. The effluent overflows from the bioreactor into a clarifier where the biomass settles out and is returned to the bioreactor. The clarified water passes through a filter to remove residual solids as the final treatment step. The sludge is either incinerated, landfilled or sent to metal recovery plants. Achieved environmental benefits reduction of the TOC content in the discharged water reduction of the heavy metals content in the discharged water.
Cross-media effects consumption of chemicals for precipitation/flocculation (e.g. calcium hydroxide) consumption of energy the precipitation/flocculation step produces sludges that need to be disposed of.
223
Chapter 6
Applicability generally applicable. Sodium hydroxide can be used as a precipitation agent, but may not be cost effective.
Example plants GE Bayer Silicones, Germany Dow Corning, United Kingdom Wacker-Chemie GmbH, Germany Rhodia, France.
6.3.4.10 Minimisation of the quantity of water used in the production process Description Volumes of cooling and process water are measured for the whole manufacturing process down to the finished goods. The usage of water is optimised. Whenever possible and economically justified, heat exchangers are built as air condensers. Achieved environmental benefits reduction of the TOC and Cl content in the discharged water reduction of waste water.
224
Chapter 6
6.3.4.11 Re-use of the water formed in the methyl chloride synthesis step into the hydrolysis step Description The water formed in the methyl chloride synthesis step can be re-used in the hydrolysis step. Achieved environmental benefits reduction in the amount of waste water generated in the production reduction in consumption of fresh water in the hydrolysis step.
Applicability Because trace levels of methanol are present in the water formed in the methyl chloride synthesis step and can result in methoxy end-blocking on linear PDMS siloxanes, re-use of the water in the hydrolysis step is applicable only if the indicated effect on the end-products is tolerated by the customers. Driving force for implementation economics.
225
Chapter 6
6.3.4.12 HCl recovery from the hydrolysis of dimethyldichlorosilane Description HCl is recovered from the hydrolysis of dimethyldichlorosilane and used in methyl chloride synthesis. Achieved environmental benefits reduction of HCl consumption in methyl chloride synthesis.
Applicability HCl recovery is not economical for small production volumes. In these cases, hydrogen chloride is neutralised and discharged into the sewerage system. Driving force for implementation cost aspects.
Example plants Wacker-Chemie Gmbh, Germany Dow Corning, United Kingdom GE Bayer Silicones, Germany.
226
Chapter 6
6.3.4.13 Selection of the elemental silicon particle size Description The elemental silicon particle size is <1 mm to achieve maximum efficiency (i.e. reaction yield) of the chemical reaction in direct synthesis. Data on the exact particle size used are considered to be confidential. Achieved environmental benefits high efficiency with a small elemental silicon loss as waste.
227
Chapter 6
6.3.4.14 Use of a covered elemental silicon storage Description Storage of elemental silicon before grinding is carried out in a covered area. Achieved environmental benefits reduce diffuse emissions of elemental silicon to the air.
228
Chapter 6
6.3.4.15 Minimise the source of ignition energy from elemental silicon grinding Description Installation of a magnetic sorting system allows the capture of metallic parts upstream of the grinder. Installation of antistatic blades on the bucket elevator limits the accumulation of static electricity. Achieved environmental benefits reduced risk of fire with subsequent environmental impact.
229
Chapter 6
6.3.4.16 Minimise the sources of explosions from elemental silicon grinding and conveying Description The concentration of oxygen and/or elemental silicon dust in the equipment (e.g. grinder, conveyor) atmosphere is permanently maintained at a safe level below the LEL. A safe oxygen level for elemental silicon is about 5 %, depending on the silicon particle size. The oxygen content is continuously monitored and alarms are reported to the control room. The grinder is automatically shut down in the cases where there is a high content of oxygen. Pneumatic transport of ground elemental silicon is carried out in an inert gas (e.g. nitrogen) atmosphere. The grinding unit is maintained at a slightly higher pressure than atmospheric pressure, in order to prevent air inlet. The grinding plant can also be run at less than atmospheric pressure to reduce the potential of diffuse dust elemental silicon emissions from occuring. Any nitrogen supply breakdown in the grinding unit would trigger the shut down of the unit. Achieved environmental benefits reduced risk of explosions with subsequent environmental impact.
Reference literature Directive 94/9/EC of 23 March 1994 on the approximation of the laws of the Member States concerning equipment and protective systems intended for use in potentially explosive atmospheres (also called the ATEX directive). Directive 1999/92/EC of 16 December 1999 on minimum requirements for improving the safety and health protection of workers potentially at risk from explosive atmospheres.
230
Chapter 6
6.3.4.17 Cooling of the distillation columns with air Description Organochlorosilanes are very sensitive to hydrolysis, that is, they react readily with water and vigorously give off hydrochloric acid. For safety reasons in the case of leaks, the distillation columns are usually not cooled with water but with air [7, Dr. Held, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits reduction in the risk of accidents with subsequent environmental impact.
6.3.4.18 Backup power source for the waste water treatments Description An automatic backup power source for waste water treatments can be installed. Alternatively, it is possible to have adequate storage volume containment for untreated water in the event of power failure. Achieved environmental benefits limits of the risks of accidental spills.
231
Chapter 6
232
Chapter 6
Prevention of accidents If a bucket elevator is used to charge the grinder, BAT is to: 6.3.8 minimise the sources of ignition energy from elemental silicon grinding (see Section 6.3.4.15), e.g. by having antistatic blades installed on the elevator to limit the accumulation of static electricity. In order to minimise the risk of accidents and the subsequent environmental impact, BAT is to: 6.3.9 minimise the sources of explosions from grinding and conveying elemental silicon by maintaining the oxygen and/or elemental silicon dust content in the equipment atmosphere at a safe level below the LEL, for example by applying a combination of the measures below (see Section 6.3.4.16). A safe oxygen level for elemental silicon is about 5 %, depending on the silicon particle size: a. using nitrogen gas injection or continuous dust extraction b. continuously monitoring the oxygen content in the atmosphere of the grinder and reporting alarms to the control room c. carrying out pneumatic transport of ground elemental silicon under an inert gas atmosphere d. tripping the grinder in case of breakdown of the inert gas supply.
In order to reduce the risk of accidents and the subsequent environmental impact, BAT is to: 6.3.10 cool the distillation columns with air (see Section 6.3.4.17). Energy BAT is to: 6.3.11 reduce the consumption of energy by recycling the energy produced in the direct synthesis, e.g. for the distillation step (see Section 6.3.3.1.2). Waste gas treatments BAT is to: 6.3.12 minimise emissions of VOCs (light hydrocarbons) and chlorinated compounds to air by thermal oxidation of the off-gases from the methyl chloride, direct synthesis and distillation process steps. This should be followed by scrubbing (see Section 6.3.4.8). In general it is BAT to use the operating conditions (i.e. temperatures, residence time and turbulence) as specified in Article 6 of Directive 2000/76/EC. The use of operating conditions in excess of those that are required for efficient destruction of the VOCs (light hydrocarbons) and chlorinated compounds should generally be avoided. The use of other operating conditions may also be BAT if they provide a similar or better level of overall environmental performance. For example, where the use of operational temperatures of below 1100 C (as specified for certain hazardous waste in 2000/76/EC) have been demonstrated to provide a similar or better level of overall environmental performance, the use of such lower temperatures is considered to be BAT.
233
Chapter 6
Waste water treatment/management BAT is to: 6.3.13 minimise the consumption of water by applying all of the following (see Sections 6.3.4.10 and 6.3.4.11): a. measuring volumes of cooling and process water for the whole manufacturing process down to the finished goods b. optimising the usage of water c. using air-cooled condensers instead of water cooled condensers where technically and economically justified d. re-using water generated in the methylchloride synthesis step into the hydrolysis step provided any resulting changes to the product quality can be tolerated. For waste water treatment, BAT is to: 6.3.14 minimise emission of Cu and Zn to water by pretreating the water effluents from PDMS production by precipitation/flocculation under alkaline conditions followed by sedimentation and filtration (see Section 6.3.4.9). This includes a. dewatering sludge before disposal and b. recovering solid metal residues in metal recovery plants or c. disposing of sludge via incineration or landfill. BAT is to: 6.3.15 reduce BOD/COD content of the water effluent coming out of the pretreatment by applying a biological step (see Section 6.3.4.9). BAT is to: 6.3.16 minimise the risk of accidental spills in the event of a power failure by applying either of the following techniques (see Section 6.3.4.18): a. providing an automatic backup power source for waste water treatments b. providing adequate storage volume containment for untreated waste water.
234
Chapter 6
235
Chapter 6
6.4.1.2 Toxicity Lead azide, lead trinitroresorcinate and lead picrate have been classified as dangerous substances under Council Directive 67/548/EEC on classification, packaging and labelling of dangerous substances. It should be noted that some new products, which are less toxic than lead compounds, are under experimentation in several countries to serve as primary explosives.
236
Chapter 6
6.4.1.3 Production capacity The reported production capacity of lead azide, lead trinitroresorcinate and lead picrate in Europe is given in Table 6.20.
Location (city, country) Troisdorf, Germany Rivalta, Italy Galdcano, Spain Vsetin, Czech Republic Clrieux, France Hry, France Survilliers, France Tarbes, France La Fert-Saint-Aubain, France Production capacity in 2004 Lead azide Lead trinitroresorcinate ~20 t lead trinitroresorciante <15 t lead azide <10 t lead trinitroresorcinate <5 t lead azide <5 t lead trinitroresorcinate <300 kg lead picrate ~25 t lead trinitroresorciante <5 t lead azide <5 t lead trinitroresorcinate <5 t trinitroresorcinate ~1 t lead azide ~1 t lead trinitroresorciante <1 t lead azide <1 t lead trinitroresorcinate
Table 6.20: Production capacity of lead azide, lead trinitroresorcinate and lead picrate in Europe
It should be noted that other European producers exist in Italy, Germany, Portugal and probably in Sweden, Austria and Poland [40, ZANTE, 2004]. Less than 25 tonnes of SIC explosives (lead azide and lead trinitroresorcinate) are produced in Spain and Portugal every year compared to a total production of 95000 tonnes of explosives (both primary and secondary explosives) in these two countries, most of which are of organic nature. In France, total production capacities are way over effective production (50 to 100 kg/day production at each installation). Because SIC explosive substances are extremely sensitive (i.e. easily ignited or detonated) and, therefore, dangerous to transport, articles made with SIC explosive substances (e.g. detonators, blasting caps, initiating systems for pyrotechnics and propellants), that are designed to be safe in storage, transport and use, are manufactured at the very same site as the SIC explosive substances. 6.4.1.4 Features of the European SIC explosive industry In Europe, large enterprises (over 250 employees) and medium sized enterprises (between 50 and 249 employees) manufacture SIC explosives. The workforce employed to run SIC explosive production facilities within these companies is generally below 20. Production is carried out batch wise in sites where production and storage buildings are scattered as a safety measure. In Spain, production is carried out in installations that are part of a larger explosive manufacturing complex where secondary explosives are produced. In France, production is carried out in plants that are dedicated to the production of initiating devices.
237
Chapter 6
6.4.1.5 Economics Economical data and product prices are usually not publicly available in the explosives industry. For SIC explosives that are used as initiating charges for organic explosives and blasting agents, production figures follow those of these secondary explosives. Therefore, as the production figures of secondary explosives have remained nearly constant for the last few years, or are slightly declining, the production figures for the SIC substances used as initiating systems have remained constant. As the two major applications of explosives are in civil works and mining, it is important to point out that, at the time of writing, mining is declining in Europe and civil works (mainly road and tunnel construction) is the only market with a significant growth rate in some Member States. For SIC explosives that are used in the automotive industry (mainly lead trinitroresorcinate), production has significantly increased during the past ten years. However, Directive 2000/53/EC on end-of-life vehicles forbids the use of lead compounds after 1 July 2007, so production should greatly decrease after that date. SIC explosives (lead trinitroresorcinate) are widely used as the main component of primer caps for hunting and sporting ammunition. This market is slightly declining, and new products without lead (e.g. 2-Diazo-4,6-Dinitrophenol, mercuric-5-nitrotetrazole) are now starting to be investigated but are not commercially available yet. The final customers do not buy SIC explosives directly, but indirectly in the products or devices using them (i.e. primer or percussion caps, squibs, detonators, pyrotechnic devices, etc.) and sometimes buy them as separate products. In other cases, SIC explosives are bought as part of a more complete supply or service, so it is very difficult to provide general features about competition or structure of the market for SIC explosives.
Building floors where these operations are carried out are liquid tight in order to contain any spill and to avoid pollution of the soil by lead compounds. 6.4.2.1 Process chemistry Lead azide is produced by the reaction of lead nitrate (solid) and sodium azide (solid) in stoichiometric proportions through the following reaction: 2Na (N=N=N) + Pb(NO3)2 X (N=N=N) Pb (N=N=N) q + 2NaNO3 Sodium azide is produced industrially by the reaction of liquid sodium with liquid ammonia, followed by the addition of nitrous oxide to give sodium azide and sodium hydroxide. Sodium azide used in European SIC explosives manufacturing installations is imported from nonEuropean countries.
238
Chapter 6
Lead trinitroresorcinate is produced by the reaction of lead nitrate (solid), magnesium oxide (solid) and trinitroresorcine (solid) through the following reactions: MgO + C6H(NO2)3(OH)2 X Mg C6H(NO2)3(O)2 + H2O Pb(NO3)2 + Mg C6H(NO2)3(O)2 X Pb C6H(NO2)3(O)2 q + Mg(NO3)2 Lead picrate is produced by the reaction of lead nitrate Pb(NO3)2, sodium picrate and acetic acid (CH3COOH) through the following reaction: Pb(NO3)2 + Na(C6H2(NO2)2NH2O) X Pb(C6H2(NO2)2NH2O)2 q + 2NaNO3 6.4.2.2 Raw materials and auxiliary chemicals storage and handling Raw materials are stored under cover (inside buildings), in metallic drums or in bulk bags. At some plants, the different raw materials are stored in dedicated rooms where the room temperature is maintained at a constant 20 C. Storage areas have no drainage points in the floor. Only some raw materials (e.g. sulphuric acid, nitric acid) are stored in aboveground storage tanks equipped with secondary containment. 6.4.2.3 Raw material solution Solid raw materials are usually dissolved in water to prepare aqueous solutions containing the anionic and cationic components of the SIC explosive product. The proportion of water used to prepare the solutions is considered confidential information by the SIC explosive producers. Adjustment of the solutions pH is of significant importance for product quality. 6.4.2.4 Reaction The material solutions are brought to the reactor (stirred tank of <100 litres capacity) by means of pipes and valves where they are agitated and heated up to approximately 50 C. Dextrine is added to obtain a proper product grain shape and size (dextrine is a natural product that acts as a crystalline modifier, but is used only in the production of lead azide, not in the production of other SIC explosives). The reaction (i.e. precipitation) is carried out by adding two or more water solutions to the vessel. The temperature and the pH both have a significant influence on the quality properties of the explosive produced (e.g. particle size and shape). Formation of crystal needles overly sensitive to shocks is to be avoided particularly in the production of lead azide. The reaction takes place at atmospheric pressure and leads to the formation of a precipitated lead salt. Residence time in the reactor is about one hour. The temperature is controlled by external heating and/or cooling through jackets. Agitation of the solution is stopped to allow explosive crystals (of about 70 [ in size) to settle at the bottom of the reactor. The mother liquor (containing explosive impurities and unreacted lead nitrate) is removed from the reactor and led to waste water treatment. Temperature and residence time in the reactor are important factors to control in order to avoid the formation of large crystals that are sensitive to handle even below water.
239
Chapter 6
6.4.2.5 Purification of SIC explosives At reaction temperatures, the SIC explosives are always insoluble in the reacting media. Therefore, purification is usually carried out by solid-liquid separation and washing with water and a small quantity of organic solvents (mainly ethyl alcohol) is used to minimise organic impurities. The SIC explosive powder is loaded up on antistatic trays (containing less than 5 kg of products) and manually transported to the drying area. Waste water (containing explosive impurities and unreacted lead nitrate) which comes from the purification step is led to waste water treatment. 6.4.2.6 Drying of SIC explosives For safety reasons, the drying area is located at some distance from the reactors room (prevention of the domino effect). The drying area consists of built-in closets where the trays are deposited. Hot air (65 70 C) circulates in the closets through the trays and dries the moist crystals (steam is used as the source of energy to heat the circulating air). Residence time in the drying area is about 72 hours. The warm air is circulated at a low flowrate in order to avoid particulate emissions (from the SIC explosive powder) into the drying room. SIC explosives (mainly trinitroresorcinate) are often not dried and directly mixed with other products in a wet phase. 6.4.2.7 Handling and storage of SIC explosives Finished products are stored in storage buildings equipped with extensive electrical protection (e.g. ground lines) and safety systems. Storage buildings are located at safe distances from any other building to prevent a domino effect in the event of an accidental detonation. Security systems are also in operation in every handling and storage area, particularly to prevent intrusion. No special environmental issues are related to the storage of inorganic explosive products, as long as a maximum temperature of 20 25 C is maintained during storage.
240
Chapter 6
Sodium azide, dextrine, sodium hydroxide or magnesium oxide, trinitroresorcine, sodium hydroxide, acetic acid or sodium picrate, acetic acid
Lead nitrate
Water
Activated carbon
Reaction
COD reduction
Lead removal
Ethyl alcohol
Purification
Steam
Air heating
Drying*
*SIC explosives (mainly lead trinitroresorcinate) are often not dried and directly mixed with other products in a wet phase
Figure 6.22: Consumption of raw materials, auxiliary chemicals, energy and water for the production of SIC explosives
Reaction
COD reduction
Lead removal
Pb COD TSS Nitrates Sulphates pH Water volume To receiving water or off-site WWTP
Purification Residues Final emissions to water Drying Waste water from the SIC process
Sludge to disposal
The purity and quality check of the raw materials is of paramount importance to avoid the production of defective products that will have to be reprocessed (increase of energy use) or managed as waste (increase of waste volume) and consequently will result in increasing the overall environmental impact of production.
241
Chapter 6
6.4.3.1 Raw materials and auxiliary chemicals consumption The production of lead azide (LA) necessitates raw and auxiliary materials as indicated in Table 6.21.
Substance Lead nitrate Sodium azide Dextrine Use Raw material Raw material Crystalline modifier Production step Reaction Reaction Mixing with sodium azide Reaction Purification Waste water treatment Quantity (in kg/kg of LA produced) 1.14 0.45 Confidential data Confidential data Confidential data Confidential data (twice the equimolecular quantity of nitric acid related to sodium nitrite)
Sodium hydroxide pH adjustment Ethyl alcohol Washing of LA Chemical destruction (i.e. oxidation reaction) Sodium nitrite of explosive impurities in waste water before lead removal treatment Chemical destruction (i.e. oxidation reaction) Nitric acid of explosive impurities in waste water before lead removal treatment Ferric chloride Verify the completeness of the above oxidation reaction Precipitation of lead carbonate as part of the lead removal treatment Adsorption of coloured organic impurities in waste water
Confidential data Trace quantities for chemical qualitative analysis of explosive impurities in water {no information provided} {no information provided}
Table 6.21: Raw and auxiliary materials used in the production of lead azide (LA)
The production of lead trinitroresorcinate (LTNR) necessitates raw and auxiliary materials as indicated in Table 6.22.
242
Chapter 6 Substance Lead nitrate Magnesium oxide (or magnesium hydroxide) Trinitroresorcine Sodium hydroxide Acetic acid Ethyl alcohol Sodium polysulphides Hydrochloric Acid Use Raw material Raw material Raw material pH adjustment pH adjustment Washing of LTNR Chemical destruction of explosive impurities Chemical destruction of explosive impurities Production step Reaction Reaction Reaction Reaction Reaction Purification Waste water treatment Waste water treatment Waste water treatment Waste water treatment Quantity (in kg/kg of LTNR produced) 0.74 0.09 0.54 Confidential data Confidential data Confidential data 0.27 0.41 0.14
Sodium hydroxide pH adjustment Chemical destruction of explosive impurities in waste water and precipitation of lead sulphate as part of the lead removal treatment Adsorption of coloured organic impurities in waste water
Sulphuric acid
Confidential data
Activated carbon
Approximately 0.27
Table 6.22: Raw and auxiliary materials used in the production of lead trinitroresorcinate (LTNR)
The production of lead picrate (LP) necessitates raw and auxiliary materials as indicated in Table 6.23.
Substance Lead nitrate Sodium picrate Acetic acid Water Sulphuric acid Activated carbon Use Raw material Raw material pH adjustment Washing of LP Chemical destruction of explosive impurities in waste water Adsorption of coloured organic impurities in waste water Production step Reaction Reaction Reaction Purification Waste water treatment Waste water treatment Quantity (in kg/kg of LP produced) {no information provided} {no information provided} {no information provided} {no information provided} Confidential data Confidential data
Table 6.23: Raw and auxiliary materials used in the production of lead picrate (LP)
6.4.3.2 Energy consumption Electricity is the main type of energy used for the production of SIC explosives (e.g. lighting, powering of motors in pumps and stirrers). Steam is used for heating the air needed to dry the explosive crystals after the purification step. It may also be used for heating the reactors. Steam is provided by natural gas boilers or other means. In 2004, the total consumption levels at a Spanish installation were around 103000 kWh (approximately 6600 kWh per tonne of SIC explosives produced). Consumption at a Czech installation is estimated at approximately 12000 kWh per tonne of SIC explosives produced. This is due to the extra energy needed to operate an evaporator used after the reaction step in order to re-use water in solutions of raw materials (90 % of the water is recuperated).
Speciality Inorganic Chemicals 243
Chapter 6
6.4.3.3 Water consumption Water is used in the production of SIC explosives for: putting raw materials into solutions (see Section 6.4.2.3) washing of the explosive crystals in the purification step (see Section 6.4.2.5) cleaning equipment cooling equipment.
The proportion of water used in solutions of raw materials is confidential information of the SIC explosive producers. The water used to clean production equipment is collected and sent to waste water treatment to remove its lead content. Significant quantities of water are used to maintain production building floors wet in order to avoid sparks from static electricity. The estimated consumption of fresh water at a Spanish installation represents approximately 500 m3/t of SIC explosives produced [23, Castresana, 2004]. Consumption of fresh water at a Czech plant is about 10 % of that of the Spanish installation (i.e. 50 m3/t of SIC explosives) due to the re-use of water permitted by the operation of an evaporator after the reaction step. For installations with large production capacities and/or where the ratio between energy cost/water cost justifies it, water consumption can be lowered down to 50 m3/t of SIC explosives produced by performing appropriate recycling dispositions (see Section 6.4.4.2). 6.4.3.4 Air emissions There are no significant air emissions from the production of SIC explosives. Only very minor fugitive emissions of ethyl alcohol arise from the purification and drying steps. In addition, some low volume emissions arise from the chemical destruction of the dissolved explosive residues contained in the waste water. Fugitive air emissions are neither collected nor treated due to their very low volume and negligible impact on the environment. It can also be noted that CO2 may be emitted to the air during the treatment of waste water arising from the production of SIC explosives (carbon dioxide is produced in the reaction between acidic waste water and sodium carbonate solution). 6.4.3.5 Water emissions Waste water from the production of SIC explosives (originating from the reaction and purification steps) mainly contain lead soluble salts (i.e. lead nitrate raw material) and organic coloured materials (i.e. traces of trinitroresorcine raw material, partially soluble in water). Waste water is generally treated in several steps; pretreatment steps are carried out within the SIC installation, followed by treatment in a central WWTP (see Figure 6.23). The first operation in the pretreatment steps consists of destroing the traces of explosives materials (i.e. LA, LTNR or LP) contained in the waste water by using nitric acid and sodium nitrite (in case of production of LA) or sulphuric acid (in case of the production of LTNR). Activated carbon is used for the adsorption of organic impurities (e.g. trinitroresorcine) responsible for the yellow/green colour of the waste water. After such a treatment, COD is reduced to <600 mg O2/l.
244
Chapter 6
Lead contained in waste water is precipitated by adding sulphate and/or carbonate anions to obtain solid lead sulphate and/or lead carbonate (this treatment is carried out together with the destruction of traces of explosives material in the production of LTNR). The efficiency of the lead removal pretreatment used at a Spanish installation is shown in Table 6.24.
Total lead concentration in Total lead concentration in waste waste water after pretreatment water before pretreatment and before discharge to a central on-site WWTP 1500 mg/l 5 mg/l 30000 mg/l 15 mg/l
Table 6.24: Efficiency of the lead removal pretreatment in the production of lead azide and lead trinitroresorcinate at a Spanish installation
In the production of lead azide and lead trinitroresorcinate at a Spanish installation, water effluent (after removal of traces of explosive materials, lead removal and activated carbon treatment) is collected and treated in a central on-site Waste Water Treatment Plant (WWTP) together with other industrial waste waters coming from industrial activities not covered in this document. This central WWTP has no biological treatment. Sludge from this central WWTP is sent to an off-site contractor authorised to deal with such waste. The company has the intention to send, in the near future, the effluent coming out of the central on-site WWTP to a municipal waste water treatment plant that includes aerobic and anaerobic steps, and carries out nitrification/denitrification. Neutralisation is also used for pH adjustment of the final effluent before discharging it into the river or the municipal sewerage system. Because of the rather constant value of the parameters in the water effluent, monitoring of the water effluent (before and after the central on-site WWTP) is carried out every two weeks at the Spanish plant. The typical concentration of pollutants in waste waters at the output of the central WWTP at the Spanish plant is given in Table 6.25.
Pollutants COD Nitrates pH Soluble lead Sulphates TSS Concentration (mg/l) 200 1900 as NO35.5 9.5 0.05 0.5 900 as SO42150
Table 6.25: Typical concentration of pollutants in waste waters at the output of the central WWTP
245
Chapter 6
Annual water emission levels and concentration values of pollutants in discharged water from different installations in Europe are given in Table 6.26 and Table 6.27.
Reference plant Plant A
1
TSS 75
COD
Nitrates Sulphates (as NO3-) (as SO42-) kg/t of end-product 100 950 450
Pb g/t 250
3.2
310
1400
0.2
Table 6.26: Annual water emission levels in the production of SIC explosives Nitrates (as NO3-) mg/l 1900 Sulphates (as SO42-) 900 Volume of waste water treated m3/h 3.5
TSS 150
COD 200
Pb mg/l 0.5
11
1000
100 55
0.7
Table 6.27: Concentration values of pollutants in water emissions in the production of SIC explosives
6.4.3.6 Solid wastes In the lead azide production process, waste arises from waste water treatment sludge (containing lead carbonate PbCO3) which is collected, put in metal drums and disposed of by an external contractor. In the lead trinitroresorcinate production process, waste arises from waste water treatment sludge (containing lead sulphate PbSO4) which is collected and disposed of by an external contractor. Another type of waste is made of solid materials contaminated with traces of explosives. Table 6.28 shows the quantity of solid wastes generated at a Spanish installation in 2003, which is considered typical.
Solid waste type Solid waste containing traces of explosives (e.g. coming from the hand washing of production equipment) Sludge containing PbCO3 Sludge containing PbSO4 Spent activated carbon Quantity generated in 2003 63 kg/t of explosives 350 kg/t of lead azide 210 kg/t of lead TNR 270 kg/t of lead TNR
Table 6.28: Typical quantity of solid wastes generated at a Spanish installation 246 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Chapter 6
6.4.3.7 Odour and noise emissions The main sources of noise at installations producing SIC explosives are motors, pumps, and fans. Odour is not an issue at installations producing SIC explosives.
These two substances are moderately soluble salts and are easily separated by gravity from the waste water. They are disposed of by a waste contractor. Lead recovery is possible from these salts in lead metallurgical industries. The simple addition of sulphuric acid or sodium carbonate to the mother liquors yields the precipitation reaction by adequately adjusting the pH of the reaction media. This technique is not used in isolation, but as a pretreatment technique. Achieved environmental benefits reduction of the lead concentration in the released waste water possibility of lead recovery in metallurgical furnaces.
247
Chapter 6
Cross-media effects sulphuric acid (H2SO4) consumption sodium carbonate (Na2CO3) consumption the precipitants have to be disposed of as sludge.
Operational data The efficiency of the lead removal pretreatment system at a Spanish installation is shown in Table 6.29.
Total lead concentration in waste water before pretreatment 1500 mg/l 30000 mg/l Total lead concentration in waste water after pretreatment and before discharge to a central on-site WWTP 5 mg/l 15 mg/l
Table 6.29: Efficiency of the lead removal pretreatment system at a Spanish installation
The resulting lead concentration after pretreatment is limited by a number of factors, such as pH, the production process as well as the solubility of PbCO3 (when sodium carbonate is the precipitation agent used) or by the solubility of PbSO4 (when sulphuric acid is the precipitation agent used). Applicability generally applicable.
Economics Both sulphuric acid and sodium carbonate are chemicals that are cheap and available worldwide. Driving force for implementation reducing emissions of heavy metals to water.
Reference literature 23rd International Annual Conference of ICT 1992, Waste management of energetic materials and polymers, J-L. Chen, S-J. Jing, C-H Lin, Elimination of detrimental constituents from plant effluents resulting from the manufacture of basic lead styphnate, 30 June 3 July 1992, Karlsruhe, Germany.
248 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Chapter 6
6.4.4.2 Removal of traces of explosive materials containing lead from waste waters using a neutralisation station Description A neutralisation station can be used to treat the waste waters loaded with traces of explosive materials containing lead coming from the reaction and purification steps of the SIC explosives production process. The neutralisation station is composed of the following main elements: neutralisation tanks evaporator/concentrator (for the treatment of water-based liquids) chamber filter press.
The removal of traces of explosive materials containing lead from the waste waters is carried out in two steps. Traces of explosive materials containing lead in the waste waters are decomposed in the neutralisation tanks by chemical methods to non-explosive substances (salts). In the case of lead trinitroresorcinate, the decomposition is according to the following reaction: Pb-C6H(NO2)3(O)2 q + 10NaOCl + 8HNO3 X 3CCl3NO2 + Pb(NO3)2 + NaCl + 3NaHCO3 + 6NaNO3 + 3H2O Off-gases from the decomposition process (containing hydrogen azide, chlorine and chloropicrin) are treated on a carbon filter. The carbon filter is regenerated off-site by a specialised company. Sludge (containing most of the lead) from the neutralisation tanks is pumped to the chamber filter press. The liquid part which has substances containing traces of lead is pumped to the evaporator/concentrator and this uses the combined effect of vacuum and heat pump technology to make water-based liquids boil at a low temperature (20 30 C). At a plant in the Czech Republic, the solid residues from the evaporator are managed by an external contractor and sent to a secure disposal site. The concentrate liquid residue is mixed to the other (non-SIC) waste waters of the plant, the overall water effluent being treated in a (off-site) municipal WWTP. The following are possible outputs from the neutralisation station: hydrogen azide (HN3) gas (absorbed on a carbon filter) chlorine (absorbed on a carbon filter) chloropicrin (absorbed on a carbon filter) clean water (returned back to production) concentrated liquid residues (to disposal).
Achieved environmental benefits reduction of the lead concentration in the released waste water reduction in water consumption through re-use of the cleansed water in the production process.
Cross-media effects emissions to air (hydrogen azide, chlorine and chloropicrin) generation of concentrated liquid residues to be disposed of generation of solid residues to be disposed of consumption of electricity (installed power: 35 kW, consumption: 0.177 kWh/l) and pressurised air consumption of auxiliary chemicals (H2SO4, NaNO2, NaOCl, NaOH).
249
Chapter 6
Operational data The operational data provided in this section comes from the example plant mentioned below. A very low level of maintenance is required. The treatment capacity is 3000 l/day. Concentrated liquid residues coming out of the neutralisation station amounts to 120 l/day. The noise level in the neutralisation station is about 74 dB. The technical specifications of the evaporator used in the example plant as well as a daily mass balance are given respectively in Table 6.30 and Table 6.31.
Parameter Power input Production of distillate yield Production of distillate yield Production of liquid concentrate Evaporation ratio (clean water distilate:concentrate) Specific consumption Table 6.30: Technical specifications of the evaporator Value 31 kW 175 l/h 155 l/h 15 l/h 9:1 0.177 kWh/l Remarks Theoretical Real
Parameter Waste water input to the evaporator/concentrator Water output from the evaporator/concentrator that is returned to the process Concentrate liquid residue Solid residue from filter press Table 6.31: Example of a daily mass balance
Applicability This technique is applicable to treat waste waters coming from the production of lead azide, lead trinitroresorcinate and lead picrate. The use of an evaporator/concentrator is viable, from an economic point of view, if the cost of water supply is high and the cost of electricity supply is low: if the cost of 177 kWh is more than the cost of 1 m3 of water, the technique is not economically viable. Applicability also depends on the size of the installation: for small production units, the cost of building an evaporator/concentrator might be too high whatever the respective cost of water supply and electricity. Economics about EUR 250000 for the purchase and operation of the equipment, without the building.
250
Chapter 6
6.4.4.3 COD reduction through treatment with activated carbon Description A significant COD reduction can be achieved by segregation of waste water streams with high COD loads and a subsequent treatment with activated carbon before release to the central waste water treatment plant (WWTP). The use of activated carbon also permits the removal of colouring substances from the waste water effluent being treated. Achieved environmental benefits effective reduction of the COD released to receiving waters removal of colouring substances in waste water.
Operational data After treatment with activated carbon, the COD of the water effluent is reduced from >1500 mg to <600 mg O2/l. Applicability generally applicable.
Economics Activated carbon is a product that is rather cheap and available worldwide. The cost of carbon regeneration or disposal (by a waste contractor) is significant in the case of a high COD load. Driving force for implementation reduction of COD levels and removal of colouring substances in water effluents.
Reference literature See Section 3.3.4.2.9 on adsorption techniques in the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
251
Chapter 6
6.4.4.4 Destruction of explosive impurities from waste water Description In the production of lead azide, minor quantities of nitric acid and sodium nitrite (NaNO2, solid) are used for the chemical destruction of explosive impurities in the waste water before lead removal treatment. The reaction of this chemical destruction of explosives is as follows: Pb(N3)2 + O2 (air) + 4HNO3 + 2NaNO2 X Pb(NO3)2 + 2NaNO3 + 2H2O + 2NO2t + 3N2t Achieved environmental benefits removal of (toxic and) explosive chemical substances (lead azide) from the waste water.
Cross-media effects consumption of sodium nitrite and nitric acid emission of oxides of nitrogen.
Operational data Quantities of nitric acid and sodium nitrite are added in excess to guarantee the total destruction of traces of lead azide. A ferric chloride test is carried out to be sure that no explosive substances are present in the water effluent after the treatment. Applicability generally applicable at plants producing lead azide.
Economics relatively low cost of chemicals and equipment (e.g. stirred tank reactor).
Driving force for implementation avoids detonation accidents that can cause environmental effects.
Example plants UEB plant, Galdacano, Spain Austin Detonator, Vsetin, Czech Republic.
Reference literature Tadeusz Urbanski, Chemistry and Technology of Explosives, vol. 3, Pergamon Press, Oxford, UK (1985). Fedoroff, B.T., Encyclopedia of Explosives and Related Items, vol.1, Picatinny Arsenal, Dover, NJ, USA (1960).
252 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Chapter 6
6.4.4.5 Ground protection Description Because SIC explosive installations represent a contamination potential to the ground, surface water and groundwater, they are designed, built, operated and maintained in such a way that no spills occur. They are sealed, stable and sufficiently resistant against possible mechanical, thermal or chemical stress. Leakages are quickly and reliably recognised. Leaking substances are safely retained and treated/disposed of. This is realised by applying an impervious and stable retention area according to the amount of substance that could be spilled before other measures take effect. Additionally, double walled equipment with leak detection can be used. The ESB BREF [8, European IPPC Bureau, 2003] describes techniques used to prevent emissions to the environment from the storage and handling of solids, liquids and liquefied gases. Achieved environmental benefits prevention of contamination to the ground, surface water and groundwater.
Operational data a retention volume of at least 110 % of the capacity of the largest tank or drum in the contributing area and at least 25 % of the total capacity of the stored/handled volume is often used as a benchmark the integrity and tightness of all structure boundaries and their resistance to penetration by water or other substances are tested and demonstrated the loading and unloading of materials are carried out only in designated areas protected against leakage run-off. While awaiting disposal, all materials are collected and stored in designated areas protected against leakage run-off all pump sumps or other treatment plant chambers from which spillages might occur are equipped with alarms activated by high levels of liquid or pump sumps are regularly inspected by personnel a programme for the testing and inspection of tanks and pipelines is established and carried out inspections are carried out for leaks on all flanges and valves on pipes used to transport materials other than water. A log of these inspections is maintained a catchment system is provided to collect any leaks from flanges and valves on pipes used to transport materials other than water, except when the construction of flanges or valves is technically tight an adequate supply of containment booms and suitable absorbent material is provided all bunds are tested at least once every three to five years.
Chapter 6
Driving force for implementation prevention of contamination to the ground, surface water and groundwater.
Reference literature OFC BREF [18, European IPPC Bureau, 2004]. ESB BREF [8, European IPPC Bureau, 2003].
254
Chapter 6
6.4.6
255
Chapter 6
6.4.7 6.4.8
minimise the amount of lead in the waste water by precipitation with sulphate and/or carbonate anions (see Section 6.4.4.1). recycle waste water back into the production process where the production scale and/or the ratio between energy cost/water cost justifies this by using an evaporator/concentrator (see Section 6.4.4.2) and achieving a consumption of process water of l 50 m3/t of SIC explosives (see Section 6.4.3.3).
Once the waste water has been pretreated as indicated in BAT 6.4.5 through to BAT 6.4.8, BAT is to: 6.4.9 send the waste water to a central WWTP for treatment. If the central WWTP does not have denitrification treatment (and nitrification if necessary), BAT is to subsequently treat the waste water in a biological WWTP (on-site or off-site, e.g. municipal WWTP) with denitrification (and nitrification if necessary). Handling of solid residues BAT is to: 6.4.10 recover lead contained in solid residues (sludge from waste water treatment) in lead metallurgical industries (see Section 6.4.4.1) or appropriately dispose of solid residues containing lead (see Section 6.4.3.6).
256
Chapter 6
6.5 Cyanides
[16, CEFIC Cyanide Sector and Working Group, 2004] [1, Ullmann, 2001] Within the scope of this document, cyanides signify the speciality inorganic chemical compounds containing the cyanide ion (CN-). Hydrogen cyanide (HCN), also called hydrocyanic acid, is not included. This section only focuses on water soluble sodium cyanide (NaCN) and potassium cyanide (KCN). The other inorganic cyanide salts are not addressed due to their reported low production volume.
257
Chapter 6
When solid cyanides and colourless cyanide solutions come into contact with acids, they can change from their white colour into anything from light yellow to dark brown. The intensity of the colour change depends on a variety of parameters. This behaviour is due to a polymerisation reaction of HCN. Because such behaviour affects the quality of the products (cyanide solutions especially during production as well as solid cyanides), cyanides need to be stabilised by the addition of excess alkali (the alkali used is normally NaOH or KOH). In this sense, alkali cyanides are sensitive to any contact with humid air which contains carbon dioxide (which is a weak acid in water solution). Only if additional stabilisation with an alkali takes place, is the acid neutralised to form carbonate and the cyanide is protected from decomposition by the acid. Sodium cyanide is commercially available in briquettes, in a granular or powder form, or as an aqueous solution. Potassium cyanide is available as briquettes, or in a granular or powder form. 6.5.1.1 Uses and markets The major part of worldwide cyanide production is used for the application of sodium cyanide in gold mining to extract gold from its ores (approximately 70 % of the total sodium cyanide produced is used for this purpose). Gold, in its elementary form, is very stable and does not react easily with a number of the even very aggressive chemicals. Usually, only in the presence of a strong oxidant together with a complexing agent can gold be reacted and be made water soluble (soluble gold salts). In gold mining, cyanides are used as complexing agents. The other two largest applications of cyanides worldwide are the chemical synthesis of organic and inorganic compounds (e.g. to produce pharmaceuticals, food additives, feed additives, pigments, complexing agents) and the electroplating of metal surfaces (e.g. zinc, gold, silver). In the latter application, potassium cyanide is preferred, particularly for the deposition of gold and silver. In Europe, the largest application of cyanides is in the chemical synthesis industry. The second largest application in Europe is for the electroplating of metal surfaces together with metal hardening. The use of cyanides in the mining industry only comes in third position. 6.5.1.2 Quality of the cyanide products/specifications The quality of cyanides depends on the heavy metal impurities they contain which originate from the NaOH or KOH raw materials. Among cyanide users, the electroplating industry has the highest requirements and, therefore, sets quality standards in terms of heavy metal impurities in the cyanides. The mining industry could basically accept cyanides with a higher content of heavy metal impurities but is actually not supplied with a different specification than the one for the electroplating industry. All end users apply the same high quality specifications for cyanides.
258
Chapter 6
Apart from heavy metals, cyanides may contain impurities originating from their production process. The main impurities that can be generated in the cyanide production process are cyanate (OCN-), formate (HCOO-) and carbonate (CO32-). However, generally speaking, none of these are critical in any way for cyanide applications (very often these impurities are formed in the application processes anyway). Carbonate originates mainly from the contact of excess alkali with carbon dioxide in the air. Hydrolysis of cyanide at high temperatures (e.g. in the drying step of the production process, see Section 6.5.2.6) leads to the formation of formate and ammonia (NH3). Cyanate can be formed due to oxidation processes. Ammonia can also be seen as a possible impurity especially in solutions after a longer storage time at elevated temperatures. If slow hydrolysis in solid (wet) material takes place, the ammonia formed can be released to the gas phase around the material but is normally not built up/concentrated in the material itself. Due to these reactions that lead to the formation of HCN and/or NH3, commercial cyanide solutions can (mainly after a long storage time under non-ideal storage conditions) have a smell of HCN and/or NH3. Absolutely dry cyanides do not normally smell of any of these species as the presence of water is necessary for any of the decomposition reactions that lead to the release of HCN and/or NH3. The typical liquid cyanide product specifications are presented in Table 6.32.
Type of solution Sodium cyanide solution Potassium cyanide solution Specifications NaCN 30 % +/- 0.5 % NaOH 0.5 % +/- 0.25 % KCN 40 % +/- 0.5 % KOH 0.5 % +/- 0.25 %
The typical solid cyanide product specification is minimum 98 % pure (2 % water maximum). 6.5.1.3 Toxicity A major feature of cyanides is their high toxicity for most life forms, by all routes of exposure (i.e. ingestion, inhalation, dermal absorption). Cyanides form a number of metal cyanide complexes, most of them having toxicity similar to the free cyanide itself. 6.5.1.4 Cyanides production in Europe and worldwide In Europe and worldwide, the most important alkali cyanides, in terms of production volumes, are sodium cyanide (NaCN) and potassium cyanide (KCN). Current worldwide sodium cyanide production is about 500000 tonnes (dry basis) per year. The total amount of potassium cyanide produced worldwide is significantly lower compared to the production of sodium cyanide. In Europe, NaCN and KCN are produced at less than a dozen sites, each producing between 8000 and 50000 tonnes (dry basis) of these products per year. A significant amount of these chemicals is produced for captive use, meaning that the cyanides are used as intermediates in the production of other substances at the site. However, the greatest amount of NaCN and KCN is produced to be sold within Europe and for export outside Europe. The same production facilities can be used for the manufacture of NaCN and KCN.
259
Chapter 6
The sites where sodium cyanide and potassium cyanide are produced in Europe are listed in Table 6.33.
Location (city, country) Wesseling, Germany Geleen, the Netherlands Billingham, United Kingdom Ludwigshafen, Germany Antwerp, Belgium Kolin, Czech Republic Pitesti, Rumania Seal Sands, United Kingdom* Saint-Avold, France* Roussillon, France*
* captive use
Product(s) NaCN liquid NaCN solid KCN solid NaCN liquid NaCN liquid NaCN liquid NaCN liquid NaCN solid NaCN liquid NaCN liquid NaCN liquid NaCN liquid
Table 6.33: Sites where sodium cyanide and potassium cyanide are produced in Europe
The worldwide production capacity of cyanides is currently about 650000 tonnes for a market of about 500000 tonnes. European production capacity is currently around 140000 tonnes for a market of about 80000 tonnes. 6.5.1.5 Features of the European cyanide industry In Europe, large enterprises (over 250 employees) and medium sized enterprises (between 50 and 249 employees) manufacture cyanides. The workforce employed to run the cyanide production facilities within these companies, is generally below 60. Production is carried out in medium sized facilities using a continuous mode of operation. Production is carried out in installations that are part of a larger chemical complex where the HCN raw material is manufactured (due to the fact that HCN poses serious transportation issues). 6.5.1.6 Economics The differences in market values between NaCN and KCN are often the reflection of the market value differences of their raw materials NaOH and KOH. As KOH is significantly higher in value than NaOH, KCN is more expensive than NaCN. According to the Chemical Market Reporter of 8 December 2003, selling prices in Europe for NaCN/KCN are also subject to fluctuations in the world market. According to this report, prices were mainly less than USD 1650 per tonne for NaCN (100 % purity), and less than USD 3000 per tonne for KCN (100 % purity). During recent years, production of cyanides has consolidated to a significant extent in Europe resulting in the closure of a number of production sites.
260
Chapter 6
In the melting process, a cyanide source is not needed as a raw material; cyanides are produced from non-cyanide components (reaction of sodium metal with charcoal and ammonia). The result is solid cyanides with different kinds of impurities, e.g. carbon black from using carbon as the raw material. When cyanides are produced in the water solution process (also called the neutralisation process), the cyanide source is provided by HCN raw material. As the cyanide needs to be applied with a counter cation which makes the cyanide stable and cost effective to produce, NaOH (for the production of NaCN) or KOH (for the production of KCN) is used as the neutralisation agent. The production of HCN is, therefore, an important intermediate step for the production of alkali cyanides. However, for the reason indicated at the beginning of this section, the production of HCN is not addressed in this document. Nowadays, the water solution process is the method most largely used worldwide. Only where electricity costs are sufficiently low can melting processes be competitive. This section focuses on the water solution process only as the melting process is not used industrially in Europe. As an example, Figure 6.25 shows the main production steps for the production of cyanides using a water solution process. Liquid cyanides are produced as a result of a neutralisation/crystallisation step followed by product filtration. Solid cyanides (powder, granular or briquettes) are produced as a result of subsequent process steps: drying, compaction, granulation, separation from fine dust and eventually sieving or briquetting.
261
Chapter 6
NaOH/KOH 50% + purity check HCN NaOH H2SO4 H2O2 (liquid or gas)
Neutralisation/ crystallisation
Detoxification unit
Steam To WWTP
NaOH
H2SO4
Air heating
Drying
H2SO4 scrubber
Air circulation
Compaction
Ammonium-sulphate sent to a nearby HCN production plant where large amounts of ammonium suphate are produced
Granulation
Sieving To customers
Briquetting
Inputs to process
Waste gas
Waste water
Figure 6.25: Main steps for the production of sodium or potassium cyanide using a water solution process
In Europe, cyanides are produced in liquid as well as in solid forms. Cyanide solutions are generally concentrated to get the best efficiency for transport. Cyanide solutions are used where the application industry site is close enough to the cyanide production site so as to keep the transportation of the solution competitive against the costs of solid production (i.e. the evaporation of excess water and the formulation of solid material). 6.5.2.2 Process chemistry The formation of the cyanides is a simple chemical neutralisation reaction between a weak acid (HCN) and a strong base (OH-). The neutralisation reaction is given for both the production of NaCN and KCN: HCN + NaOH X NaCN + H2O X Na+ + OH- + CNHCN + KOH X KCN + H2O X K+ + OH- + CNAn alkaline salt is formed and this is because of the alkaline pH in the water after dissolution/hydrolysis of the cyanide salt and the subsequent formation/liberation of OH- from the water.
262
Chapter 6
6.5.2.3 Raw materials and auxiliary chemicals storage and handling Raw materials The raw materials used for the production of cyanides are HCN, NaOH or KOH and water. As HCN is a product that poses serious transportation issues, cyanide production plants are located close to HCN production plants or close to plants producing HCN as a by-product (e.g. acrylonitrile production). The HCN supplied is always kept in motion and at a cool temperature of about 5 C to prevent polymerisation. NaOH and KOH are supplied to the cyanide production facility from a tank farm via a pipeline. These raw materials are either produced on the chemical complex where the installation is located or are delivered from external suppliers to the tank farm by ship, rail or road. NaOH and KOH raw materials are stored in steel or stainless steel tanks with a capacity of between 50 and 1000 m. All tanks are equipped with the necessary safety devices (e.g. overfill protection, secondary containment, double bottom). Fresh water may be used as the raw material in a proportion that depends on the cyanide concentration requested by customers for the liquid cyanide product. Auxiliary chemicals For the production of NaCN/KCN, no auxiliary chemicals are needed. For the detoxification of cyanide residues, hydrogen peroxide (H2O2) or chlorine-based chemicals, and sulphuric acid, are used. These chemicals are stored in suitable tanks and delivered to the cyanide plant by pipeline. 6.5.2.4 Neutralisation/crystallisation The neutralisation reaction leads to an energy release of 460 kJ/mol. This energy is used in the subsequent vaporisation of water to form NaOH or KOH crystals (crystallisation). The neutralisation reaction necessitates the raw materials HCN and NaOH or KOH to be in stoichiometric proportions. The use of special mixing devices and the addition of 0.2 3 % excess NaOH or KOH prevents the polymerisation of HCN. The efficiency of the neutralisation reaction has a higher than 98 % yield based on HCN. That means that all of the HCN used is transferred into the end-product NaCN or KCN and only minimal losses of HCN occur. Simultaneously to the neutralisation reaction or in a second step, water is vaporised under reduced pressure and the alkali metal cyanide is precipitated below 100 C (crystallisation). The shorter the residence time of the cyanide in solution, the cleaner the product and the lower the content of hydrolysis products and iron impurities will be [1, Ullmann, 2001]. The evaporated water is condensed before entering the cyanide detoxification unit. A side reaction in the crystalliser (i.e. the hydrolysis of cyanide) results in the formation of NH3 that needs to be abated. The neutralisation reaction results in the formation of a dissolved NaCN (or KCN) salt (46 % NaCN solution when using 50 % NaOH and 99 % pure HCN raw materials; 47 % KCN solution when using 50 % KOH and 99 % pure HCN raw materials). Further along, the raw solution can either be concentrated or diluted with water, depending on the final product required. Usually, the aim is to form a concentrated cyanide solution containing approximately 30 % sodium cyanide or 40 % potassium cyanide.
263
Chapter 6
6.5.2.5 Filtration The crystals of NaCN or KCN are separated from the solution by filtration (drum filters or filter presses are used as the filtering device). Depending on the filtering device used, between 2 and 15 % of water remains in the solid cyanide. The solution is then returned to the crystalliser and the crystals are fed into the drying step. 6.5.2.6 Drying The moist NaCN crystals (which still contain about 12 % water) are dried (at about 300 C) with hot, CO2 free air which circulates in a closed loop within the process (see Figure 6.25). The drying and filtration steps operate in a slight vacuum so that small amounts of additional air might be sucked in. The excess air contaminated with HCN and NH3 is sent to an air cleaning system. The contaminated air is treated in a washing system which uses NaOH for abating HCN and sulphuric acid (H2SO4) for abating NH3. The excess air can also be incinerated in the air heaters if it is contaminated with organic compounds, such as benzene. After drying, crystals are separated in cyclones. At this stage, cyanide salts contain up to 0.5 % moisture. 6.5.2.7 Compaction The crystals which have a low bulk density are pressed in rotating rolls to increase their bulk density. The compacted crystals are then granulated. 6.5.2.8 Granulation The cyanide crystals are granulated in a rotative knife granulator. 6.5.2.9 Separation from fine dust/sieving/briquetting As the granulation step might create fine dust, dust is separated before producing the granules. A low content of fine dust in the granules has advantages in terms of safety and processing of the product at the customers site. The granules are then either filled into packages or are processed to briquettes or powder. The fines are separated from the granules in a sieve. The briquettes are formed in a pressing machine with rotating rolls. 6.5.2.10 Packaging and storing of cyanides Solid cyanides are generally filled into plated steel drums (usually containing between 50 and 100 kg of products) or in one tonne bags (usually made of polypropylene and equipped with an inner polyethylene liner for further protection and to make the packaging both air and water tight) which are transported in plywood boxes. The lid of the drum is fixed with a locking ring and hermetically sealed. Drums are generally used for customers from smaller industries (e.g. the electroplating industry) and plywood boxes for customers from larger industries (especially for the mining industry). Returnable packaging allowing multiple uses is an important alternative to the application of single use packaging. Both single use packaging and returnable packaging are used worldwide for transporting solid cyanides.
264
Chapter 6
An alternative for transporting cyanides is the so called Solid to Liquid System (SLS). Solid cyanides are filled into a unit containing approximately 20 tonnes of material. This unit is transported to the customers site and the solid cyanides are dissolved at the users facility and pumped to a storage facility. The transportation unit can be refilled with solid cyanide material frequently. The packaging chosen for solid cyanides depends on technical, economic and environmental considerations. Liquid cyanides are always transported in returnable packaging (metal drums or railcars). Liquid cyanide is only economically feasible within a limited radius of the production plant. The concentration of the solution can be adjusted to ensure that, even in winter, no precipitation occurs. Liquid cyanide is easier to handle and is the preferred form when large quantities of cyanides are required and aqueous solutions can be used. All packaging must meet the official requirements for the transportation of toxic substances (UN approval). All packaging is labelled according to transport regulations. Metal drums and plywood boxes loaded with products are stored in a dedicated covered area (where only cyanides are stored) equipped with extensive security and fire safety systems (e.g. the storage area is fenced, equipped with locked doors and roofed to keep rainfall out; the use of water is prohibited for extinguishing a fire in the storage area). 6.5.2.11 Handling and storage of cyanides [1, Ullmann, 2001] The stability of solid cyanides under dry conditions and isolated from air is very high, even at fairly high temperatures. Only when exposed to moist air, can solid and liquid cyanide react with carbon dioxide to release HCN: 2NaCN + H2O + CO2 X 2HCN + CO3 2- + 2Na+ Cyanides are stored in a dry place and protected against corrosion. Storage rooms are well ventilated. Storage of cyanides is separated from strong oxidants (e.g. nitrates, chlorates, nitric acid, peroxides), acids, food and feedstuffs, carbon dioxide, water or products containing water. The cyanide storage area is clearly marked and unauthorised personnel are never allowed access to rooms in which cyanides are stored or processed. Therefore, a cyanide area is separated from other areas, e.g. by fences or walls. In the case of an emergency, powder fire extinguishers, safety showers, eye washes, and antidotes are available in the immediate vicinity. Stainless steel is used as the construction material for equipment that comes into contact with cyanide solutions. However, concentrated cyanide solutions are stored in steel or stainless steel containers which are protected against leakage by a collecting basin constructed of alkaliresistant concrete. Before being packaged (into bulk containers or railcars) and sent to customers, cyanide solutions are stored at the production site in steel or stainless steel tanks that have a capacity of between 50 and 1000 m. All tanks are equipped with the necessary safety devices (e.g. overfill protection, secondary containment, double bottom).
265
Chapter 6
Work with cyanides requires the greatest possible caution and strictest adherence to all safety measures. It is not permitted to work alone, to eat, drink, smoke, use snuff, or chew gum (when handling cyanide). Also, it is prohibited to store any food, beverages, or smoking material in the cyanide area. Production of cyanides is carried out in strictly enclosed systems to prevent any contact of cyanide with the skin or eyes, as well as the respiration of cyanide dust or hydrogen cyanide gas. If a danger of cyanide contamination exists, rubber gloves, rubber boots, a rubber apron, and safety goggles or protection for the face and head are readily available. Safety showers and eye washes are located within the immediate vicinity of each cyanide area.
Table 6.34: Quantity of raw materials needed to produce one tonne of NaCN and one tonne of KCN respectively
HCN is currently produced by the direct reaction of alkanes with ammonia, and indirectly as a by-product of the manufacture of acrylonitrile (25 % of the hydrogen cyanide in the US and 20 % in western Europe is obtained as a by-product in the manufacture of acrylonitrile by the oxidation of propane and propylene in the presence of ammonia [1, Ullmann, 2001]). When HCN comes from an acrylonitrile plant, impurities in the HCN raw material (99 % pure HCN) mainly include benzene (about 70 ppm). There are no other significant impurities in the HCN raw material. NaOH and KOH with a very low content of heavy metals are used in the production of cyanides in order to limit the release of heavy metals into the environment as a result of the production process and in order to meet the requirements of the electroplating industry (see Section 6.5.1.2). For the oxidative destruction (in the detoxification unit) of cyanide residues contained in water effluents, hydrogen peroxide (H2O2) or chlorine-based chemicals are used. NaOH and sulphuric acid (H2SO4) are used in the air cleaning system to abate HCN and NH3 after the drying step. At an installation producing 20000 tonnes of NaCN (dry basis) per year, typically 100 tonnes of detoxification material (H2O2 or chlorine-based chemicals), less than 50 tonnes of H2SO4 and less than 100 tonnes of NaOH are used.
266 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Chapter 6
6.5.3.2 Energy consumption The energy costs for the production of cyanide are mainly based on electricity and steam. Electricity is used to power control systems, motors and pumps and to heat tanks and pipes used to transport NaOH. Natural gas is used to power air dryers. Steam is used in the crystallisation and in the waste water detoxification unit. Steam is produced by high pressure boilers. The consumption of steam is between 1.3 1.5 tonne of steam/t 100 % NaCN/KCN. The consumption of electricity is between 0.1 0.15 MWh/t 100 % NaCN/KCN. 6.5.3.3 Water consumption Water is used in the production of cyanides for: preparing the cyanide solution cleaning equipment cooling equipment.
For the production of the cyanide solution (only relevant for the neutralisation/crystallisation and filtration steps) water is needed as a raw material by dosing in the pipeline. Most of the water needed to produce a commercially viable cyanide solution comes from the caustic (NaOH or KOH) solution which is a major water source. Additional water needed is either fresh water or process water. Water is also used for equipment cooling purposes (e.g. cooling towers). In addition, water is used for cleaning process equipment (washing and rinsing water). After cleaning, the cyanide contaminated water is collected and re-used in the production process. Water with a low cyanide concentration is fed to the detoxification unit. 6.5.3.4 Air emissions Air emissions for a well operated cyanide production plant, which produces NaCN and KCN as solid product and as solution, is given in Table 6.35.
Pollutant HCN NH3 NOX VOCs
1
Emissions to air 1 g/t 100 % NaCN or KCN 0.5 2 0.7 3 100 500 0 0.01
The values were developed from measurements of emissions in different cyanide production plants. The ranges give a best practice depending on the process and technology used and on site-specific conditions which vary from site to site (i.e. waste water treatment). For instance, one site reports a frequency of one emission analysis every three months
Table 6.35: Emissions to air from a well operated cyanide production plant
267
Chapter 6
HCN NH3 VOCs CO2 NOx
Air heating
Drying
NaOH scrubber
H2SO4 scrubber
NH3 and HCN emissions NH3 and HCN are contaminants present in the excess air coming from the drying step. NH3 is formed as a result of the hydrolysis of cyanides under high temperature. Cyanate (OCN-) is formed first and leads to the further formation of NH3. HCN comes from the neutralisation/crystallisation step as an unreacted raw material. NH3 and HCN are abated in a washing system which uses NaOH for the abatement of HCN and sulphuric acid (H2SO4) for the abatement of NH3. The solution containing NaCN recuperated in the alkaline scrubber is recycled back into the production process. The solution containing ammonium sulphate recuperated in the acid scrubber is recycled, i.e. to a nearby HCN production plant where large amounts of ammonium sulphate are produced as forced byproducts. For health and safety reasons, monitoring devices are installed for the detection of NH3 and HCN in the work areas. CO2 and NOX emissions CO2 and NOX emissions arise from the combustion of natural gas used to power the air heaters that serve to dry the NaCN/KCN crystals prior to compaction. The combustion gases (CO2 and NOX) from the heaters are emitted to the air. All measures are taken to reach the lowest hourly emission rate of NOX. This includes: optimisation of the construction of the burner reduction of nitrogen components in the process gases separation of gas streams with high VOC concentration from gas streams with no VOC contamination reduction of flowrates.
VOC emissions VOC emissions originate from the incineration of air contaminated with organic compounds (such as benzene which may be an impurity contained in the HCN raw material see Section 6.5.3.1) in the above-mentioned air heaters. VOCs are abated in the air heaters.
268 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Chapter 6
6.5.3.5 Water emissions Waste water mainly originates from the neutralisation/crystallisation step. Waste water emissions mainly consist of free cyanide in the waste water streams.
CNTOC COD Total N water volume
Neutralisation/ crystallisation
Detoxification unit
To receiving water
Excess water from concentrating cyanide solutions is evaporated in the crystallisation step and either taken back to the process after condensing, or sent to the detoxification unit. After detoxification (see Section 6.5.4.1), cyanide concentration in the treated water effluent which is sent to public waterways is far below 0.01 ppm of free cyanide. While most of the water which is evaporated is subsequently condensed, a small amount of the vapours and non-condensable gases must be treated before being released to the air. This is accomplished by the use of wet scrubbers, or incineration, or a combination of both. Wet scrubber systems utilise liquid scrubbing solutions designed to contain or neutralise the noncondensable gases. Abatement efficiencies for these systems exceed 98 %. Incineration or thermal oxidation systems are also utilised for detoxification of the gases. Abatement efficiencies for these systems exceed 99 %. Discharge levels to a waste water treatment plant (WWTP) from a typical cyanide production plant, which produces NaCN and KCN as a solid product and as a solution, are given in Table 6.36. These levels are after detoxification and before the biological waste water treatment plant.
Pollutant NH4(+)-N COD CNTOC Emissions to a WWTP g/t 100 % NaCN or KCN 400 2000 800 4000 0.4 6 300 1500
Table 6.36: Discharge levels to a WWTP from a typical cyanide production plant
269
Chapter 6
6.5.3.6 Solid wastes No solid wastes are generated from the chemical reaction (e.g. no solid cyanide waste). Offspecification solid cyanide products are recycled back into the production process, by dissolving in waters contaminated with cyanides and re-injecting in the neutralisation/crystallisation step. On the other hand, contaminated insulations, used hand gloves and damaged packaging (originating from filling or storage operations) are solid wastes from the production process. All solid waste material is washed free of cyanide with water prior to disposal (metals are recycled in steel mill; the rest is disposed of or incinerated). The wash-water containing cyanides is sent to the detoxification unit for treatment. 6.5.3.7 Odour and noise emissions The main source of noise at the cyanide plants are motors, pumps, and fans. Noise is monitored regularly so that it does not become a nuisance. Odour is not an issue at cyanide production facilities. 6.5.3.8 Monitoring Air monitoring is carried out either by calculations or by measurements. Some installations report that the air emissions are monitored on a one to three year basis and that the efficiency of the air cleaning system is monitored on a daily basis. The water emissions are monitored continuously (in some cases, online analysis for free cyanide and total cyanide) or on a regular (mostly daily) basis (analysis) depending on the pollutant.
270
Chapter 6
Cleaned gas
Water with low cyanide content Water with low cyanide content pH adjustment Oxidation
NaOH/KOH or H2SO4
Figure 6.28: Destruction of cyanides from waste gases and waste waters
Using H2O2 based technology (as opposed to hypochlorite, for example) does not generate salts and AOX by-products. NaCN + OCl- X OCN- + NaCl (hypochlorite method) CN- + H2O2 X OCN- + H2O (peroxide method) It is common to catalyse the reaction with a transition metal such as soluble copper, vanadium, tungsten or silver in concentrations of 5 to 50 mg/l. The oxidation requires 1.26 kg H2O2 per kg of cyanide [41, H2O2.com, 2003]. Achieved environmental benefits removal of HCN/CN- from waste gases and waste waters re-use of waste water streams as raw materials no AOX in waste water no contaminated waste.
Achieved emission levels (for discharge to a biological WWTP) are given in Table 6.37.
Waste gas Waste water Concentration 1 mg HCN/m 1.1 mg CN-/l Mass-flow 3 g HCN/h 2.3 g CN-/h Reference CyPlus, Germany
271
Chapter 6
Cross-media effects consumption of energy consumption of hydrogen peroxide (H2O2) consumption of catalysts.
Operational data
Flow and concentration at the inlet of the treatment system 3400 m/h 50 mg HCN/m 1 m/h 5 % CN15 m/h 700 mg HCN/m
Reference
Gas stream Treatment capacity Waste water with high CN- concentration Waste water with low CN- concentration 99.9 %
CyPlus, Germany
Overall efficiency
A pH of 9 10 should be maintained to avoid the release of hydrogen cyanide (HCN) gas. Applicability generally applicable.
Economics cost reduction for waste water treatment due to the absence of AOX load. The technique is in practice at some installations.
Driving force for implementation removal of toxic compounds from waste gases and waste waters.
272
Chapter 6
6.5.4.2 Incineration of process air containing volatile organic compounds (VOCs) Description HCN raw material contains small amounts of volatile organic compounds (e.g. benzene) which can be found in several air streams of the production process. The air streams which contain VOCs are identified and separated from the others. The air streams containing VOCs are incinerated in an air heater which is run by natural gas. The energy from the incineration is used to heat up the air that is used to dry the cyanide crystals. A schematic of this technique is shown in Figure 6.29.
Combustion air natural gas
Combustion air
Figure 6.29: Incineration of process air containing volatile organic compounds (VOCs)
Achieved environmental benefits removal of VOCs (e.g. benzene) from waste gases saving of natural gas fuel by using benzene contained in the air streams as fuel the heat recovered from incineration is used to dry the cyanide crystals.
273
Chapter 6
Operational data
Flow and concentration at the inlet of the treatment system 2500 m/h Variable benzene concentration 99.9 % Reference CyPlus, Germany
Gas stream
Driving force for implementation removal of toxic compounds from waste gases.
274
Chapter 6
6.5.4.3 Cleaning-In-Place (CIP) system for equipment contaminated with cyanides Description During production, solid cyanide builds up in pipelines, machines and vessels and can ultimately provoke equipment malfunction or blockage. A Cleaning-In-Place (CIP) system allows easy cleaning and rinsing of equipment in a closed system. With such a system, workers are not exposed to harmful emissions. The rinsing water containing cyanide is collected in a closed piping system and stored in tanks. The rinsing water is then recycled back into the process to reduce the use of fresh water as a raw material. In addition, off-specification solid cyanide salts can be dissolved in the rinsing water collecting tanks and recycled back into the process in order to reduce the amount of hazardous waste produced. A schematic of this technique is shown in Figure 6.30.
Rinsing water Equipment with a CIP system
Achieved environmental benefits no solid wastes containing cyanides recycling of waste water containing cyanides within the process reduction of raw material consumption (i.e. fresh water) protection of the workers reduction of emissions to the environment and to the working areas.
Table 6.41: Achieved emission levels associated with the cleaning of equipment contaminated with cyanides
275
Chapter 6
Operational data
Flow and concentration at the inlet of the treatment system 15 m/h Variable cyanide concentration 99 %1 Reference
Treatment capacity
1
Rinsing water
CyPlus, Germany
Overall efficency
The remaining 1 % of the cyanides either break up (hydrolysis) to by-products or end up in the cyanide detoxification unit
Table 6.42: Operational data for the cleaning of equipment contaminated with cyanides
Economics cost reduction for waste water treatment cost reduction for raw materials.
Driving force for implementation reduction of emissions to the environment and the working areas.
276
Chapter 6
6.5.4.4 Removal of HCN and NH3 from waste gases Description Hydrogen cyanide (HCN) and ammonia (NH3) are removed from waste gases using one alkaline scrubber with NaOH solution and one acidic scrubber with H2SO4 solution. For each scrubber, the solution is circulated between a buffer vessel and the scrubber. The solution in each scrubber is sampled regularly and exchanged if the content of free OH- is too low for the absorption of HCN from the air stream or if the content of free H2SO4 is too low for the absorption of ammonia. The spent solution from the alkaline scrubber is recycled back into the process to substitute raw materials in the neutralisation/crystallisation step (see Figure 6.25). The ammonium sulphate solution formed in the acidic scrubber can be recycled off-site (e.g. in plants producing fertilisers). For safety purposes, the secondary containment of the acidic scrubber is strictly separated from the secondary containment of the alkali scrubber and the rest of the production building. This is to avoid, in the case of an accident, acids coming into contact with solutions containing cyanide, a situation which would lead to the emission of HCN into the environment. A schematic of this technique is shown in Figure 6.31.
Cleaned gas
Alkaline scrubber
Waste gas with traces of HCN and NH3
Buffer
NaCN solution Recycled back into the process Secondary containment only for alkaline substances
(NH4)2SO4 solution
Achieved environmental benefits removal of HCN and NH3 from waste gases no waste water from the alkaline scrubber (re-use of the alkaline scrubber solution into the process to substitute raw materials) strict separation of acidic and alkaline containment reduces the potential for hazardous emissions in the case of an accident.
Table 6.43: Achieved emission levels for the removal of HCN and NH3 from waste gases
277
Chapter 6
Operational data
Flow and concentrations at the inlet of the treatment system 3400 m/h 50 mg/m HCN 250 mg/m NH3 99.2 %
Reference
Gas stream
CyPlus, Germany
Table 6.44: Operational data for the removal of HCN and NH3 from waste gases
Driving force for implementation removal of toxic compounds from waste gases.
278
Chapter 6
6.5.4.5 Returnable packaging for the transport of solid cyanides Description Besides single use packaging, returnable packaging is used for the transport of solid cyanides. In a filling line, the packaging (drums, boxes, IBCs) is filled with cyanides. After the customer empties the packaging, they are sealed and returned to the producer. A second option is that the part of the packaging that did not come into contact with the cyanides (i.e. plywood box) is disassembled by the customer and returned to the producer where it is checked and assembled again for re-use. The customers can be equipped with unloading devices to unload the content of the packaging in a closed system to avoid exposure to the workers. Achieved environmental benefits reduction in the amount of contaminated packaging and waste.
Cross-media effects transport for the return of the packaging leads to additional fuel consumption.
Economics reduction of packaging costs (depending on the contract, either the producer or the customer has to bear such costs) reduction of waste treatment costs.
279
Chapter 6
6.5.4.6 Use of a computerised control system to operate the plant Description The operation of a cyanide production plant requires numerous and frequent monitoring of operating parameters, and adjustments to the process conditions, particularly to ensure safety and environmental control. A computerised control system can help monitor hundreds of process parameters and automatically make the required adjustments to ensure a safe and environmentally sound operation. Using a computerised control system, automatic interlocks can be implemented to prevent the overfilling of tanks or to minimise the generation of waste water, for example. Achieved environmental benefits reduction of emissions reduction of contaminated waste water health and safety of the workers reduction of raw material consumption.
Driving force for implementation more efficient control of process conditions reduction of emissions.
280
Chapter 6
6.5.4.7 Double containment of cyanide plants Description Even if all measures are taken to prevent leaks, they can occur at cyanide production facilities (whether or not they originate from plant operations or because concrete or other traditional civil construction materials are subject to cracking) and can result in cyanide contaminated water being present on the ground floor of the production plant. Providing double containment for the ground floor and sumps reduces the potential for cyanide to be released to the soil or groundwater. The containment is sized to hold the volume of the largest equipment in the building. Steel, stainless steel or special plastic materials, which are resistant to cyanides, can be used for containment. Achieved environmental benefits reduction of soil contamination reduction of contaminated civil construction materials.
Economics wide range of costs, from approximately EUR 100 to 5000/m2, mainly depending on the construction material used reduction of clean up and remedial costs.
Driving force for implementation improved assurance of no leakage of cyanide contaminated water to the soil.
281
Chapter 6
6.5.4.8 Application of the International Cyanide Management Code (ICMC) Description The International Cyanide Management Code (ICMC) for the manufacture, transport and use of cyanide in the production of gold is a voluntary industry code developed by a multi-stakeholder committee formed under the auspices of the United Nations Environment Programme (UNEP) and the International Council on Metals and the Environment (ICME). It is a voluntary programme of the gold mining industry, operating worldwide. The objective of the Code is to ensure very high standards for safety, environmental and quality aspects worldwide in the production, transport and use of cyanides in gold mining so that humans and the environment are protected. The application of the Code at cyanide production plants entails activities such as auditing, certification, training of plant personnel. Achieved environmental benefits reduction in the overall environmental impact of the production of cyanides.
Economics There are no savings to be made for applying the Code. Costs depend on the standards a cyanide producer already has in place it therefore means less costs for producers who already have a sound environmental management system in place, and higher costs for those who do not. Auditing can take a day, internal preparations for the audit can take several days to several weeks with the respective, e.g. personnel costs involved. Example plants CyPlus, Germany.
282
Chapter 6
6.5.4.9 Storage measures for solid cyanides Description Solid cyanides are packaged in UN certified packages for the transport of dangerous goods and are stored at the cyanide plant in specially designed storage buildings. These storage buildings are fenced and locked to prohibit access to unauthorised personnel. Solid cyanides easily dissolve in water, therefore, storage buildings are constructed so that no rainfall and surface water can enter the building. Additionally, the use of water is prohibited for fire fighting purposes in the building (alkaline foams have to be used as fire extinguishing agent. The use of acidic foams is prohibited as HCN could be set free using this kind of foam). Achieved environmental benefits reduction of soil and water contamination reduction of contaminated civil construction materials.
Applicability generally applicable, where solid cyanide salts are stored in packages.
6.5.4.10 Using NaOH and KOH with a very low content of heavy metals Description NaOH and KOH are important raw materials for the production of NaCN and KCN. The overall quality of these materials is mainly influenced by their individual production processes. Based on these processes, heavy metal salts can be ingredients of these caustics in different ranges of concentration. One of the major uses of cyanides is for electroplating purposes. In these applications different kinds of metal ions are precipitated mainly on metal surfaces. The electroplating process and the quality of end-products are strongly influenced by any kind of heavy metal salts in the working solution. Therefore, to achieve high quality end-products, the content of any undesired metal ion in any chemicals used needs to be as low as possible. For such electroplating processes, cyanides are produced with a very low content of heavy metal salts based on the use of NaOH and KOH with a very low content of heavy metals.
283
Chapter 6
During cyanide production, heavy metals in the raw material NaOH and KOH may also lead to residues within the process. This effect may force additional measures to meet standards in occupational health care and may lead to the generation of additional hazardous waste. Achieved environmental benefits reduction of the amount of waste containing heavy metal ions exposure of personnel to heavy metals, especially mercury, lead and nickel is reduced technical optimisation of processes also leads to optimal environmental performance.
Applicability generally applicable when cyanides are used in electroplating or in any process sensitive to heavy metal ions.
Economics reduction of waste at electroplating facilites improved quality of end-products less efforts in monitoring and tracing the residues of heavy metals in the process potentially longer shelf life of end-products.
284
Chapter 6
6.5.4.11 High level of education and continuous training of personnel Description The complex process to produce cyanides, the use of modern technologies, the fact that highly toxic substances are produced and that emergency situations can occur put a lot of stress on the plant personnel, in particular the plant operators. To ensure that incidents are kept to a minimum, accidents are prevented and in order to reduce the risk of error in emergency situations, specific education and training programmes are implemented. Besides a sound basic education in chemical engineering and operations, plant personnel are continuously trained on the jobs. Their skills can regularly be evaluated and performance can be recorded after written or practical exams. Additionally, all operators are regularly trained on how to respond to emergency situations, on health and safety at work, and on product and transportation safety regulations. Achieved environmental benefits reduction in the risks of incidents and accidents that could lead to emissions to the air, water and soil.
Economics Better education and continuous training of personnel leads to better decision-making when confronted by problems (including incidents and emergency situations) and finally to a reduction in production costs. Driving force for implementation enhancing safety standards.
285
Chapter 6
Emissions to air 1 g/t 100 % NaCN or KCN 0.5 2 0.7 3 100 500 0 0.01
The values were developed from measurements of emissions in different cyanide production plants. The ranges give a best practice depending on the process and technology used and on site-specific conditions which vary from site to site (i.e. waste water treatment). For instance, one site reports a frequency of one emission analysis every three months
Table 6.45: Emission levels to air associated with BAT for the production of cyanides
In the production of solid cyanides, BAT is to: 6.5.3 minimise VOC emissions from the drying step by incinerating process air containing VOCs to achieve a removal efficiency of 99.9 % and re-using the energy from incineration to dry the cyanide crystals (see Section 6.5.4.2). BAT is to: 6.5.4 minimise HCN and NH3 emissions and achieve the emission levels shown in Table 6.45 by, e.g. using one alkaline scrubber with NaOH solution to abate HCN and one acidic scrubber with H2SO4 solution to abate NH3 (see Section 6.5.4.4). BAT is to: 6.5.5 minimise NOX emissions by using a combination of the following techniques (see Section 6.5.3.4): a. optimising the construction of the burner b. reducing nitrogen components in the process gases c. separating gas streams with high VOC concentrations from gas streams with no VOC contamination d. reducing flowrates.
286 Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
Chapter 6
Waste water management BAT is to: 6.5.6 achieve the discharge levels indicated in Table 6.46 (see Section 6.5.3.5).
Pollutant NH4(+)-N COD CNTOC Emissions to a WWTP g/t 100 % NaCN or KCN 400 2000 800 4000 0.4 6 300 1500
Table 6.46: Discharge levels to water at the inlet of the WWTP associated with BAT for the production of cyanides
BAT is to: 6.5.7 minimise emission of cyanides to water by using techniques that oxidise cyanides (e.g. using peroxides such as H2O2, see Section 6.5.4.1). Using hypochlorite is also BAT when the cyanide-effluent stream is free of organic material and when no free hypochlorite is left in the effluent after the oxidation reaction. BAT is to: 6.5.8 minimise the consumption of raw material by reconditioning aqueous residues containing cyanides in order to substitute raw materials where technically possible (see Section 6.5.4.1). Prevention of soil pollution BAT is to: 6.5.9 use ground protection and strictly enclosed systems for the production of cyanides (see Section 6.5.2.11). BAT is to: 6.5.10 use a dedicated covered area equipped with extensive security and fire safety systems to store cyanides (see Section 6.5.2.10). BAT is to: 6.5.11 provide double containment for the ground floor and sumps in the production and storage areas (see Section 6.5.4.7). This involves both: a providing containment that is sized to hold the volume of the largest equipment in the building b. using steel, stainless steel or special plastic materials for containment, which are all resistant to cyanides. Energy BAT is to: 6.5.12 minimise the consumption of energy by recycling the heat released in the neutralisation reaction to vaporise water in the subsequent crystallisation step (see Section 6.5.2.4).
287
Chapter 6
Water consumption BAT is to: 6.5.13 minimise the consumption of fresh water by a combination of the following: a. re-using filtrate from the filtration step into the crystalliser (see Section 6.5.2.5) b. re-using cleaning water in the production process (see Section 6.5.4.3 and Section 6.5.3.6) c. using a cleaning-in-place system (see Section 6.5.4.3). Product storage and packaging BAT is to: 6.5.14 minimise the risk of accidents by storing cyanides in areas separated from the areas where strong oxidants (e.g. nitrates, chlorates, nitric acid, peroxides), water or products containing water are stored (see Section 6.5.2.11). BAT is to: 6.5.15 minimise the amount of solid residues by, e.g. using returnable packaging for the transport of solid cyanides (see Section 6.5.4.5). Storage of solid cyanides BAT is to: 6.5.16 store solid cyanides in covered, fenced and locked storage buildings. This includes both (see Section 6.5.4.9): a. making sure that no rainfall and surface water can enter the storage buildings b. providing alkaline foams as the fire extinguishing agent in the storage buildings to be used in the event of a fire. Plant operation BAT is to: 6.5.17 use a computerised control system to operate the plant (see Section 6.5.4.6). BAT is to: 6.5.18 apply the principles of the International Cyanides Management Code (see Section 6.5.4.8). This includes both: a. applying high standards for safety, environmental and quality aspects in the production of cyanides b. carrying out activities such as auditing, certification, training of plant personnel. Training of personnel BAT is to: 6.5.19 have a high level of education and continuous training of personnel (see Section 6.5.4.11). This includes all of the following: a. having personnel with sound basic education in chemical engineering and operations b. continuously training plant personnel on the jobs c. regularly evaluating and recording performance of personnel d. regularly training personnel on how to respond to emergency situations, health and safety at work, and on product and transportation safety regulations.
288
Chapter 6
289
Chapter 7
7 EMERGING TECHNIQUES 7.1 Decontamination of exhaust gases and waste water by chemically modified inorganic ion exchangers and active carbons
[38, Dr. Boenke, 2005] General Information This EU funded project will carry out comprehensive research and set up a semi-pilot plant for the production of adsorbents for the purification of industrial wastes and drinking water from heavy metal ions, radionuclides and organic toxic substances. New catalysts for the decontamination of exhaust gases from H2S, CO and NO will be studied. The project will combine the latest achievements in the field of development and application of new adsorbents (inorganic ionites) and catalysts (mainly based on synthetic and fruit shell and stone carbons as well as different composition oxides). Synthesis methods have already been developed and a technology for the production of inorganic ionites worked out, based on insoluble titanium and zirconium hydroxides and phosphates in the form of spherical granules which possess a high mechanical strength and a regulated surface chemistry. These materials were shown to have much better properties than most ion-exchange resins industrially produced in many countries. Hence this project aims to determine the optimum conditions for the decontamination of typical sewage waters from Cd2+, Cr3+, As3+, Zn2+, Al3+, Fe3+ and Hg2+ ions. The application of these ionites, combined with activated and oxidised carbons, is found to be very beneficial in the elaboration of cartridges for domestic use to purify drinking water from a great number of organic contaminants, radionuclides (which polluted the environment after the Chernobyl accident), and heavy metal ions, particularly microquantities of lead which are found in drinking water in some countries, e.g. UK and Germany. The project can be divided into the following research activities: preparation of adsorbent materials; characterisation of materials such as surface properties, morphology and mechanical properties; ion exchanges; catalytic behaviour; optimisation. Achievements The expected level of achievement of the two objectives is quite different. Concerning the activated carbonaceous materials (including adsorption and catalysis), the preliminary works carried out by the different participants and the existence of a semi-pilot plant of production will enable pre-industrialisation of the materials to be attained. The probability of success is higher for ion adsorptions than for the catalysis for the destruction of gaseous pollutants. The utilisation of inorganic ionites as adsorbents is more prospective. It is expected that the potential of the new materials will be verified and their efficiency compared with that of carbonaceous materials. Reference literature http://www.cordis.lu/fp5/projects.htm http://www.cordis.lu/fp6/projects.htm#search http://www.cordis.lu/en/home.html
291
Chapter 7
7.2 Utilisation of industrial waste and especially petrochemical residues for power generation with low emissions
[38, Dr. Boenke, 2005] General Information The concept is based on a confidential combustion system combined with a two step, dry fluegas treatment system and an existing boiler. The combustor is composed of a high swirl, substoichiometric combustion chamber, followed by an after combustion chamber, to which secondary air is added ensuring a residence time of 0.3 s and a temperature of 1200 C. The particular geometry, together with the flow pattern lead to complete combustion, with low formation levels of NOX, CO and dioxins. The flue-gas is desulphurised by the injection of crushed limestone, together with recirculated flue-gas to reduce the temperature to a level of 1100 1150 C. After heat recovery, lime powder and steam are added for HCl removal. Finally, the flue-gas is cleaned using bag filters. Achievements The plant using this technique started full operation on September 1988. The burner capacity was varied between 120 450 kg of oil/h while for all tests the combustion air supplied was 125 m3/h. The operating temperature of the furnace was in the range of 1150 1250 C and this was controlled by recycling flue-gases. The flue-gases purification system was modified considerably and it was concluded that hot gas desulphurisation was not needed while for HCl removal a combination of limestone and steam injection in the dechlorination reactor proved efficient and resolved all operational problems of solids and CaCl2 accumulation. No problem was encountered with the bag filter. Emission measurements for dust, CO, SO2, HCl and total carbon are performed continuously while emission measurements for inorganic halogen compounds (HF, phosgene), BTEXaromatics, chlorinated hydrocarbons, PCB and PCDD are performed periodically. It was also noted that no significant amounts of phosgene BTEX-aromatics, chlorinated hydrocarbons and polychlorinated biphenyls are emitted by the installation and these were always well below the limits set by TA Luft. However, the emissions of dioxins from furnaces were always close to the limits specified by TA Luft and although the limits were rarely exceeded, the contractor plans to continue development work in this area. Nevertheless, it can be concluded that, from the emissions point of view, the furnace chamber system with swirl has proved to burn waste oils successfully. During the demonstration period which ended in December 1989, the demonstration plant fulfilled almost 80 % of the planned capacity of waste oils combustion and about 50 % of the targeted energy savings. The reduced capacity was due to technical optimisation at the flue-gas purification system while the reduced energy savings were due to the utilisation of an existing old type radiation boiler instead of a convection boiler. Reference literature http://www.cordis.lu/fp5/projects.htm http://www.cordis.lu/fp6/projects.htm#search http://www.cordis.lu/en/home.html
292
Chapter 7
7.3 Air filtration for the abatement of volatile chromium compounds in the tanning industry
[38, Dr. Boenke, 2005] Objectives The aim of this EU funded project is the identification of innovative technologies for the abatement of air pollutants (mainly chromium) from the air effluents of the tanning industry, to be applied in small sized plants mainly for the use of small and medium enterprises; a convenient option will connect a reasonable efficiency together with reduced investment and maintenance costs. A prototype of an innovative filtering system for chromium compounds will be developed, tested and certified with the direct involvement of end users partners. The system will have to comply with precise technical, and also economic, requirements which can ensure its actual and sustainable applicability (also for smaller tanning companies). Reference literature http://www.cordis.lu/fp5/projects.htm http://www.cordis.lu/fp6/projects.htm#search http://www.cordis.lu/en/home.html
7.4 Development and application of advanced ceramic electrodes for the electrochemical elimination of cyanides in waste water
[38, Dr. Boenke, 2005] General Information Baths containing cyanide compounds are found to be among the most used in galvanic industries. This noteworthy industrial presence of cyanides has been very questioned due to their high toxicity. Among the new methods of treatment of waste water contaminated with cyanides, the electrocatalytic oxidation of inorganic pollutants on high oxygen overvoltage ceramic electrodes should be noted. One example of this technique is the so-called Dimensionally Stable Anodes (DSA) that is used in the chlor-alkali industry. A European Union funded project has the aim of developing porous ceramic electrodes having stronger elctrocatalytic activity as a result of their high area/volume relationship. The starting point will be the DSA technology, and different procedures of processing ceramics powders, such as SnOand perovskite-like structures, which will be applied. As the electrochemical elimination of cyanides in waste water is an energy intensive technique, there are questions as to whether it has economic viability in the production of cyanides described in Section 6.5. However, the technique might be applicable in cases where chemical treatments (i.e. chemical oxidation) are not feasible or possible (such as in low volume, end-use applications where a dedicated waste water treatment plant is not economically viable). Reference literature http://www.cordis.lu/fp5/projects.htm http://www.cordis.lu/fp6/projects.htm#search http://www.cordis.lu/en/home.html
Speciality Inorganic Chemicals 293
Chapter 8
8 CONCLUDING REMARKS
The IPPC Directive does not define the term Speciality Inorganic Chemicals and there is no common definition of this term in industry. This has created difficulty in defining the scope for this document and necessitates careful management of the possible interface with other chemical BREFs, in particular the LVIC-S BREF [24, European IPPC Bureau, 2004]. It is important to note that the end-of-pipe abatement techniques reported to be used in the SIC sector in the course of this work are all techniques commonly used in the chemical sector which are described in more detail in the CWW BREF [21, European IPPC Bureau, 2003]. There were some questions at the beginning of this work which included whether or not hydrocyanic acid (HCN, which is an important raw material for SIC substances e.g. cyanides, see Section 6.5) and hydrazine were to be considered in the scope of SIC. It was considered that these two substances are not SIC substances. However, they are both inorganic chemicals and their production gives rise to environmental issues of importance and therefore warrants being covered in a BREF document. As hydrocyanic acid is a chemical produced in large volume, its production could be addressed in a revision of the LVIC-AAF BREF. With regard to hydrazine, there are only two producers in Europe utilising different production routes and in a situation of fierce competition, hence this could be an obstacle to a meaningful exchange of information on BAT.
Table 8.1: Milestones for the work on the Speciality Inorganic Chemicals BREF
After the final meeting, a short consultation of the TWG on the Executive summary, Concluding remarks, and the revised BAT chapter and sections was organised before the final draft of this document was produced.
295
Chapter 8
The TWG provided input to the work on SIC mainly through: reports/documents elaborated to provide targeted information for the development of this document (i.e. for each of the illustrative families of SIC substances addressed) comments made to the two drafts issued (about 600 comments were received on the first draft and about 400 comments were received on the second) responses to requests for additional information developed by the European IPPC Bureau responses to e-mails and telephone calls from the European IPPC Bureau site visits.
The reports submitted by Germany [2, Dr. Kppke, 2003, 5, Dr. Kppke, 2003, 11, Dr. Kppke, 2004, 17, Rudolph and Kppke, 2003], Cefic [10, ANFFECC/CERAMICOLOR/EPSOM/VdMi, 1998, 16, CEFIC Cyanide Sector and Working Group, 2004], and UEE [15, Castresana, 2004] can be considered the main building blocks for the first draft of this document. Despite the fact that, when issuing the first draft, attention of the TWG was drawn to the lack of information regarding consumption and emission levels in the SIC sector and techniques to consider in the determination of BAT (Chapter 4 and Sections 6.X.4 of this document), only limited additional information was sent in response to the consultation on the first draft. However, the second draft supplemented Chapter 4 (on common techniques to consider in the determination of BAT) mainly with techniques derived from the specific/illustrative part of this document (Chapter 6) and from the CWW BREF. In the second draft of this document, the section on soluble inorganic salts of nickel (which appeared in Section 6.6 of the first draft) was removed. This decision was taken because the work on this section did not progress at the same speed as the other sections and that bringing this section to the same level of completion could have compromised the objective of holding the final plenary TWG meeting before the end of 2005 (the final TWG meeting took place from 21 to 24 November 2005). The information exchanged on the production of soluble inorganic salts of nickel made it difficult, even impossible, to come to BAT conclusions. Despite this, and in order to keep the very valuable information that was provided for future use (e.g. for the revision of this document), a separate document that compiles the results of the information exchanged on the production of these substances was prepared [49, European IPPC Bureau, 2005]. Furthermore, it should be noted that the generic/common parts have been developed so that this document could be used in the permitting process of installations producing speciality chemicals not specifically covered in Chapter 6. Some information for the work on SIC was also obtained by visiting SIC installations. A total of nine SIC installations were visited by the European IPPC Bureau for this document. These visits were made to Italy (for pigments), France (for silicones), Spain (for explosives), Germany (for phosphorus compounds and cyanides) and Finland (for inorganic salts of nickel). These visits were organised and generally accompanied by one TWG member. In addition, the European IPPC Bureau developed a questionnaire in order to gather site-specific (or installation-specific) data in particular on consumption and emission levels as well as on techniques used to minimise environmental impacts at SIC installations. However, a very limited number of these questionnaires were filled in and returned to the European IPPC Bureau. Industry indicated that the lack of response was due to concerns over confidentiality of some data requested. The questionnaire is presented as an Annex to this document (See Section 9.1).
296
Chapter 8
297
Chapter 8
There was a lack of information received from the ten new Member States despite the fact that SIC installations have been identified in these countries (e.g. inorganic explosives, cyanides). Future work could provide the missing information. There is very little information about monitoring in this document. Furthermore, when data on consumption and emission levels were submitted, the monitoring regime associated with the data was not always provided. This generated some lack of clarity in certain BAT conclusions where associated emission levels are used (e.g. the generic BAT conclusion on the abatement of total dust, the BAT conclusion on total dust abatement in the production of inorganic pigments). Future work could look at this issue more closely (e.g. characteristic emissions of the sector, special monitoring issues, sector-specific and substance-specific monitoring techniques, quality assurance of the whole information chain concerning monitoring). As indicated previously in Section 8.2, as well as in other parts of this document, the exchange of information on soluble inorganic salts of nickel could not be carried out to such an extent that BAT conclusions could be drawn, and it was consequently decided to remove the section on inorganic salts of nickel. Building up on the information already submitted which has been compiled in a separate document (see Section 8.2), future work could bring the missing information that will allow BAT conclusions to be drawn for this family of SIC (in particular actual performance data on consumptions and emissions as well as candidate techniques to be considered for BAT). In addition, soluble inorganic salts of nickel are not the only inorganic salts that could be considered in the scope of SIC. Future work could therefore include enlarging the information exchange to other inorganic salts (e.g. inorganic salts of copper that are sometimes produced at the same installations as the nickel salts). The production of speciality inorganic pigments by chemical processes is covered by this document and is addressed in Section 6.1. There are other production routes for the production of speciality inorganic pigments (e.g. iron oxides), i.e. using non-chemical production processes. Future work could provide for a comparison between chemical production routes and non-chemical production routes.
References
REFERENCES
1 2 3 Ullmann (2001). "Encyclopedia of Industrial Chemistry, Sixth Edition, Electronic Release". Dr. Kppke, K.-E. (2003). "Manufacture of Phosphorus Compounds", German Federal Environmental Agency, Berlin. UNEP; ILO and WHO (1989). "Phosphorus trichloride and phosphorus oxychloride health and safety guide", World Health Organization (WHO), http://www.inchem.org/documents/hsg/hsg/hsg035.htm. Dr. Kppke, K.-E. (2003). "Silicon and Silicon compounds", German Federal Environmental Agency, Berlin. Dr. Held, W. (2003). "Silicones - Their Science, Production and Major Qualities", Centre Europeen des Silicones. European IPPC Bureau (2003). "Reference Document on Best Available Techniques on Emissions from Storage", European Commission. Vito (2001). "Beste Beschikbare Tecnieken voor de Gieterijen", 90 382 0312 8. ANFFECC/CERAMICOLOR/EPSOM/VdMi (1998). "Ceramic Decorating Materials". Dr. Kppke, K.-E. (2004). "BAT Notes for the Production of Silicones", CES - Centre Europen des Silicones. Castresana, J. M. (2004). "SIC-EXPLOSIVES - CONTRIBUTION FROM UEE", Union Espaola de Explosivos, S.A. CEFIC Cyanide Sector and Working Group (2004). "Proposal for BREF on Speciality Inorganic Chemicals (SIC) Cyanides", CEFIC. Rudolph, P. D. and Kppke, D. (2003). "Investigations concerning Integrated Environmental Protection in Certain Industrial Productions (Manufacture of Speciality Chemicals) Industrial Inorganic Pigments", Federal Environmental Agency, Berlin. European IPPC Bureau (2004). "Draft Reference Document on Best Available Techniques for the Manufacture of Organic Fine Chemicals", European Commission. European IPPC Bureau (2003). "Reference Document on Best Available Techniques in Common Waste Water and Waste Gas Treatment / Management Systems in the Chemical Sector", European Commission. European IPPC Bureau (2004). "Draft Reference Document on Best Available Techniques for the Production of Large Volume Inorganic Chemicals (Solids and others)", European Commission. Cefic (2004). "Facts and Figures", Cefic, http://www.cefic.org/factsandfigures/level02/profile_index.html. European IPPC Bureau (2003). "Reference Document on Best Available Techniques in the Large Volume Organic Chemical Industry", European Commission. European IPPC Bureau (2000). "Reference Document on the application of Best Available Techniques to Industrial Cooling Systems", European Commisssion.
299
5 7 8 9 10 11 15 16 17
18 21
24
29 30 31
References
32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 45
European IPPC Bureau (2004). "Draft Reference Document on Best Available Techniques for Large Combustion Plants", European Commission. European Industrial Gases Association (1999). "Hazards of inert gases", IGC Doc 44/00/E. European IPPC Bureau (2004). "Draft Referencce Document on the Best Available Techniques for Waste Incineration", European Commission. European IPPC Bureau (2004). "Draft Reference Document on Best Available Techniques for the Waste Treatments Industries", European Commisssion. European IPPC Bureau (2003). "Reference Document on the General Principles of Monitoring", European Commission. European IPPC Bureau (2003). "Draft Reference Document on Economics and CrossMedia Effects", European Commission. Dr. Boenke, A. (2005). "List of Different Research Projects Relevant to Speciality Inorganic Chemicals (SIC) BREF", European Commission. Karschunke, K. (2004). "Additional Information from UBA-Germany on the production of inorganic pigments", German Federal Environmental Agency, Berlin. ZANTE, H. (2004). "Comments from SFEPA on BREF ''Speciality inorganic chemical (SIC) explosives''". H2O2.com (2003). "Cyanide treatment with peroxygen compounds", H2O2.com, http://www.h2o2.com/applications/industrialwastewater/cyanide.html. European IPPC Bureau (2004). "Draft Reference Document on Best Available Techniques in the Large Volume Inorganic Chemicals, Ammonia, Acids and Fertilisers Industries", European Commisssion. Research and Markets (2001). "The Chemical Industry Market Report - Jan 2001", Key Note Publications Ltd, http://www.reserachandmarkets.com/reportinfo.asp?report_id=3870. Dr Pflug, K. (2003). Participation models in speciality chemicals", Arthur D Little Chemicals Executive Newsletter, Summer 2003. European IPPC Bureau (2005). "Information Exchanged on the Production of Soluble Inorganic Salts of Nickel between October 2003 and April 2005".
46
47 49
300
Glossary
Glossary
TERM or ABBREVIATION CHP CIC CIP Cl ClCl2 CNCo CO CO2 CO32COD Cooling water Cr Cr(III) Cr(VI) Cross-media effects Cu CWW dB DC Diffuse emission
MEANING Combined Heat and Power. Complex Inorganic Coloured (pigments). Cleaning-In-Place system. Chlorine. Chloride ion. Chlorine gas. Cyanide ion. Cobalt. Carbon monoxide. Carbon dioxide. Carbonate ion. Chemical Oxygen Demand: the amount of potassium dichromate, expressed as oxygen, required to chemically oxidise at about 150 C substances contained in waste water. Water used for energy transfer (cooling, heating), which is kept in a network separated from industrial water and which can be released back to receiving waters without further treatment. Chromium. Trivalent chromium. Hexavalent chromium. The calculation of the environmental impacts of water/air/soil emissions, energy use, consumption of raw materials, noise and water extraction (i.e. everything required by the IPPC Directive). Copper. BREF on Common Waste Water and Waste Gas Treatment/Management Systems in the Chemical Sector. Decibel(s). Direct Current. Emissions arising from direct contact of volatile or light dusty substances with the environment (atmosphere, under normal operating circumstances). These can result from: - inherent design of the equipment (filters, dryers, etc.) - operating conditions (e.g. during transfer of material between containers) - type of operation (e.g. maintenance activities) - or from a gradual release to other media (e.g. to cooling water or waste water). Fugitive emissions are a subset of diffuse emissions and commonly refer to substances that enter the environment through leaks from equipment. For dusty substances the term diffuse emissions is more commonly used. See also the definition of Fugitive emissions below. Sources of similar diffuse or direct emissions which are multiple and distributed inside a defined area. The scum or refuse matter which is thrown off, or falls from, metals in smelting the ore, or in the process of melting. Dry Solids (content). The mass of a material remaining after drying by the standard method of test. Dimensionally Stable Anodes. A solid, mechanically produced particle with a size ranging from submicroscopic to macroscopic. European Community.
302
Glossary
MEANING Effect Concentration 50. The concentration at which effects are observed in 50 % of the test population after administering a single dose. Effects include the immobilisation of daphnia, inhibition of growth, cell division or biomass production, or the production of chlorophyll by algae. Physical fluid (air or water together with contaminants) forming an emission. European Inventory of Existing Commercial Substances. European IPPC Bureau. A process that decomposes a chemical compound or produces a new compound by the action of an electrical current. The electrical current is passed through an electrolytic cell and oxidation/reduction reactions occur at the electrodes; for example, water can be decomposed into hydrogen and oxygen by electrolysis. The direct or indirect release of substances, vibrations, heat or noise from individual or diffuse sources in the installation into the air, water or land. The mass, expressed in terms of certain specific parameters, concentration and/or level of an emission, which may not be exceeded during one or more periods of time. A technique/measure that reduces final consumptions or emissions by some additional process but does not change the fundamental operation of the core process. Synonyms: secondary technique/measure, abatement technique/measure. Antonyms: process-integrated technique/measure, primary technique/measure (a technique/measure that in some way changes the way in which the core process operates thereby reducing raw consumptions or emissions). End-Of-Pipe. Total Extractable Organic halides. European Pollutant Emission Register. Electrostatic Precipitator. The pollution of a body of water by sewage, fertilisers washed from the land, and industrial wastes (inorganic nitrates and phosphates). These compounds stimulate the growth of algae, reducing the oxygen content in the water, and so killing animals with a high oxygen requirement. European Union. Euro currency. The first 15 countries that joined the European Community/Union. An installation in operation or, in accordance with legislation existing before the date on which this Directive is brought into effect, an installation authorised or in the view of the competent authority the subject of a full request for authorisation, provided that that installation is put into operation no later than one year after the date on which this Directive is brought into effect. Iron. Flue-Gas Desulphurisation. Flocculation agent. The process in which particles in a colloid aggregate into larger clumps. Often, the term is used for a reversible aggregation of particles in which the forces holding the particles together are weak and the colloid can be redispersed by agitation.
303
Glossary
MEANING Emission caused by non-tight equipment/leak: emission into the environment resulting from a gradual loss of tightness from a piece of equipment designed to contain an enclosed fluid (gaseous or liquid), basically caused by a difference of pressure and a resulting leak. Examples of fugitive emissions: leak from a flange, a pump, a sealed or tightened equipment. Gram. Granular Activated Carbon. Gross Domestic Product. General Electric company. Hour. Hydrogen. Hydrogen ion. Wastes which have hazardous properties that may render it harmful to human health or the environment. Hydrogen chloride. Hydrochloric acid. Hydrogen cyanide. Hydrocyanic acid. Formate. Water. Hydrogen peroxide. Sulphuric acid. High Efficiency Air Filter. High Efficiency Particle Arrestation (filter). Technical literature describes these as metals with a density greater than 4.5 g/ml. By this definition, most chemical elements are heavy metals. Hydrogen fluoride. Mercury. Nitric acid. High Pressure. High Vacuum Unit. Production unit (step in the production line) which operates under high vacuum. International Agency for Research on Cancer. Intermediate Bulk Containers. Information Exchange Forum (informal consultation body in the framework of the IPPC Directive). A gas which is not toxic, which does not support human breathing and which reacts scarcely or not at all with other substances. Inert gases are mainly nitrogen and the rare gases like helium, argon, neon, xenon, krypton. A stationary technical unit where one or more activities listed in Annex I are carried out, and any other directly associated activities which have a technical connection with the activities carried out on that site and which could have an effect on emissions and pollution. The precursor of IPPC in the UK. Integrated Pollution Prevention and Control. International Organisation for Standardisation. Joule(s). Kilo(s). Potassium ion. Potassium cyanide. Potassium hydroxide. Kilo pascal(s). Kilowatt(s).
Speciality Inorganic Chemicals
g GAC GDP GE h H H+ Hazardous wastes HCl HCN HCOOH2O H2O2 H2SO4 HEAF HEPA Heavy metals HF Hg HNO3 HP HVU IARC IBCs IEF Inert gas
Installation
Glossary
MEANING Kilowatt(s)-hour(s). Lead azide. Lethal Concentration 50. The lowest concentration of a substance in water or ambient air in milligrams per litre sufficient to cause death in 50 % of the test population within a defined period (e.g. 96 hours for fish, 48 hours for daphnia). Lethal Dose 50. The lowest dose of a substance administered to species such as mice and rats sufficient to cause death in 50 % of the test population within a defined period (no more than 14 days), expressed in milligrams of test substance per kilogram of body weight. Lower Explosive Limit. Low Pressure. Lead Picrate. Lead trinitroresorcinate. Large Volume Inorganic Chemicals. Large Volume Inorganic Chemicals Solids and others. Large Volume Organic Chemicals. A mixture of sulphides that forms when sulphide metal ores (containing e.g. nickel, copper, cobalt) are smelted. Methyl chloride. Microfiltration (membrane process). Methanol. Milligram(s). Cubic metre(s). Process intended to assess or to determine the actual value and the variations of an emission or another parameter, based on procedures of systematic, periodic or spot surveillance, inspection, sampling and measurement or other assessment methods intended to provide information about emitted quantities and/or trends for emitted pollutants. Waste water stream directly arising from a synthesis or chemical reaction, generally highly concentrated in products, starting material or by-products, especially the initial aqueous discharges. Mega Pascal(s). See cross-media effects. Megawatt(s). Megawatt(s)-hour(s). Nitrogen. Nitrogen gas. Not applicable OR not available (depending on the context). No data. National Association of Corrosion Engineers. Sodium hypochlorite. Sodium perchlorate. Sodium cyanide. Sodium nitrite. Sodium hydroxide. Also called caustic soda. Sodium dichromate. Sodium carbonate, soda. Also called soda ash. Nanofiltration (membrane process). Non-Ferrous Metal (BREF). Nanogram(s). Non-Governmental Organisation.
305
LD50
Mother liquor MPa Multi-media effects MW MWh N N2 N/A or n/a N/D or n/d NACE NaOCl NaClO4 NaCN NaNO2 NaOH Na2Cr2O7 Na2CO3 NF NFM ng NGO
Glossary
TERM or ABBREVIATION NH3 NH4+ NH4-N Ni Nm3 N2O NO NO2 NO3NO3-N NOX O2 O3 OClOCNOFC OJ Operator
MEANING Ammonia. Ammonium ion. Nitrogen content in the form of NH3 or NH4+. Nickel. Normal cubic metre(s). Typically at 0 C and 101.3 kPa. Nitrous oxide. Nitrogen oxide. Nitrogen dioxide. Nitrate. Nitrogen nitrate. Nitrogen oxides (mixture of NO and NO2). Oxygen gas. Ozone. Hypochlorite ion. Cyanate ion. Organic Fine Chemicals. Official Journal. Any natural or legal person who operates or controls the installation or, where this is provided for in national legislation, to whom decisive economic power over the technical functioning of the installation has been delegated. Phosphorus. Pascal. A unit of pressure equal to one newton per square metre. Powdered Activated Carbon. Lead. Polychlorinated Biphenyls. Polychlorinated dibenzodioxins. Polychlorinated dibenzofurans. Polydimethysiloxane. Calculated by taking the logarithm of the concentration of the hydrogen ions present in solution: pH = -log10[H+]. Process-Integrated. Programmable Logic Control. Particulate Matter. Any airborne finely divided solid or liquid material excluding uncombined water. Particulate Matter with an aerodynamic diameter less than or equal to a nominal 0.01 micrometres. Particulate Matter with an aerodynamic diameter less than or equal to a nominal 0.1 micrometres. Particulate Matter with an aerodynamic diameter less than or equal to a nominal 0.12 micrometres. Particulate Matter with an aerodynamic diameter less than or equal to a nominal 0.3 micrometres. Particulate Matter with an aerodynamic diameter less than or equal to a nominal 10 micrometres. Particulate Matter with an aerodynamic diameter less than or equal to a nominal 2.5 micrometres. Hazardous air pollutants in particulate form. Phosphorus content in the form of phosphates. Individual substance or group of substances which can harm or affect the environment. Parts Per Million.
P Pa PAC Pb PCB PCDD PCDF PDMS pH PI PLC PM PM0.01 PM0.1 PM0.12 PM0.3 PM10 PM2.5 PMHAP PO4-P Pollutant PPM or ppm
306
Glossary
TERM or ABBREVIATION Primary measure/technique PSA PTFE RCO R&D RO rpm RTD RTO Salt Sb SCR SCWO Secondary measure/technique Slag
MEANING A technique that in some way changes the way in which the core process operates thereby reducing raw consumptions or emissions (see end-of-pipe technique). Pressure-Swing Adsorption. Politetrafluoro-ethylene. Regenerative Catalytic Oxidation. Research and Development. Reverse Osmosis (membrane process). Rotation per minute. Research and Technological Development. Regenerative Thermal Oxidiser. An ionic compound made of a cation and an anion, other than hydroxide. Antimony. Selective Catalytic Reduction. Super Critical Water Oxidation. See end-of-pipe technique. A product of smelting, containing, mostly as silicates, the substances not sought to be produced as matte or metal, and having a lower specific gravity than the latter. The slag of iron blast furnaces is essentially silicate of calcium, magnesium, and aluminium; that of lead and copper smelting furnaces contains iron. Speciality Inorganic Chemicals. Small and Medium Enterprise(s). Tin. Selective Non-Catalytic Reduction. Tin monoxide. Sulphur dioxide. Sulphur trioxide. Sulphate ion. Sulphur oxides (mixture of SO2 and SO3). Emission related to a reference basis, such as production capacity, or actual production (e.g. mass per tonne or per unit produced). Stanford Research Institute. Suspended Solids (content) (in water) (see also TSS). Tonne(s). German regulations. Toxic Equivalents. Used to report the toxicity-weighted masses of mixtures of dioxins/furans. Titanium. Titanium dioxide. Trinitroresorcinate. Total Organic Carbon. Total Solids (content). Solid content before drying of the material. Total Suspended Solids (content) (in water) (see also SS). Technical Working Group. Upflow Anaerobic Sludge Blanket reactor or process. Umweltbundesamt (German Federal Environmental Agency). Unin Explosivos-Ensign Bickford company. Ultrafiltration (membrane process). United Kingdom. United Nations.
307
SIC SME Sn SNCR SnO SO2 SO3 SO4SOx Specific emission SRI SS t TA Luft TEQ Ti TiO2 TNR TOC TS TSS TWG UASB UBA UEB UF UK UN
Glossary
MEANING United Nations Environment Programme. United States. Ultraviolet. Vanadium Viscosity Index. Volatile Organic Compounds. Tungsten. Waste Water Treatment Plant. Year. Zinc. Zinc oxide.
308
Annexes
9 ANNEXES 9.1 Annex I. Questionnaire used to gather environmental information on SIC installations
EUROPEAN COMMISSION
DIRECTORATE-GENERAL JRC JOINT RESEARCH CENTRE Institute for Prospective Technological Studies (Seville) European IPPC Bureau
HOW IS THE SUBMITTED INFORMATION GOING TO BE USED? The information submitted will only be used for the purpose of the SIC BREF and in a form that will prevent the identification from which specific company or production site it originates. The submitted data will only be dealt with by EIPPCB personnel (th
IF ANY DATA REQUESTED IS CONFIDENTIAL, PLEASE SPECIFY THIS Confidentiality should not generally be an issue as the vast majority of consumption and emission data included in this questionnaire are provided to national permitting authorities and entered onto public registers (when they are not simply part of compa
WHAT IF I DON'T HAVE ALL THE INFORMATION REQUESTED? You are asked to submit the information that you have to hand. Partial information is also useful. WHICH CELLS DO I HAVE TO FILL? The cells that require information or data are coloured blue. Please feel free to add any of your relevant information here.
THE FOLLOWING FIGURE SUMMARISES HOW YOUR INSTALLATION NEEDS TO BE SEEN TO FILL THE QUESTIONNAIRE CORRECTLY
INPUTS
OUTPUTS
309
Annexes
1. GENERAL INFORMATION ABOUT THE SIC INSTALLATION
Country where the installation is located Name of the company Name of the installation (or city where it is located) Date of entry into operation Year of reference for the data provided in this questionnaire Additional information
310
Annexes
fossil fuel (gas, liquid, solid), other (please specify) MJ/yr MWh/yr MWh/yr m3/yr MJ/yr
RAW MATERIALS tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr OTHER MATERIALS (catalysts, etc.) tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr tonnes/yr
311
Annexes
3. APPLIED PROCESSES AND TECHNIQUES AT THE SIC INSTALLATION
Installation: SPECIALITY CHEMICALS PRODUCED AT THE INSTALLATION Family of SIC substances produced production of inorganic pigments (other than TiO2 and carbon black) production of inorganic explosives by chemical processes production of cyanides production of phosphorus compounds production of silicones production of soluble salts of nickel
By-products generated
Outcome
312
Annexes
BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE PROCESSES Please mention the list of processes/activities carried out at your installation (storage already partially included). For a better understanding of your process, please add a flow chart of the installation to the next worksheet. Outputs (i.e. emissions to air and water, residues, noise, odour) Inputs (e.g. raw material, energy, water)
Short description/Remarks
1 Gas storage
2 Liquid storage
10
11
12
13
14
15
313
Annexes
AIR ABATEMENT SYSTEMS USED Please mention in the following table which types of flue-gas cleaning systems are used in your installation Abatement Basis of the efficiency* efficiency* % PM PM PM PM PM
Type of abatement system in use A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 A22 A9 A10 A11 Dry electrostatic precipitator Wet electrostatic precipitator Cyclone Quench Bag filter Baghouse filter with active carbon injection Acid wet scrubber Alkaline wet scrubber Water scrubber Additional scrubber system Dry scrubber with lime injection
Remarks
Non selective catalytic reduction A12 Selective catalytic reduction for NOx A13 A14 A15 A16 A17 A18 A19 A20 A21 Selective catalytic reduction for NOx and dioxins Active carbon filter (steady) VOC incinerator Biofilter
NOx NOx
VOC
* if more than one pollutant is abated by the technique, please report abatement efficiency and the basis of the efficiency for each pollutant
Are you planning to implement any other air abatement technique within the next two years? NO If yes, please specify which.
314
Annexes
WASTE WATER TREATMENT SYSTEMS USED Please mention the waste water treatments carried out in your installation which are not part of the waste water treatment plant (WWTP) in the following table Abatement Basis of the efficiency efficiency %
Abatement system in use WI1 WI2 WI3 WI4 WI5 WI6 WI7 WI8
Remarks
WASTE WATER TREATMENT PLANT (WWTP) 1) Is your installation generating waste water? If yes, please respond to question 2) 2) Is the waste water generated by your installation treated in a WWTP? If yes, please respond to question 3) 3) Is the WWTP only treating waste water generated by your installation Overall efficiency % % Applied In TOC terms
Possible treatments contained in the WWTP W1 Sedimentation W2 Neutralisation W3 Chemical treatment with .......... W4 Separation of emulsions W5 Filtration W6 Dewatering W7 Filter press W8 Ion exchange W9 Flocculation W10 W11 W12 W13 W14 W15
Remarks
Are you planning to implement any other water treatment within the next two years? NO If yes, please specify which.
315
Annexes
Units
Load
Units kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr g/yr
mg/Nm mg/Nm mg/Nm mg/Nm mg/Nm mg/Nm mg/Nm mg/Nm mg/Nm mg/Nm mg/Nm mg/Nm mg/Nm mg/Nm mg/Nm mg/Nm mg/Nm mg/Nm mg/Nm mg/Nm (ngTEQ/Nm)
Note: N means normal conditions (0 C and 1 atm). Please give the data from dry conditions.
316
Annexes
WATER EMISSIONS Parameter Averaging time period Waste water generated o SS (Suspended Solids (dried 105 C)) TOC (Total Organic Carbon) BOD5 (Biological Oxygen Demand 5 days) COD (Chemical Oxygen Demand 2 hours) AOX (Adsorbable Organic Halogens) Total metals Al As, total B, total Cd, total Chlorides CN (free) Cr, total Cr (VI) Cu, total F, total Fe Hg Hydrocarbons Mn, total Total Nitrogen (as N) Nitrite N (NO2 - N) Ni, total Nitrates P, total Pb, total Phenols Sn Sulphates Zn, total Types of measurement (C, D, IM, E) Concentration
Units
Load
Units m/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr g/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr kg/yr
mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l mg/l
WASTE GENERATED Waste generated in the process Annual amount of waste (tonnes/yr)
Subsequent outcome
317
Annexes
5. GOOD ENVIRONMENTAL PRACTICES
Installation: The information included in this worksheet concerns those techniques (which are already implemented or that will be implemented shortly in your installation) that you consider to be Good Environmental Practices (GEP). For each technique, please provide i
Information Description Achieved environmental benefits Cross-media effects Operational data Applicability Economics Driving force for implementation Example plants Reference literature Information Description Achieved environmental benefits Cross-media effects Operational data Applicability Economics Driving force for implementation Example plants Reference literature
Duplicate the above format to provide information on all the techniques applied in your installation that you consider to be GEP
318